xref: /freebsd/contrib/llvm-project/llvm/lib/CodeGen/CodeGenPrepare.cpp (revision e64bea71c21eb42e97aa615188ba91f6cce0d36d)
1 //===- CodeGenPrepare.cpp - Prepare a function for code generation --------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 // This pass munges the code in the input function to better prepare it for
10 // SelectionDAG-based code generation. This works around limitations in it's
11 // basic-block-at-a-time approach. It should eventually be removed.
12 //
13 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
14 
15 #include "llvm/CodeGen/CodeGenPrepare.h"
16 #include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
17 #include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
18 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
19 #include "llvm/ADT/MapVector.h"
20 #include "llvm/ADT/PointerIntPair.h"
21 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
22 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
23 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
24 #include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
25 #include "llvm/Analysis/BlockFrequencyInfo.h"
26 #include "llvm/Analysis/BranchProbabilityInfo.h"
27 #include "llvm/Analysis/FloatingPointPredicateUtils.h"
28 #include "llvm/Analysis/InstructionSimplify.h"
29 #include "llvm/Analysis/LoopInfo.h"
30 #include "llvm/Analysis/ProfileSummaryInfo.h"
31 #include "llvm/Analysis/ScalarEvolutionExpressions.h"
32 #include "llvm/Analysis/TargetLibraryInfo.h"
33 #include "llvm/Analysis/TargetTransformInfo.h"
34 #include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
35 #include "llvm/Analysis/VectorUtils.h"
36 #include "llvm/CodeGen/Analysis.h"
37 #include "llvm/CodeGen/BasicBlockSectionsProfileReader.h"
38 #include "llvm/CodeGen/ISDOpcodes.h"
39 #include "llvm/CodeGen/SelectionDAGNodes.h"
40 #include "llvm/CodeGen/TargetLowering.h"
41 #include "llvm/CodeGen/TargetPassConfig.h"
42 #include "llvm/CodeGen/TargetSubtargetInfo.h"
43 #include "llvm/CodeGen/ValueTypes.h"
44 #include "llvm/CodeGenTypes/MachineValueType.h"
45 #include "llvm/Config/llvm-config.h"
46 #include "llvm/IR/Argument.h"
47 #include "llvm/IR/Attributes.h"
48 #include "llvm/IR/BasicBlock.h"
49 #include "llvm/IR/Constant.h"
50 #include "llvm/IR/Constants.h"
51 #include "llvm/IR/DataLayout.h"
52 #include "llvm/IR/DebugInfo.h"
53 #include "llvm/IR/DerivedTypes.h"
54 #include "llvm/IR/Dominators.h"
55 #include "llvm/IR/Function.h"
56 #include "llvm/IR/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
57 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalValue.h"
58 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalVariable.h"
59 #include "llvm/IR/IRBuilder.h"
60 #include "llvm/IR/InlineAsm.h"
61 #include "llvm/IR/InstrTypes.h"
62 #include "llvm/IR/Instruction.h"
63 #include "llvm/IR/Instructions.h"
64 #include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicInst.h"
65 #include "llvm/IR/Intrinsics.h"
66 #include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicsAArch64.h"
67 #include "llvm/IR/LLVMContext.h"
68 #include "llvm/IR/MDBuilder.h"
69 #include "llvm/IR/Module.h"
70 #include "llvm/IR/Operator.h"
71 #include "llvm/IR/PatternMatch.h"
72 #include "llvm/IR/ProfDataUtils.h"
73 #include "llvm/IR/Statepoint.h"
74 #include "llvm/IR/Type.h"
75 #include "llvm/IR/Use.h"
76 #include "llvm/IR/User.h"
77 #include "llvm/IR/Value.h"
78 #include "llvm/IR/ValueHandle.h"
79 #include "llvm/IR/ValueMap.h"
80 #include "llvm/InitializePasses.h"
81 #include "llvm/Pass.h"
82 #include "llvm/Support/BlockFrequency.h"
83 #include "llvm/Support/BranchProbability.h"
84 #include "llvm/Support/Casting.h"
85 #include "llvm/Support/CommandLine.h"
86 #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
87 #include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
88 #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
89 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
90 #include "llvm/Target/TargetMachine.h"
91 #include "llvm/Target/TargetOptions.h"
92 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
93 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BypassSlowDivision.h"
94 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
95 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/SimplifyLibCalls.h"
96 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/SizeOpts.h"
97 #include <algorithm>
98 #include <cassert>
99 #include <cstdint>
100 #include <iterator>
101 #include <limits>
102 #include <memory>
103 #include <optional>
104 #include <utility>
105 #include <vector>
106 
107 using namespace llvm;
108 using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
109 
110 #define DEBUG_TYPE "codegenprepare"
111 
112 STATISTIC(NumBlocksElim, "Number of blocks eliminated");
113 STATISTIC(NumPHIsElim, "Number of trivial PHIs eliminated");
114 STATISTIC(NumGEPsElim, "Number of GEPs converted to casts");
115 STATISTIC(NumCmpUses, "Number of uses of Cmp expressions replaced with uses of "
116                       "sunken Cmps");
117 STATISTIC(NumCastUses, "Number of uses of Cast expressions replaced with uses "
118                        "of sunken Casts");
119 STATISTIC(NumMemoryInsts, "Number of memory instructions whose address "
120                           "computations were sunk");
121 STATISTIC(NumMemoryInstsPhiCreated,
122           "Number of phis created when address "
123           "computations were sunk to memory instructions");
124 STATISTIC(NumMemoryInstsSelectCreated,
125           "Number of select created when address "
126           "computations were sunk to memory instructions");
127 STATISTIC(NumExtsMoved, "Number of [s|z]ext instructions combined with loads");
128 STATISTIC(NumExtUses, "Number of uses of [s|z]ext instructions optimized");
129 STATISTIC(NumAndsAdded,
130           "Number of and mask instructions added to form ext loads");
131 STATISTIC(NumAndUses, "Number of uses of and mask instructions optimized");
132 STATISTIC(NumRetsDup, "Number of return instructions duplicated");
133 STATISTIC(NumDbgValueMoved, "Number of debug value instructions moved");
134 STATISTIC(NumSelectsExpanded, "Number of selects turned into branches");
135 STATISTIC(NumStoreExtractExposed, "Number of store(extractelement) exposed");
136 
137 static cl::opt<bool> DisableBranchOpts(
138     "disable-cgp-branch-opts", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
139     cl::desc("Disable branch optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
140 
141 static cl::opt<bool>
142     DisableGCOpts("disable-cgp-gc-opts", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
143                   cl::desc("Disable GC optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
144 
145 static cl::opt<bool>
146     DisableSelectToBranch("disable-cgp-select2branch", cl::Hidden,
147                           cl::init(false),
148                           cl::desc("Disable select to branch conversion."));
149 
150 static cl::opt<bool>
151     AddrSinkUsingGEPs("addr-sink-using-gep", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
152                       cl::desc("Address sinking in CGP using GEPs."));
153 
154 static cl::opt<bool>
155     EnableAndCmpSinking("enable-andcmp-sinking", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
156                         cl::desc("Enable sinking and/cmp into branches."));
157 
158 static cl::opt<bool> DisableStoreExtract(
159     "disable-cgp-store-extract", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
160     cl::desc("Disable store(extract) optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
161 
162 static cl::opt<bool> StressStoreExtract(
163     "stress-cgp-store-extract", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
164     cl::desc("Stress test store(extract) optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
165 
166 static cl::opt<bool> DisableExtLdPromotion(
167     "disable-cgp-ext-ld-promotion", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
168     cl::desc("Disable ext(promotable(ld)) -> promoted(ext(ld)) optimization in "
169              "CodeGenPrepare"));
170 
171 static cl::opt<bool> StressExtLdPromotion(
172     "stress-cgp-ext-ld-promotion", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
173     cl::desc("Stress test ext(promotable(ld)) -> promoted(ext(ld)) "
174              "optimization in CodeGenPrepare"));
175 
176 static cl::opt<bool> DisablePreheaderProtect(
177     "disable-preheader-prot", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
178     cl::desc("Disable protection against removing loop preheaders"));
179 
180 static cl::opt<bool> ProfileGuidedSectionPrefix(
181     "profile-guided-section-prefix", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
182     cl::desc("Use profile info to add section prefix for hot/cold functions"));
183 
184 static cl::opt<bool> ProfileUnknownInSpecialSection(
185     "profile-unknown-in-special-section", cl::Hidden,
186     cl::desc("In profiling mode like sampleFDO, if a function doesn't have "
187              "profile, we cannot tell the function is cold for sure because "
188              "it may be a function newly added without ever being sampled. "
189              "With the flag enabled, compiler can put such profile unknown "
190              "functions into a special section, so runtime system can choose "
191              "to handle it in a different way than .text section, to save "
192              "RAM for example. "));
193 
194 static cl::opt<bool> BBSectionsGuidedSectionPrefix(
195     "bbsections-guided-section-prefix", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
196     cl::desc("Use the basic-block-sections profile to determine the text "
197              "section prefix for hot functions. Functions with "
198              "basic-block-sections profile will be placed in `.text.hot` "
199              "regardless of their FDO profile info. Other functions won't be "
200              "impacted, i.e., their prefixes will be decided by FDO/sampleFDO "
201              "profiles."));
202 
203 static cl::opt<uint64_t> FreqRatioToSkipMerge(
204     "cgp-freq-ratio-to-skip-merge", cl::Hidden, cl::init(2),
205     cl::desc("Skip merging empty blocks if (frequency of empty block) / "
206              "(frequency of destination block) is greater than this ratio"));
207 
208 static cl::opt<bool> ForceSplitStore(
209     "force-split-store", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
210     cl::desc("Force store splitting no matter what the target query says."));
211 
212 static cl::opt<bool> EnableTypePromotionMerge(
213     "cgp-type-promotion-merge", cl::Hidden,
214     cl::desc("Enable merging of redundant sexts when one is dominating"
215              " the other."),
216     cl::init(true));
217 
218 static cl::opt<bool> DisableComplexAddrModes(
219     "disable-complex-addr-modes", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
220     cl::desc("Disables combining addressing modes with different parts "
221              "in optimizeMemoryInst."));
222 
223 static cl::opt<bool>
224     AddrSinkNewPhis("addr-sink-new-phis", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
225                     cl::desc("Allow creation of Phis in Address sinking."));
226 
227 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkNewSelects(
228     "addr-sink-new-select", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
229     cl::desc("Allow creation of selects in Address sinking."));
230 
231 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineBaseReg(
232     "addr-sink-combine-base-reg", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
233     cl::desc("Allow combining of BaseReg field in Address sinking."));
234 
235 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineBaseGV(
236     "addr-sink-combine-base-gv", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
237     cl::desc("Allow combining of BaseGV field in Address sinking."));
238 
239 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineBaseOffs(
240     "addr-sink-combine-base-offs", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
241     cl::desc("Allow combining of BaseOffs field in Address sinking."));
242 
243 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineScaledReg(
244     "addr-sink-combine-scaled-reg", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
245     cl::desc("Allow combining of ScaledReg field in Address sinking."));
246 
247 static cl::opt<bool>
248     EnableGEPOffsetSplit("cgp-split-large-offset-gep", cl::Hidden,
249                          cl::init(true),
250                          cl::desc("Enable splitting large offset of GEP."));
251 
252 static cl::opt<bool> EnableICMP_EQToICMP_ST(
253     "cgp-icmp-eq2icmp-st", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
254     cl::desc("Enable ICMP_EQ to ICMP_S(L|G)T conversion."));
255 
256 static cl::opt<bool>
257     VerifyBFIUpdates("cgp-verify-bfi-updates", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
258                      cl::desc("Enable BFI update verification for "
259                               "CodeGenPrepare."));
260 
261 static cl::opt<bool>
262     OptimizePhiTypes("cgp-optimize-phi-types", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
263                      cl::desc("Enable converting phi types in CodeGenPrepare"));
264 
265 static cl::opt<unsigned>
266     HugeFuncThresholdInCGPP("cgpp-huge-func", cl::init(10000), cl::Hidden,
267                             cl::desc("Least BB number of huge function."));
268 
269 static cl::opt<unsigned>
270     MaxAddressUsersToScan("cgp-max-address-users-to-scan", cl::init(100),
271                           cl::Hidden,
272                           cl::desc("Max number of address users to look at"));
273 
274 static cl::opt<bool>
275     DisableDeletePHIs("disable-cgp-delete-phis", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
276                       cl::desc("Disable elimination of dead PHI nodes."));
277 
278 namespace {
279 
280 enum ExtType {
281   ZeroExtension, // Zero extension has been seen.
282   SignExtension, // Sign extension has been seen.
283   BothExtension  // This extension type is used if we saw sext after
284                  // ZeroExtension had been set, or if we saw zext after
285                  // SignExtension had been set. It makes the type
286                  // information of a promoted instruction invalid.
287 };
288 
289 enum ModifyDT {
290   NotModifyDT, // Not Modify any DT.
291   ModifyBBDT,  // Modify the Basic Block Dominator Tree.
292   ModifyInstDT // Modify the Instruction Dominator in a Basic Block,
293                // This usually means we move/delete/insert instruction
294                // in a Basic Block. So we should re-iterate instructions
295                // in such Basic Block.
296 };
297 
298 using SetOfInstrs = SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 16>;
299 using TypeIsSExt = PointerIntPair<Type *, 2, ExtType>;
300 using InstrToOrigTy = DenseMap<Instruction *, TypeIsSExt>;
301 using SExts = SmallVector<Instruction *, 16>;
302 using ValueToSExts = MapVector<Value *, SExts>;
303 
304 class TypePromotionTransaction;
305 
306 class CodeGenPrepare {
307   friend class CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass;
308   const TargetMachine *TM = nullptr;
309   const TargetSubtargetInfo *SubtargetInfo = nullptr;
310   const TargetLowering *TLI = nullptr;
311   const TargetRegisterInfo *TRI = nullptr;
312   const TargetTransformInfo *TTI = nullptr;
313   const BasicBlockSectionsProfileReader *BBSectionsProfileReader = nullptr;
314   const TargetLibraryInfo *TLInfo = nullptr;
315   LoopInfo *LI = nullptr;
316   std::unique_ptr<BlockFrequencyInfo> BFI;
317   std::unique_ptr<BranchProbabilityInfo> BPI;
318   ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI = nullptr;
319 
320   /// As we scan instructions optimizing them, this is the next instruction
321   /// to optimize. Transforms that can invalidate this should update it.
322   BasicBlock::iterator CurInstIterator;
323 
324   /// Keeps track of non-local addresses that have been sunk into a block.
325   /// This allows us to avoid inserting duplicate code for blocks with
326   /// multiple load/stores of the same address. The usage of WeakTrackingVH
327   /// enables SunkAddrs to be treated as a cache whose entries can be
328   /// invalidated if a sunken address computation has been erased.
329   ValueMap<Value *, WeakTrackingVH> SunkAddrs;
330 
331   /// Keeps track of all instructions inserted for the current function.
332   SetOfInstrs InsertedInsts;
333 
334   /// Keeps track of the type of the related instruction before their
335   /// promotion for the current function.
336   InstrToOrigTy PromotedInsts;
337 
338   /// Keep track of instructions removed during promotion.
339   SetOfInstrs RemovedInsts;
340 
341   /// Keep track of sext chains based on their initial value.
342   DenseMap<Value *, Instruction *> SeenChainsForSExt;
343 
344   /// Keep track of GEPs accessing the same data structures such as structs or
345   /// arrays that are candidates to be split later because of their large
346   /// size.
347   MapVector<AssertingVH<Value>,
348             SmallVector<std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t>, 32>>
349       LargeOffsetGEPMap;
350 
351   /// Keep track of new GEP base after splitting the GEPs having large offset.
352   SmallSet<AssertingVH<Value>, 2> NewGEPBases;
353 
354   /// Map serial numbers to Large offset GEPs.
355   DenseMap<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int> LargeOffsetGEPID;
356 
357   /// Keep track of SExt promoted.
358   ValueToSExts ValToSExtendedUses;
359 
360   /// True if the function has the OptSize attribute.
361   bool OptSize;
362 
363   /// DataLayout for the Function being processed.
364   const DataLayout *DL = nullptr;
365 
366   /// Building the dominator tree can be expensive, so we only build it
367   /// lazily and update it when required.
368   std::unique_ptr<DominatorTree> DT;
369 
370 public:
CodeGenPrepare()371   CodeGenPrepare(){};
CodeGenPrepare(const TargetMachine * TM)372   CodeGenPrepare(const TargetMachine *TM) : TM(TM){};
373   /// If encounter huge function, we need to limit the build time.
374   bool IsHugeFunc = false;
375 
376   /// FreshBBs is like worklist, it collected the updated BBs which need
377   /// to be optimized again.
378   /// Note: Consider building time in this pass, when a BB updated, we need
379   /// to insert such BB into FreshBBs for huge function.
380   SmallSet<BasicBlock *, 32> FreshBBs;
381 
releaseMemory()382   void releaseMemory() {
383     // Clear per function information.
384     InsertedInsts.clear();
385     PromotedInsts.clear();
386     FreshBBs.clear();
387     BPI.reset();
388     BFI.reset();
389   }
390 
391   bool run(Function &F, FunctionAnalysisManager &AM);
392 
393 private:
394   template <typename F>
resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(BasicBlock * BB,F f)395   void resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(BasicBlock *BB, F f) {
396     // Substituting can cause recursive simplifications, which can invalidate
397     // our iterator.  Use a WeakTrackingVH to hold onto it in case this
398     // happens.
399     Value *CurValue = &*CurInstIterator;
400     WeakTrackingVH IterHandle(CurValue);
401 
402     f();
403 
404     // If the iterator instruction was recursively deleted, start over at the
405     // start of the block.
406     if (IterHandle != CurValue) {
407       CurInstIterator = BB->begin();
408       SunkAddrs.clear();
409     }
410   }
411 
412   // Get the DominatorTree, building if necessary.
getDT(Function & F)413   DominatorTree &getDT(Function &F) {
414     if (!DT)
415       DT = std::make_unique<DominatorTree>(F);
416     return *DT;
417   }
418 
419   void removeAllAssertingVHReferences(Value *V);
420   bool eliminateAssumptions(Function &F);
421   bool eliminateFallThrough(Function &F, DominatorTree *DT = nullptr);
422   bool eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(Function &F);
423   BasicBlock *findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB);
424   bool canMergeBlocks(const BasicBlock *BB, const BasicBlock *DestBB) const;
425   void eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB);
426   bool isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BasicBlock *BB, BasicBlock *DestBB,
427                                      bool isPreheader);
428   bool makeBitReverse(Instruction &I);
429   bool optimizeBlock(BasicBlock &BB, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
430   bool optimizeInst(Instruction *I, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
431   bool optimizeMemoryInst(Instruction *MemoryInst, Value *Addr, Type *AccessTy,
432                           unsigned AddrSpace);
433   bool optimizeGatherScatterInst(Instruction *MemoryInst, Value *Ptr);
434   bool optimizeInlineAsmInst(CallInst *CS);
435   bool optimizeCallInst(CallInst *CI, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
436   bool optimizeExt(Instruction *&I);
437   bool optimizeExtUses(Instruction *I);
438   bool optimizeLoadExt(LoadInst *Load);
439   bool optimizeShiftInst(BinaryOperator *BO);
440   bool optimizeFunnelShift(IntrinsicInst *Fsh);
441   bool optimizeSelectInst(SelectInst *SI);
442   bool optimizeShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst *SVI);
443   bool optimizeSwitchType(SwitchInst *SI);
444   bool optimizeSwitchPhiConstants(SwitchInst *SI);
445   bool optimizeSwitchInst(SwitchInst *SI);
446   bool optimizeExtractElementInst(Instruction *Inst);
447   bool dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(BasicBlock *BB, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
448   bool fixupDbgValue(Instruction *I);
449   bool fixupDbgVariableRecord(DbgVariableRecord &I);
450   bool fixupDbgVariableRecordsOnInst(Instruction &I);
451   bool placeDbgValues(Function &F);
452   bool placePseudoProbes(Function &F);
453   bool canFormExtLd(const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &MovedExts,
454                     LoadInst *&LI, Instruction *&Inst, bool HasPromoted);
455   bool tryToPromoteExts(TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
456                         const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &Exts,
457                         SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &ProfitablyMovedExts,
458                         unsigned CreatedInstsCost = 0);
459   bool mergeSExts(Function &F);
460   bool splitLargeGEPOffsets();
461   bool optimizePhiType(PHINode *Inst, SmallPtrSetImpl<PHINode *> &Visited,
462                        SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &DeletedInstrs);
463   bool optimizePhiTypes(Function &F);
464   bool performAddressTypePromotion(
465       Instruction *&Inst, bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,
466       bool HasPromoted, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
467       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &SpeculativelyMovedExts);
468   bool splitBranchCondition(Function &F, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
469   bool simplifyOffsetableRelocate(GCStatepointInst &I);
470 
471   bool tryToSinkFreeOperands(Instruction *I);
472   bool replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(BinaryOperator *BO, Value *Arg0, Value *Arg1,
473                                    CmpInst *Cmp, Intrinsic::ID IID);
474   bool optimizeCmp(CmpInst *Cmp, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
475   bool optimizeURem(Instruction *Rem);
476   bool combineToUSubWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
477   bool combineToUAddWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT);
478   bool unfoldPowerOf2Test(CmpInst *Cmp);
479   void verifyBFIUpdates(Function &F);
480   bool _run(Function &F);
481 };
482 
483 class CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass : public FunctionPass {
484 public:
485   static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
486 
CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass()487   CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass() : FunctionPass(ID) {
488     initializeCodeGenPrepareLegacyPassPass(*PassRegistry::getPassRegistry());
489   }
490 
491   bool runOnFunction(Function &F) override;
492 
getPassName() const493   StringRef getPassName() const override { return "CodeGen Prepare"; }
494 
getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage & AU) const495   void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const override {
496     // FIXME: When we can selectively preserve passes, preserve the domtree.
497     AU.addRequired<ProfileSummaryInfoWrapperPass>();
498     AU.addRequired<TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass>();
499     AU.addRequired<TargetPassConfig>();
500     AU.addRequired<TargetTransformInfoWrapperPass>();
501     AU.addRequired<LoopInfoWrapperPass>();
502     AU.addUsedIfAvailable<BasicBlockSectionsProfileReaderWrapperPass>();
503   }
504 };
505 
506 } // end anonymous namespace
507 
508 char CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass::ID = 0;
509 
runOnFunction(Function & F)510 bool CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
511   if (skipFunction(F))
512     return false;
513   auto TM = &getAnalysis<TargetPassConfig>().getTM<TargetMachine>();
514   CodeGenPrepare CGP(TM);
515   CGP.DL = &F.getDataLayout();
516   CGP.SubtargetInfo = TM->getSubtargetImpl(F);
517   CGP.TLI = CGP.SubtargetInfo->getTargetLowering();
518   CGP.TRI = CGP.SubtargetInfo->getRegisterInfo();
519   CGP.TLInfo = &getAnalysis<TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass>().getTLI(F);
520   CGP.TTI = &getAnalysis<TargetTransformInfoWrapperPass>().getTTI(F);
521   CGP.LI = &getAnalysis<LoopInfoWrapperPass>().getLoopInfo();
522   CGP.BPI.reset(new BranchProbabilityInfo(F, *CGP.LI));
523   CGP.BFI.reset(new BlockFrequencyInfo(F, *CGP.BPI, *CGP.LI));
524   CGP.PSI = &getAnalysis<ProfileSummaryInfoWrapperPass>().getPSI();
525   auto BBSPRWP =
526       getAnalysisIfAvailable<BasicBlockSectionsProfileReaderWrapperPass>();
527   CGP.BBSectionsProfileReader = BBSPRWP ? &BBSPRWP->getBBSPR() : nullptr;
528 
529   return CGP._run(F);
530 }
531 
532 INITIALIZE_PASS_BEGIN(CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass, DEBUG_TYPE,
533                       "Optimize for code generation", false, false)
INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(BasicBlockSectionsProfileReaderWrapperPass)534 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(BasicBlockSectionsProfileReaderWrapperPass)
535 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(LoopInfoWrapperPass)
536 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(ProfileSummaryInfoWrapperPass)
537 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass)
538 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetPassConfig)
539 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetTransformInfoWrapperPass)
540 INITIALIZE_PASS_END(CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass, DEBUG_TYPE,
541                     "Optimize for code generation", false, false)
542 
543 FunctionPass *llvm::createCodeGenPrepareLegacyPass() {
544   return new CodeGenPrepareLegacyPass();
545 }
546 
run(Function & F,FunctionAnalysisManager & AM)547 PreservedAnalyses CodeGenPreparePass::run(Function &F,
548                                           FunctionAnalysisManager &AM) {
549   CodeGenPrepare CGP(TM);
550 
551   bool Changed = CGP.run(F, AM);
552   if (!Changed)
553     return PreservedAnalyses::all();
554 
555   PreservedAnalyses PA;
556   PA.preserve<TargetLibraryAnalysis>();
557   PA.preserve<TargetIRAnalysis>();
558   PA.preserve<LoopAnalysis>();
559   return PA;
560 }
561 
run(Function & F,FunctionAnalysisManager & AM)562 bool CodeGenPrepare::run(Function &F, FunctionAnalysisManager &AM) {
563   DL = &F.getDataLayout();
564   SubtargetInfo = TM->getSubtargetImpl(F);
565   TLI = SubtargetInfo->getTargetLowering();
566   TRI = SubtargetInfo->getRegisterInfo();
567   TLInfo = &AM.getResult<TargetLibraryAnalysis>(F);
568   TTI = &AM.getResult<TargetIRAnalysis>(F);
569   LI = &AM.getResult<LoopAnalysis>(F);
570   BPI.reset(new BranchProbabilityInfo(F, *LI));
571   BFI.reset(new BlockFrequencyInfo(F, *BPI, *LI));
572   auto &MAMProxy = AM.getResult<ModuleAnalysisManagerFunctionProxy>(F);
573   PSI = MAMProxy.getCachedResult<ProfileSummaryAnalysis>(*F.getParent());
574   BBSectionsProfileReader =
575       AM.getCachedResult<BasicBlockSectionsProfileReaderAnalysis>(F);
576   return _run(F);
577 }
578 
_run(Function & F)579 bool CodeGenPrepare::_run(Function &F) {
580   bool EverMadeChange = false;
581 
582   OptSize = F.hasOptSize();
583   // Use the basic-block-sections profile to promote hot functions to .text.hot
584   // if requested.
585   if (BBSectionsGuidedSectionPrefix && BBSectionsProfileReader &&
586       BBSectionsProfileReader->isFunctionHot(F.getName())) {
587     F.setSectionPrefix("hot");
588   } else if (ProfileGuidedSectionPrefix) {
589     // The hot attribute overwrites profile count based hotness while profile
590     // counts based hotness overwrite the cold attribute.
591     // This is a conservative behabvior.
592     if (F.hasFnAttribute(Attribute::Hot) ||
593         PSI->isFunctionHotInCallGraph(&F, *BFI))
594       F.setSectionPrefix("hot");
595     // If PSI shows this function is not hot, we will placed the function
596     // into unlikely section if (1) PSI shows this is a cold function, or
597     // (2) the function has a attribute of cold.
598     else if (PSI->isFunctionColdInCallGraph(&F, *BFI) ||
599              F.hasFnAttribute(Attribute::Cold))
600       F.setSectionPrefix("unlikely");
601     else if (ProfileUnknownInSpecialSection && PSI->hasPartialSampleProfile() &&
602              PSI->isFunctionHotnessUnknown(F))
603       F.setSectionPrefix("unknown");
604   }
605 
606   /// This optimization identifies DIV instructions that can be
607   /// profitably bypassed and carried out with a shorter, faster divide.
608   if (!OptSize && !PSI->hasHugeWorkingSetSize() && TLI->isSlowDivBypassed()) {
609     const DenseMap<unsigned int, unsigned int> &BypassWidths =
610         TLI->getBypassSlowDivWidths();
611     BasicBlock *BB = &*F.begin();
612     while (BB != nullptr) {
613       // bypassSlowDivision may create new BBs, but we don't want to reapply the
614       // optimization to those blocks.
615       BasicBlock *Next = BB->getNextNode();
616       if (!llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(BB, PSI, BFI.get()))
617         EverMadeChange |= bypassSlowDivision(BB, BypassWidths);
618       BB = Next;
619     }
620   }
621 
622   // Get rid of @llvm.assume builtins before attempting to eliminate empty
623   // blocks, since there might be blocks that only contain @llvm.assume calls
624   // (plus arguments that we can get rid of).
625   EverMadeChange |= eliminateAssumptions(F);
626 
627   // Eliminate blocks that contain only PHI nodes and an
628   // unconditional branch.
629   EverMadeChange |= eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(F);
630 
631   ModifyDT ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::NotModifyDT;
632   if (!DisableBranchOpts)
633     EverMadeChange |= splitBranchCondition(F, ModifiedDT);
634 
635   // Split some critical edges where one of the sources is an indirect branch,
636   // to help generate sane code for PHIs involving such edges.
637   EverMadeChange |=
638       SplitIndirectBrCriticalEdges(F, /*IgnoreBlocksWithoutPHI=*/true);
639 
640   // If we are optimzing huge function, we need to consider the build time.
641   // Because the basic algorithm's complex is near O(N!).
642   IsHugeFunc = F.size() > HugeFuncThresholdInCGPP;
643 
644   // Transformations above may invalidate dominator tree and/or loop info.
645   DT.reset();
646   LI->releaseMemory();
647   LI->analyze(getDT(F));
648 
649   bool MadeChange = true;
650   bool FuncIterated = false;
651   while (MadeChange) {
652     MadeChange = false;
653 
654     for (BasicBlock &BB : llvm::make_early_inc_range(F)) {
655       if (FuncIterated && !FreshBBs.contains(&BB))
656         continue;
657 
658       ModifyDT ModifiedDTOnIteration = ModifyDT::NotModifyDT;
659       bool Changed = optimizeBlock(BB, ModifiedDTOnIteration);
660 
661       if (ModifiedDTOnIteration == ModifyDT::ModifyBBDT)
662         DT.reset();
663 
664       MadeChange |= Changed;
665       if (IsHugeFunc) {
666         // If the BB is updated, it may still has chance to be optimized.
667         // This usually happen at sink optimization.
668         // For example:
669         //
670         // bb0:
671         // %and = and i32 %a, 4
672         // %cmp = icmp eq i32 %and, 0
673         //
674         // If the %cmp sink to other BB, the %and will has chance to sink.
675         if (Changed)
676           FreshBBs.insert(&BB);
677         else if (FuncIterated)
678           FreshBBs.erase(&BB);
679       } else {
680         // For small/normal functions, we restart BB iteration if the dominator
681         // tree of the Function was changed.
682         if (ModifiedDTOnIteration != ModifyDT::NotModifyDT)
683           break;
684       }
685     }
686     // We have iterated all the BB in the (only work for huge) function.
687     FuncIterated = IsHugeFunc;
688 
689     if (EnableTypePromotionMerge && !ValToSExtendedUses.empty())
690       MadeChange |= mergeSExts(F);
691     if (!LargeOffsetGEPMap.empty())
692       MadeChange |= splitLargeGEPOffsets();
693     MadeChange |= optimizePhiTypes(F);
694 
695     if (MadeChange)
696       eliminateFallThrough(F, DT.get());
697 
698 #ifndef NDEBUG
699     if (MadeChange && VerifyLoopInfo)
700       LI->verify(getDT(F));
701 #endif
702 
703     // Really free removed instructions during promotion.
704     for (Instruction *I : RemovedInsts)
705       I->deleteValue();
706 
707     EverMadeChange |= MadeChange;
708     SeenChainsForSExt.clear();
709     ValToSExtendedUses.clear();
710     RemovedInsts.clear();
711     LargeOffsetGEPMap.clear();
712     LargeOffsetGEPID.clear();
713   }
714 
715   NewGEPBases.clear();
716   SunkAddrs.clear();
717 
718   if (!DisableBranchOpts) {
719     MadeChange = false;
720     // Use a set vector to get deterministic iteration order. The order the
721     // blocks are removed may affect whether or not PHI nodes in successors
722     // are removed.
723     SmallSetVector<BasicBlock *, 8> WorkList;
724     for (BasicBlock &BB : F) {
725       SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 2> Successors(successors(&BB));
726       MadeChange |= ConstantFoldTerminator(&BB, true);
727       if (!MadeChange)
728         continue;
729 
730       for (BasicBlock *Succ : Successors)
731         if (pred_empty(Succ))
732           WorkList.insert(Succ);
733     }
734 
735     // Delete the dead blocks and any of their dead successors.
736     MadeChange |= !WorkList.empty();
737     while (!WorkList.empty()) {
738       BasicBlock *BB = WorkList.pop_back_val();
739       SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 2> Successors(successors(BB));
740 
741       DeleteDeadBlock(BB);
742 
743       for (BasicBlock *Succ : Successors)
744         if (pred_empty(Succ))
745           WorkList.insert(Succ);
746     }
747 
748     // Merge pairs of basic blocks with unconditional branches, connected by
749     // a single edge.
750     if (EverMadeChange || MadeChange)
751       MadeChange |= eliminateFallThrough(F);
752 
753     EverMadeChange |= MadeChange;
754   }
755 
756   if (!DisableGCOpts) {
757     SmallVector<GCStatepointInst *, 2> Statepoints;
758     for (BasicBlock &BB : F)
759       for (Instruction &I : BB)
760         if (auto *SP = dyn_cast<GCStatepointInst>(&I))
761           Statepoints.push_back(SP);
762     for (auto &I : Statepoints)
763       EverMadeChange |= simplifyOffsetableRelocate(*I);
764   }
765 
766   // Do this last to clean up use-before-def scenarios introduced by other
767   // preparatory transforms.
768   EverMadeChange |= placeDbgValues(F);
769   EverMadeChange |= placePseudoProbes(F);
770 
771 #ifndef NDEBUG
772   if (VerifyBFIUpdates)
773     verifyBFIUpdates(F);
774 #endif
775 
776   return EverMadeChange;
777 }
778 
eliminateAssumptions(Function & F)779 bool CodeGenPrepare::eliminateAssumptions(Function &F) {
780   bool MadeChange = false;
781   for (BasicBlock &BB : F) {
782     CurInstIterator = BB.begin();
783     while (CurInstIterator != BB.end()) {
784       Instruction *I = &*(CurInstIterator++);
785       if (auto *Assume = dyn_cast<AssumeInst>(I)) {
786         MadeChange = true;
787         Value *Operand = Assume->getOperand(0);
788         Assume->eraseFromParent();
789 
790         resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(&BB, [&]() {
791           RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(Operand, TLInfo, nullptr);
792         });
793       }
794     }
795   }
796   return MadeChange;
797 }
798 
799 /// An instruction is about to be deleted, so remove all references to it in our
800 /// GEP-tracking data strcutures.
removeAllAssertingVHReferences(Value * V)801 void CodeGenPrepare::removeAllAssertingVHReferences(Value *V) {
802   LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(V);
803   NewGEPBases.erase(V);
804 
805   auto GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V);
806   if (!GEP)
807     return;
808 
809   LargeOffsetGEPID.erase(GEP);
810 
811   auto VecI = LargeOffsetGEPMap.find(GEP->getPointerOperand());
812   if (VecI == LargeOffsetGEPMap.end())
813     return;
814 
815   auto &GEPVector = VecI->second;
816   llvm::erase_if(GEPVector, [=](auto &Elt) { return Elt.first == GEP; });
817 
818   if (GEPVector.empty())
819     LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(VecI);
820 }
821 
822 // Verify BFI has been updated correctly by recomputing BFI and comparing them.
verifyBFIUpdates(Function & F)823 void LLVM_ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED CodeGenPrepare::verifyBFIUpdates(Function &F) {
824   DominatorTree NewDT(F);
825   LoopInfo NewLI(NewDT);
826   BranchProbabilityInfo NewBPI(F, NewLI, TLInfo);
827   BlockFrequencyInfo NewBFI(F, NewBPI, NewLI);
828   NewBFI.verifyMatch(*BFI);
829 }
830 
831 /// Merge basic blocks which are connected by a single edge, where one of the
832 /// basic blocks has a single successor pointing to the other basic block,
833 /// which has a single predecessor.
eliminateFallThrough(Function & F,DominatorTree * DT)834 bool CodeGenPrepare::eliminateFallThrough(Function &F, DominatorTree *DT) {
835   bool Changed = false;
836   // Scan all of the blocks in the function, except for the entry block.
837   // Use a temporary array to avoid iterator being invalidated when
838   // deleting blocks.
839   SmallVector<WeakTrackingVH, 16> Blocks(
840       llvm::make_pointer_range(llvm::drop_begin(F)));
841 
842   SmallSet<WeakTrackingVH, 16> Preds;
843   for (auto &Block : Blocks) {
844     auto *BB = cast_or_null<BasicBlock>(Block);
845     if (!BB)
846       continue;
847     // If the destination block has a single pred, then this is a trivial
848     // edge, just collapse it.
849     BasicBlock *SinglePred = BB->getSinglePredecessor();
850 
851     // Don't merge if BB's address is taken.
852     if (!SinglePred || SinglePred == BB || BB->hasAddressTaken())
853       continue;
854 
855     // Make an effort to skip unreachable blocks.
856     if (DT && !DT->isReachableFromEntry(BB))
857       continue;
858 
859     BranchInst *Term = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(SinglePred->getTerminator());
860     if (Term && !Term->isConditional()) {
861       Changed = true;
862       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "To merge:\n" << *BB << "\n\n\n");
863 
864       // Merge BB into SinglePred and delete it.
865       MergeBlockIntoPredecessor(BB, /* DTU */ nullptr, LI, /* MSSAU */ nullptr,
866                                 /* MemDep */ nullptr,
867                                 /* PredecessorWithTwoSuccessors */ false, DT);
868       Preds.insert(SinglePred);
869 
870       if (IsHugeFunc) {
871         // Update FreshBBs to optimize the merged BB.
872         FreshBBs.insert(SinglePred);
873         FreshBBs.erase(BB);
874       }
875     }
876   }
877 
878   // (Repeatedly) merging blocks into their predecessors can create redundant
879   // debug intrinsics.
880   for (const auto &Pred : Preds)
881     if (auto *BB = cast_or_null<BasicBlock>(Pred))
882       RemoveRedundantDbgInstrs(BB);
883 
884   return Changed;
885 }
886 
887 /// Find a destination block from BB if BB is mergeable empty block.
findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BasicBlock * BB)888 BasicBlock *CodeGenPrepare::findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB) {
889   // If this block doesn't end with an uncond branch, ignore it.
890   BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BB->getTerminator());
891   if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional())
892     return nullptr;
893 
894   // If the instruction before the branch (skipping debug info) isn't a phi
895   // node, then other stuff is happening here.
896   BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BI->getIterator();
897   if (BBI != BB->begin()) {
898     --BBI;
899     if (!isa<PHINode>(BBI))
900       return nullptr;
901   }
902 
903   // Do not break infinite loops.
904   BasicBlock *DestBB = BI->getSuccessor(0);
905   if (DestBB == BB)
906     return nullptr;
907 
908   if (!canMergeBlocks(BB, DestBB))
909     DestBB = nullptr;
910 
911   return DestBB;
912 }
913 
914 /// Eliminate blocks that contain only PHI nodes, debug info directives, and an
915 /// unconditional branch. Passes before isel (e.g. LSR/loopsimplify) often split
916 /// edges in ways that are non-optimal for isel. Start by eliminating these
917 /// blocks so we can split them the way we want them.
eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(Function & F)918 bool CodeGenPrepare::eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(Function &F) {
919   SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock *, 16> Preheaders;
920   SmallVector<Loop *, 16> LoopList(LI->begin(), LI->end());
921   while (!LoopList.empty()) {
922     Loop *L = LoopList.pop_back_val();
923     llvm::append_range(LoopList, *L);
924     if (BasicBlock *Preheader = L->getLoopPreheader())
925       Preheaders.insert(Preheader);
926   }
927 
928   bool MadeChange = false;
929   // Copy blocks into a temporary array to avoid iterator invalidation issues
930   // as we remove them.
931   // Note that this intentionally skips the entry block.
932   SmallVector<WeakTrackingVH, 16> Blocks;
933   for (auto &Block : llvm::drop_begin(F)) {
934     // Delete phi nodes that could block deleting other empty blocks.
935     if (!DisableDeletePHIs)
936       MadeChange |= DeleteDeadPHIs(&Block, TLInfo);
937     Blocks.push_back(&Block);
938   }
939 
940   for (auto &Block : Blocks) {
941     BasicBlock *BB = cast_or_null<BasicBlock>(Block);
942     if (!BB)
943       continue;
944     BasicBlock *DestBB = findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BB);
945     if (!DestBB ||
946         !isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BB, DestBB, Preheaders.count(BB)))
947       continue;
948 
949     eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BB);
950     MadeChange = true;
951   }
952   return MadeChange;
953 }
954 
isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BasicBlock * BB,BasicBlock * DestBB,bool isPreheader)955 bool CodeGenPrepare::isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BasicBlock *BB,
956                                                    BasicBlock *DestBB,
957                                                    bool isPreheader) {
958   // Do not delete loop preheaders if doing so would create a critical edge.
959   // Loop preheaders can be good locations to spill registers. If the
960   // preheader is deleted and we create a critical edge, registers may be
961   // spilled in the loop body instead.
962   if (!DisablePreheaderProtect && isPreheader &&
963       !(BB->getSinglePredecessor() &&
964         BB->getSinglePredecessor()->getSingleSuccessor()))
965     return false;
966 
967   // Skip merging if the block's successor is also a successor to any callbr
968   // that leads to this block.
969   // FIXME: Is this really needed? Is this a correctness issue?
970   for (BasicBlock *Pred : predecessors(BB)) {
971     if (isa<CallBrInst>(Pred->getTerminator()) &&
972         llvm::is_contained(successors(Pred), DestBB))
973       return false;
974   }
975 
976   // Try to skip merging if the unique predecessor of BB is terminated by a
977   // switch or indirect branch instruction, and BB is used as an incoming block
978   // of PHIs in DestBB. In such case, merging BB and DestBB would cause ISel to
979   // add COPY instructions in the predecessor of BB instead of BB (if it is not
980   // merged). Note that the critical edge created by merging such blocks wont be
981   // split in MachineSink because the jump table is not analyzable. By keeping
982   // such empty block (BB), ISel will place COPY instructions in BB, not in the
983   // predecessor of BB.
984   BasicBlock *Pred = BB->getUniquePredecessor();
985   if (!Pred || !(isa<SwitchInst>(Pred->getTerminator()) ||
986                  isa<IndirectBrInst>(Pred->getTerminator())))
987     return true;
988 
989   if (BB->getTerminator() != &*BB->getFirstNonPHIOrDbg())
990     return true;
991 
992   // We use a simple cost heuristic which determine skipping merging is
993   // profitable if the cost of skipping merging is less than the cost of
994   // merging : Cost(skipping merging) < Cost(merging BB), where the
995   // Cost(skipping merging) is Freq(BB) * (Cost(Copy) + Cost(Branch)), and
996   // the Cost(merging BB) is Freq(Pred) * Cost(Copy).
997   // Assuming Cost(Copy) == Cost(Branch), we could simplify it to :
998   //   Freq(Pred) / Freq(BB) > 2.
999   // Note that if there are multiple empty blocks sharing the same incoming
1000   // value for the PHIs in the DestBB, we consider them together. In such
1001   // case, Cost(merging BB) will be the sum of their frequencies.
1002 
1003   if (!isa<PHINode>(DestBB->begin()))
1004     return true;
1005 
1006   SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock *, 16> SameIncomingValueBBs;
1007 
1008   // Find all other incoming blocks from which incoming values of all PHIs in
1009   // DestBB are the same as the ones from BB.
1010   for (BasicBlock *DestBBPred : predecessors(DestBB)) {
1011     if (DestBBPred == BB)
1012       continue;
1013 
1014     if (llvm::all_of(DestBB->phis(), [&](const PHINode &DestPN) {
1015           return DestPN.getIncomingValueForBlock(BB) ==
1016                  DestPN.getIncomingValueForBlock(DestBBPred);
1017         }))
1018       SameIncomingValueBBs.insert(DestBBPred);
1019   }
1020 
1021   // See if all BB's incoming values are same as the value from Pred. In this
1022   // case, no reason to skip merging because COPYs are expected to be place in
1023   // Pred already.
1024   if (SameIncomingValueBBs.count(Pred))
1025     return true;
1026 
1027   BlockFrequency PredFreq = BFI->getBlockFreq(Pred);
1028   BlockFrequency BBFreq = BFI->getBlockFreq(BB);
1029 
1030   for (auto *SameValueBB : SameIncomingValueBBs)
1031     if (SameValueBB->getUniquePredecessor() == Pred &&
1032         DestBB == findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(SameValueBB))
1033       BBFreq += BFI->getBlockFreq(SameValueBB);
1034 
1035   std::optional<BlockFrequency> Limit = BBFreq.mul(FreqRatioToSkipMerge);
1036   return !Limit || PredFreq <= *Limit;
1037 }
1038 
1039 /// Return true if we can merge BB into DestBB if there is a single
1040 /// unconditional branch between them, and BB contains no other non-phi
1041 /// instructions.
canMergeBlocks(const BasicBlock * BB,const BasicBlock * DestBB) const1042 bool CodeGenPrepare::canMergeBlocks(const BasicBlock *BB,
1043                                     const BasicBlock *DestBB) const {
1044   // We only want to eliminate blocks whose phi nodes are used by phi nodes in
1045   // the successor.  If there are more complex condition (e.g. preheaders),
1046   // don't mess around with them.
1047   for (const PHINode &PN : BB->phis()) {
1048     for (const User *U : PN.users()) {
1049       const Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
1050       if (UI->getParent() != DestBB || !isa<PHINode>(UI))
1051         return false;
1052       // If User is inside DestBB block and it is a PHINode then check
1053       // incoming value. If incoming value is not from BB then this is
1054       // a complex condition (e.g. preheaders) we want to avoid here.
1055       if (UI->getParent() == DestBB) {
1056         if (const PHINode *UPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(UI))
1057           for (unsigned I = 0, E = UPN->getNumIncomingValues(); I != E; ++I) {
1058             Instruction *Insn = dyn_cast<Instruction>(UPN->getIncomingValue(I));
1059             if (Insn && Insn->getParent() == BB &&
1060                 Insn->getParent() != UPN->getIncomingBlock(I))
1061               return false;
1062           }
1063       }
1064     }
1065   }
1066 
1067   // If BB and DestBB contain any common predecessors, then the phi nodes in BB
1068   // and DestBB may have conflicting incoming values for the block.  If so, we
1069   // can't merge the block.
1070   const PHINode *DestBBPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(DestBB->begin());
1071   if (!DestBBPN)
1072     return true; // no conflict.
1073 
1074   // Collect the preds of BB.
1075   SmallPtrSet<const BasicBlock *, 16> BBPreds;
1076   if (const PHINode *BBPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(BB->begin())) {
1077     // It is faster to get preds from a PHI than with pred_iterator.
1078     for (unsigned i = 0, e = BBPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
1079       BBPreds.insert(BBPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
1080   } else {
1081     BBPreds.insert_range(predecessors(BB));
1082   }
1083 
1084   // Walk the preds of DestBB.
1085   for (unsigned i = 0, e = DestBBPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
1086     BasicBlock *Pred = DestBBPN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1087     if (BBPreds.count(Pred)) { // Common predecessor?
1088       for (const PHINode &PN : DestBB->phis()) {
1089         const Value *V1 = PN.getIncomingValueForBlock(Pred);
1090         const Value *V2 = PN.getIncomingValueForBlock(BB);
1091 
1092         // If V2 is a phi node in BB, look up what the mapped value will be.
1093         if (const PHINode *V2PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V2))
1094           if (V2PN->getParent() == BB)
1095             V2 = V2PN->getIncomingValueForBlock(Pred);
1096 
1097         // If there is a conflict, bail out.
1098         if (V1 != V2)
1099           return false;
1100       }
1101     }
1102   }
1103 
1104   return true;
1105 }
1106 
1107 /// Replace all old uses with new ones, and push the updated BBs into FreshBBs.
replaceAllUsesWith(Value * Old,Value * New,SmallSet<BasicBlock *,32> & FreshBBs,bool IsHuge)1108 static void replaceAllUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New,
1109                                SmallSet<BasicBlock *, 32> &FreshBBs,
1110                                bool IsHuge) {
1111   auto *OldI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old);
1112   if (OldI) {
1113     for (Value::user_iterator UI = OldI->user_begin(), E = OldI->user_end();
1114          UI != E; ++UI) {
1115       Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
1116       if (IsHuge)
1117         FreshBBs.insert(User->getParent());
1118     }
1119   }
1120   Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
1121 }
1122 
1123 /// Eliminate a basic block that has only phi's and an unconditional branch in
1124 /// it.
eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BasicBlock * BB)1125 void CodeGenPrepare::eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB) {
1126   BranchInst *BI = cast<BranchInst>(BB->getTerminator());
1127   BasicBlock *DestBB = BI->getSuccessor(0);
1128 
1129   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "MERGING MOSTLY EMPTY BLOCKS - BEFORE:\n"
1130                     << *BB << *DestBB);
1131 
1132   // If the destination block has a single pred, then this is a trivial edge,
1133   // just collapse it.
1134   if (BasicBlock *SinglePred = DestBB->getSinglePredecessor()) {
1135     if (SinglePred != DestBB) {
1136       assert(SinglePred == BB &&
1137              "Single predecessor not the same as predecessor");
1138       // Merge DestBB into SinglePred/BB and delete it.
1139       MergeBlockIntoPredecessor(DestBB);
1140       // Note: BB(=SinglePred) will not be deleted on this path.
1141       // DestBB(=its single successor) is the one that was deleted.
1142       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "AFTER:\n" << *SinglePred << "\n\n\n");
1143 
1144       if (IsHugeFunc) {
1145         // Update FreshBBs to optimize the merged BB.
1146         FreshBBs.insert(SinglePred);
1147         FreshBBs.erase(DestBB);
1148       }
1149       return;
1150     }
1151   }
1152 
1153   // Otherwise, we have multiple predecessors of BB.  Update the PHIs in DestBB
1154   // to handle the new incoming edges it is about to have.
1155   for (PHINode &PN : DestBB->phis()) {
1156     // Remove the incoming value for BB, and remember it.
1157     Value *InVal = PN.removeIncomingValue(BB, false);
1158 
1159     // Two options: either the InVal is a phi node defined in BB or it is some
1160     // value that dominates BB.
1161     PHINode *InValPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(InVal);
1162     if (InValPhi && InValPhi->getParent() == BB) {
1163       // Add all of the input values of the input PHI as inputs of this phi.
1164       for (unsigned i = 0, e = InValPhi->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
1165         PN.addIncoming(InValPhi->getIncomingValue(i),
1166                        InValPhi->getIncomingBlock(i));
1167     } else {
1168       // Otherwise, add one instance of the dominating value for each edge that
1169       // we will be adding.
1170       if (PHINode *BBPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(BB->begin())) {
1171         for (unsigned i = 0, e = BBPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
1172           PN.addIncoming(InVal, BBPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
1173       } else {
1174         for (BasicBlock *Pred : predecessors(BB))
1175           PN.addIncoming(InVal, Pred);
1176       }
1177     }
1178   }
1179 
1180   // Preserve loop Metadata.
1181   if (BI->hasMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_loop)) {
1182     for (auto *Pred : predecessors(BB))
1183       Pred->getTerminator()->copyMetadata(*BI, LLVMContext::MD_loop);
1184   }
1185 
1186   // The PHIs are now updated, change everything that refers to BB to use
1187   // DestBB and remove BB.
1188   BB->replaceAllUsesWith(DestBB);
1189   BB->eraseFromParent();
1190   ++NumBlocksElim;
1191 
1192   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "AFTER:\n" << *DestBB << "\n\n\n");
1193 }
1194 
1195 // Computes a map of base pointer relocation instructions to corresponding
1196 // derived pointer relocation instructions given a vector of all relocate calls
computeBaseDerivedRelocateMap(const SmallVectorImpl<GCRelocateInst * > & AllRelocateCalls,MapVector<GCRelocateInst *,SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *,0>> & RelocateInstMap)1197 static void computeBaseDerivedRelocateMap(
1198     const SmallVectorImpl<GCRelocateInst *> &AllRelocateCalls,
1199     MapVector<GCRelocateInst *, SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *, 0>>
1200         &RelocateInstMap) {
1201   // Collect information in two maps: one primarily for locating the base object
1202   // while filling the second map; the second map is the final structure holding
1203   // a mapping between Base and corresponding Derived relocate calls
1204   MapVector<std::pair<unsigned, unsigned>, GCRelocateInst *> RelocateIdxMap;
1205   for (auto *ThisRelocate : AllRelocateCalls) {
1206     auto K = std::make_pair(ThisRelocate->getBasePtrIndex(),
1207                             ThisRelocate->getDerivedPtrIndex());
1208     RelocateIdxMap.insert(std::make_pair(K, ThisRelocate));
1209   }
1210   for (auto &Item : RelocateIdxMap) {
1211     std::pair<unsigned, unsigned> Key = Item.first;
1212     if (Key.first == Key.second)
1213       // Base relocation: nothing to insert
1214       continue;
1215 
1216     GCRelocateInst *I = Item.second;
1217     auto BaseKey = std::make_pair(Key.first, Key.first);
1218 
1219     // We're iterating over RelocateIdxMap so we cannot modify it.
1220     auto MaybeBase = RelocateIdxMap.find(BaseKey);
1221     if (MaybeBase == RelocateIdxMap.end())
1222       // TODO: We might want to insert a new base object relocate and gep off
1223       // that, if there are enough derived object relocates.
1224       continue;
1225 
1226     RelocateInstMap[MaybeBase->second].push_back(I);
1227   }
1228 }
1229 
1230 // Accepts a GEP and extracts the operands into a vector provided they're all
1231 // small integer constants
getGEPSmallConstantIntOffsetV(GetElementPtrInst * GEP,SmallVectorImpl<Value * > & OffsetV)1232 static bool getGEPSmallConstantIntOffsetV(GetElementPtrInst *GEP,
1233                                           SmallVectorImpl<Value *> &OffsetV) {
1234   for (unsigned i = 1; i < GEP->getNumOperands(); i++) {
1235     // Only accept small constant integer operands
1236     auto *Op = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
1237     if (!Op || Op->getZExtValue() > 20)
1238       return false;
1239   }
1240 
1241   for (unsigned i = 1; i < GEP->getNumOperands(); i++)
1242     OffsetV.push_back(GEP->getOperand(i));
1243   return true;
1244 }
1245 
1246 // Takes a RelocatedBase (base pointer relocation instruction) and Targets to
1247 // replace, computes a replacement, and affects it.
1248 static bool
simplifyRelocatesOffABase(GCRelocateInst * RelocatedBase,const SmallVectorImpl<GCRelocateInst * > & Targets)1249 simplifyRelocatesOffABase(GCRelocateInst *RelocatedBase,
1250                           const SmallVectorImpl<GCRelocateInst *> &Targets) {
1251   bool MadeChange = false;
1252   // We must ensure the relocation of derived pointer is defined after
1253   // relocation of base pointer. If we find a relocation corresponding to base
1254   // defined earlier than relocation of base then we move relocation of base
1255   // right before found relocation. We consider only relocation in the same
1256   // basic block as relocation of base. Relocations from other basic block will
1257   // be skipped by optimization and we do not care about them.
1258   for (auto R = RelocatedBase->getParent()->getFirstInsertionPt();
1259        &*R != RelocatedBase; ++R)
1260     if (auto *RI = dyn_cast<GCRelocateInst>(R))
1261       if (RI->getStatepoint() == RelocatedBase->getStatepoint())
1262         if (RI->getBasePtrIndex() == RelocatedBase->getBasePtrIndex()) {
1263           RelocatedBase->moveBefore(RI->getIterator());
1264           MadeChange = true;
1265           break;
1266         }
1267 
1268   for (GCRelocateInst *ToReplace : Targets) {
1269     assert(ToReplace->getBasePtrIndex() == RelocatedBase->getBasePtrIndex() &&
1270            "Not relocating a derived object of the original base object");
1271     if (ToReplace->getBasePtrIndex() == ToReplace->getDerivedPtrIndex()) {
1272       // A duplicate relocate call. TODO: coalesce duplicates.
1273       continue;
1274     }
1275 
1276     if (RelocatedBase->getParent() != ToReplace->getParent()) {
1277       // Base and derived relocates are in different basic blocks.
1278       // In this case transform is only valid when base dominates derived
1279       // relocate. However it would be too expensive to check dominance
1280       // for each such relocate, so we skip the whole transformation.
1281       continue;
1282     }
1283 
1284     Value *Base = ToReplace->getBasePtr();
1285     auto *Derived = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(ToReplace->getDerivedPtr());
1286     if (!Derived || Derived->getPointerOperand() != Base)
1287       continue;
1288 
1289     SmallVector<Value *, 2> OffsetV;
1290     if (!getGEPSmallConstantIntOffsetV(Derived, OffsetV))
1291       continue;
1292 
1293     // Create a Builder and replace the target callsite with a gep
1294     assert(RelocatedBase->getNextNode() &&
1295            "Should always have one since it's not a terminator");
1296 
1297     // Insert after RelocatedBase
1298     IRBuilder<> Builder(RelocatedBase->getNextNode());
1299     Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(ToReplace->getDebugLoc());
1300 
1301     // If gc_relocate does not match the actual type, cast it to the right type.
1302     // In theory, there must be a bitcast after gc_relocate if the type does not
1303     // match, and we should reuse it to get the derived pointer. But it could be
1304     // cases like this:
1305     // bb1:
1306     //  ...
1307     //  %g1 = call coldcc i8 addrspace(1)*
1308     //  @llvm.experimental.gc.relocate.p1i8(...) br label %merge
1309     //
1310     // bb2:
1311     //  ...
1312     //  %g2 = call coldcc i8 addrspace(1)*
1313     //  @llvm.experimental.gc.relocate.p1i8(...) br label %merge
1314     //
1315     // merge:
1316     //  %p1 = phi i8 addrspace(1)* [ %g1, %bb1 ], [ %g2, %bb2 ]
1317     //  %cast = bitcast i8 addrspace(1)* %p1 in to i32 addrspace(1)*
1318     //
1319     // In this case, we can not find the bitcast any more. So we insert a new
1320     // bitcast no matter there is already one or not. In this way, we can handle
1321     // all cases, and the extra bitcast should be optimized away in later
1322     // passes.
1323     Value *ActualRelocatedBase = RelocatedBase;
1324     if (RelocatedBase->getType() != Base->getType()) {
1325       ActualRelocatedBase =
1326           Builder.CreateBitCast(RelocatedBase, Base->getType());
1327     }
1328     Value *Replacement =
1329         Builder.CreateGEP(Derived->getSourceElementType(), ActualRelocatedBase,
1330                           ArrayRef(OffsetV));
1331     Replacement->takeName(ToReplace);
1332     // If the newly generated derived pointer's type does not match the original
1333     // derived pointer's type, cast the new derived pointer to match it. Same
1334     // reasoning as above.
1335     Value *ActualReplacement = Replacement;
1336     if (Replacement->getType() != ToReplace->getType()) {
1337       ActualReplacement =
1338           Builder.CreateBitCast(Replacement, ToReplace->getType());
1339     }
1340     ToReplace->replaceAllUsesWith(ActualReplacement);
1341     ToReplace->eraseFromParent();
1342 
1343     MadeChange = true;
1344   }
1345   return MadeChange;
1346 }
1347 
1348 // Turns this:
1349 //
1350 // %base = ...
1351 // %ptr = gep %base + 15
1352 // %tok = statepoint (%fun, i32 0, i32 0, i32 0, %base, %ptr)
1353 // %base' = relocate(%tok, i32 4, i32 4)
1354 // %ptr' = relocate(%tok, i32 4, i32 5)
1355 // %val = load %ptr'
1356 //
1357 // into this:
1358 //
1359 // %base = ...
1360 // %ptr = gep %base + 15
1361 // %tok = statepoint (%fun, i32 0, i32 0, i32 0, %base, %ptr)
1362 // %base' = gc.relocate(%tok, i32 4, i32 4)
1363 // %ptr' = gep %base' + 15
1364 // %val = load %ptr'
simplifyOffsetableRelocate(GCStatepointInst & I)1365 bool CodeGenPrepare::simplifyOffsetableRelocate(GCStatepointInst &I) {
1366   bool MadeChange = false;
1367   SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *, 2> AllRelocateCalls;
1368   for (auto *U : I.users())
1369     if (GCRelocateInst *Relocate = dyn_cast<GCRelocateInst>(U))
1370       // Collect all the relocate calls associated with a statepoint
1371       AllRelocateCalls.push_back(Relocate);
1372 
1373   // We need at least one base pointer relocation + one derived pointer
1374   // relocation to mangle
1375   if (AllRelocateCalls.size() < 2)
1376     return false;
1377 
1378   // RelocateInstMap is a mapping from the base relocate instruction to the
1379   // corresponding derived relocate instructions
1380   MapVector<GCRelocateInst *, SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *, 0>> RelocateInstMap;
1381   computeBaseDerivedRelocateMap(AllRelocateCalls, RelocateInstMap);
1382   if (RelocateInstMap.empty())
1383     return false;
1384 
1385   for (auto &Item : RelocateInstMap)
1386     // Item.first is the RelocatedBase to offset against
1387     // Item.second is the vector of Targets to replace
1388     MadeChange = simplifyRelocatesOffABase(Item.first, Item.second);
1389   return MadeChange;
1390 }
1391 
1392 /// Sink the specified cast instruction into its user blocks.
SinkCast(CastInst * CI)1393 static bool SinkCast(CastInst *CI) {
1394   BasicBlock *DefBB = CI->getParent();
1395 
1396   /// InsertedCasts - Only insert a cast in each block once.
1397   DenseMap<BasicBlock *, CastInst *> InsertedCasts;
1398 
1399   bool MadeChange = false;
1400   for (Value::user_iterator UI = CI->user_begin(), E = CI->user_end();
1401        UI != E;) {
1402     Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
1403     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
1404 
1405     // Figure out which BB this cast is used in.  For PHI's this is the
1406     // appropriate predecessor block.
1407     BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
1408     if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(User)) {
1409       UserBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(TheUse);
1410     }
1411 
1412     // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
1413     ++UI;
1414 
1415     // The first insertion point of a block containing an EH pad is after the
1416     // pad.  If the pad is the user, we cannot sink the cast past the pad.
1417     if (User->isEHPad())
1418       continue;
1419 
1420     // If the block selected to receive the cast is an EH pad that does not
1421     // allow non-PHI instructions before the terminator, we can't sink the
1422     // cast.
1423     if (UserBB->getTerminator()->isEHPad())
1424       continue;
1425 
1426     // If this user is in the same block as the cast, don't change the cast.
1427     if (UserBB == DefBB)
1428       continue;
1429 
1430     // If we have already inserted a cast into this block, use it.
1431     CastInst *&InsertedCast = InsertedCasts[UserBB];
1432 
1433     if (!InsertedCast) {
1434       BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
1435       assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
1436       InsertedCast = cast<CastInst>(CI->clone());
1437       InsertedCast->insertBefore(*UserBB, InsertPt);
1438     }
1439 
1440     // Replace a use of the cast with a use of the new cast.
1441     TheUse = InsertedCast;
1442     MadeChange = true;
1443     ++NumCastUses;
1444   }
1445 
1446   // If we removed all uses, nuke the cast.
1447   if (CI->use_empty()) {
1448     salvageDebugInfo(*CI);
1449     CI->eraseFromParent();
1450     MadeChange = true;
1451   }
1452 
1453   return MadeChange;
1454 }
1455 
1456 /// If the specified cast instruction is a noop copy (e.g. it's casting from
1457 /// one pointer type to another, i32->i8 on PPC), sink it into user blocks to
1458 /// reduce the number of virtual registers that must be created and coalesced.
1459 ///
1460 /// Return true if any changes are made.
OptimizeNoopCopyExpression(CastInst * CI,const TargetLowering & TLI,const DataLayout & DL)1461 static bool OptimizeNoopCopyExpression(CastInst *CI, const TargetLowering &TLI,
1462                                        const DataLayout &DL) {
1463   // Sink only "cheap" (or nop) address-space casts.  This is a weaker condition
1464   // than sinking only nop casts, but is helpful on some platforms.
1465   if (auto *ASC = dyn_cast<AddrSpaceCastInst>(CI)) {
1466     if (!TLI.isFreeAddrSpaceCast(ASC->getSrcAddressSpace(),
1467                                  ASC->getDestAddressSpace()))
1468       return false;
1469   }
1470 
1471   // If this is a noop copy,
1472   EVT SrcVT = TLI.getValueType(DL, CI->getOperand(0)->getType());
1473   EVT DstVT = TLI.getValueType(DL, CI->getType());
1474 
1475   // This is an fp<->int conversion?
1476   if (SrcVT.isInteger() != DstVT.isInteger())
1477     return false;
1478 
1479   // If this is an extension, it will be a zero or sign extension, which
1480   // isn't a noop.
1481   if (SrcVT.bitsLT(DstVT))
1482     return false;
1483 
1484   // If these values will be promoted, find out what they will be promoted
1485   // to.  This helps us consider truncates on PPC as noop copies when they
1486   // are.
1487   if (TLI.getTypeAction(CI->getContext(), SrcVT) ==
1488       TargetLowering::TypePromoteInteger)
1489     SrcVT = TLI.getTypeToTransformTo(CI->getContext(), SrcVT);
1490   if (TLI.getTypeAction(CI->getContext(), DstVT) ==
1491       TargetLowering::TypePromoteInteger)
1492     DstVT = TLI.getTypeToTransformTo(CI->getContext(), DstVT);
1493 
1494   // If, after promotion, these are the same types, this is a noop copy.
1495   if (SrcVT != DstVT)
1496     return false;
1497 
1498   return SinkCast(CI);
1499 }
1500 
1501 // Match a simple increment by constant operation.  Note that if a sub is
1502 // matched, the step is negated (as if the step had been canonicalized to
1503 // an add, even though we leave the instruction alone.)
matchIncrement(const Instruction * IVInc,Instruction * & LHS,Constant * & Step)1504 static bool matchIncrement(const Instruction *IVInc, Instruction *&LHS,
1505                            Constant *&Step) {
1506   if (match(IVInc, m_Add(m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step))) ||
1507       match(IVInc, m_ExtractValue<0>(m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow>(
1508                        m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step)))))
1509     return true;
1510   if (match(IVInc, m_Sub(m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step))) ||
1511       match(IVInc, m_ExtractValue<0>(m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow>(
1512                        m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step))))) {
1513     Step = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Step);
1514     return true;
1515   }
1516   return false;
1517 }
1518 
1519 /// If given \p PN is an inductive variable with value IVInc coming from the
1520 /// backedge, and on each iteration it gets increased by Step, return pair
1521 /// <IVInc, Step>. Otherwise, return std::nullopt.
1522 static std::optional<std::pair<Instruction *, Constant *>>
getIVIncrement(const PHINode * PN,const LoopInfo * LI)1523 getIVIncrement(const PHINode *PN, const LoopInfo *LI) {
1524   const Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(PN->getParent());
1525   if (!L || L->getHeader() != PN->getParent() || !L->getLoopLatch())
1526     return std::nullopt;
1527   auto *IVInc =
1528       dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN->getIncomingValueForBlock(L->getLoopLatch()));
1529   if (!IVInc || LI->getLoopFor(IVInc->getParent()) != L)
1530     return std::nullopt;
1531   Instruction *LHS = nullptr;
1532   Constant *Step = nullptr;
1533   if (matchIncrement(IVInc, LHS, Step) && LHS == PN)
1534     return std::make_pair(IVInc, Step);
1535   return std::nullopt;
1536 }
1537 
isIVIncrement(const Value * V,const LoopInfo * LI)1538 static bool isIVIncrement(const Value *V, const LoopInfo *LI) {
1539   auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1540   if (!I)
1541     return false;
1542   Instruction *LHS = nullptr;
1543   Constant *Step = nullptr;
1544   if (!matchIncrement(I, LHS, Step))
1545     return false;
1546   if (auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(LHS))
1547     if (auto IVInc = getIVIncrement(PN, LI))
1548       return IVInc->first == I;
1549   return false;
1550 }
1551 
replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(BinaryOperator * BO,Value * Arg0,Value * Arg1,CmpInst * Cmp,Intrinsic::ID IID)1552 bool CodeGenPrepare::replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(BinaryOperator *BO,
1553                                                  Value *Arg0, Value *Arg1,
1554                                                  CmpInst *Cmp,
1555                                                  Intrinsic::ID IID) {
1556   auto IsReplacableIVIncrement = [this, &Cmp](BinaryOperator *BO) {
1557     if (!isIVIncrement(BO, LI))
1558       return false;
1559     const Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(BO->getParent());
1560     assert(L && "L should not be null after isIVIncrement()");
1561     // Do not risk on moving increment into a child loop.
1562     if (LI->getLoopFor(Cmp->getParent()) != L)
1563       return false;
1564 
1565     // Finally, we need to ensure that the insert point will dominate all
1566     // existing uses of the increment.
1567 
1568     auto &DT = getDT(*BO->getParent()->getParent());
1569     if (DT.dominates(Cmp->getParent(), BO->getParent()))
1570       // If we're moving up the dom tree, all uses are trivially dominated.
1571       // (This is the common case for code produced by LSR.)
1572       return true;
1573 
1574     // Otherwise, special case the single use in the phi recurrence.
1575     return BO->hasOneUse() && DT.dominates(Cmp->getParent(), L->getLoopLatch());
1576   };
1577   if (BO->getParent() != Cmp->getParent() && !IsReplacableIVIncrement(BO)) {
1578     // We used to use a dominator tree here to allow multi-block optimization.
1579     // But that was problematic because:
1580     // 1. It could cause a perf regression by hoisting the math op into the
1581     //    critical path.
1582     // 2. It could cause a perf regression by creating a value that was live
1583     //    across multiple blocks and increasing register pressure.
1584     // 3. Use of a dominator tree could cause large compile-time regression.
1585     //    This is because we recompute the DT on every change in the main CGP
1586     //    run-loop. The recomputing is probably unnecessary in many cases, so if
1587     //    that was fixed, using a DT here would be ok.
1588     //
1589     // There is one important particular case we still want to handle: if BO is
1590     // the IV increment. Important properties that make it profitable:
1591     // - We can speculate IV increment anywhere in the loop (as long as the
1592     //   indvar Phi is its only user);
1593     // - Upon computing Cmp, we effectively compute something equivalent to the
1594     //   IV increment (despite it loops differently in the IR). So moving it up
1595     //   to the cmp point does not really increase register pressure.
1596     return false;
1597   }
1598 
1599   // We allow matching the canonical IR (add X, C) back to (usubo X, -C).
1600   if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
1601       IID == Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow) {
1602     assert(isa<Constant>(Arg1) && "Unexpected input for usubo");
1603     Arg1 = ConstantExpr::getNeg(cast<Constant>(Arg1));
1604   }
1605 
1606   // Insert at the first instruction of the pair.
1607   Instruction *InsertPt = nullptr;
1608   for (Instruction &Iter : *Cmp->getParent()) {
1609     // If BO is an XOR, it is not guaranteed that it comes after both inputs to
1610     // the overflow intrinsic are defined.
1611     if ((BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::Xor && &Iter == BO) || &Iter == Cmp) {
1612       InsertPt = &Iter;
1613       break;
1614     }
1615   }
1616   assert(InsertPt != nullptr && "Parent block did not contain cmp or binop");
1617 
1618   IRBuilder<> Builder(InsertPt);
1619   Value *MathOV = Builder.CreateBinaryIntrinsic(IID, Arg0, Arg1);
1620   if (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::Xor) {
1621     Value *Math = Builder.CreateExtractValue(MathOV, 0, "math");
1622     replaceAllUsesWith(BO, Math, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
1623   } else
1624     assert(BO->hasOneUse() &&
1625            "Patterns with XOr should use the BO only in the compare");
1626   Value *OV = Builder.CreateExtractValue(MathOV, 1, "ov");
1627   replaceAllUsesWith(Cmp, OV, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
1628   Cmp->eraseFromParent();
1629   BO->eraseFromParent();
1630   return true;
1631 }
1632 
1633 /// Match special-case patterns that check for unsigned add overflow.
matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases(CmpInst * Cmp,BinaryOperator * & Add)1634 static bool matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases(CmpInst *Cmp,
1635                                                    BinaryOperator *&Add) {
1636   // Add = add A, 1; Cmp = icmp eq A,-1 (overflow if A is max val)
1637   // Add = add A,-1; Cmp = icmp ne A, 0 (overflow if A is non-zero)
1638   Value *A = Cmp->getOperand(0), *B = Cmp->getOperand(1);
1639 
1640   // We are not expecting non-canonical/degenerate code. Just bail out.
1641   if (isa<Constant>(A))
1642     return false;
1643 
1644   ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = Cmp->getPredicate();
1645   if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ && match(B, m_AllOnes()))
1646     B = ConstantInt::get(B->getType(), 1);
1647   else if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && match(B, m_ZeroInt()))
1648     B = Constant::getAllOnesValue(B->getType());
1649   else
1650     return false;
1651 
1652   // Check the users of the variable operand of the compare looking for an add
1653   // with the adjusted constant.
1654   for (User *U : A->users()) {
1655     if (match(U, m_Add(m_Specific(A), m_Specific(B)))) {
1656       Add = cast<BinaryOperator>(U);
1657       return true;
1658     }
1659   }
1660   return false;
1661 }
1662 
1663 /// Try to combine the compare into a call to the llvm.uadd.with.overflow
1664 /// intrinsic. Return true if any changes were made.
combineToUAddWithOverflow(CmpInst * Cmp,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)1665 bool CodeGenPrepare::combineToUAddWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp,
1666                                                ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
1667   bool EdgeCase = false;
1668   Value *A, *B;
1669   BinaryOperator *Add;
1670   if (!match(Cmp, m_UAddWithOverflow(m_Value(A), m_Value(B), m_BinOp(Add)))) {
1671     if (!matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases(Cmp, Add))
1672       return false;
1673     // Set A and B in case we match matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases.
1674     A = Add->getOperand(0);
1675     B = Add->getOperand(1);
1676     EdgeCase = true;
1677   }
1678 
1679   if (!TLI->shouldFormOverflowOp(ISD::UADDO,
1680                                  TLI->getValueType(*DL, Add->getType()),
1681                                  Add->hasNUsesOrMore(EdgeCase ? 1 : 2)))
1682     return false;
1683 
1684   // We don't want to move around uses of condition values this late, so we
1685   // check if it is legal to create the call to the intrinsic in the basic
1686   // block containing the icmp.
1687   if (Add->getParent() != Cmp->getParent() && !Add->hasOneUse())
1688     return false;
1689 
1690   if (!replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(Add, A, B, Cmp,
1691                                    Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow))
1692     return false;
1693 
1694   // Reset callers - do not crash by iterating over a dead instruction.
1695   ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::ModifyInstDT;
1696   return true;
1697 }
1698 
combineToUSubWithOverflow(CmpInst * Cmp,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)1699 bool CodeGenPrepare::combineToUSubWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp,
1700                                                ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
1701   // We are not expecting non-canonical/degenerate code. Just bail out.
1702   Value *A = Cmp->getOperand(0), *B = Cmp->getOperand(1);
1703   if (isa<Constant>(A) && isa<Constant>(B))
1704     return false;
1705 
1706   // Convert (A u> B) to (A u< B) to simplify pattern matching.
1707   ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = Cmp->getPredicate();
1708   if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT) {
1709     std::swap(A, B);
1710     Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
1711   }
1712   // Convert special-case: (A == 0) is the same as (A u< 1).
1713   if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ && match(B, m_ZeroInt())) {
1714     B = ConstantInt::get(B->getType(), 1);
1715     Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
1716   }
1717   // Convert special-case: (A != 0) is the same as (0 u< A).
1718   if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && match(B, m_ZeroInt())) {
1719     std::swap(A, B);
1720     Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
1721   }
1722   if (Pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT)
1723     return false;
1724 
1725   // Walk the users of a variable operand of a compare looking for a subtract or
1726   // add with that same operand. Also match the 2nd operand of the compare to
1727   // the add/sub, but that may be a negated constant operand of an add.
1728   Value *CmpVariableOperand = isa<Constant>(A) ? B : A;
1729   BinaryOperator *Sub = nullptr;
1730   for (User *U : CmpVariableOperand->users()) {
1731     // A - B, A u< B --> usubo(A, B)
1732     if (match(U, m_Sub(m_Specific(A), m_Specific(B)))) {
1733       Sub = cast<BinaryOperator>(U);
1734       break;
1735     }
1736 
1737     // A + (-C), A u< C (canonicalized form of (sub A, C))
1738     const APInt *CmpC, *AddC;
1739     if (match(U, m_Add(m_Specific(A), m_APInt(AddC))) &&
1740         match(B, m_APInt(CmpC)) && *AddC == -(*CmpC)) {
1741       Sub = cast<BinaryOperator>(U);
1742       break;
1743     }
1744   }
1745   if (!Sub)
1746     return false;
1747 
1748   if (!TLI->shouldFormOverflowOp(ISD::USUBO,
1749                                  TLI->getValueType(*DL, Sub->getType()),
1750                                  Sub->hasNUsesOrMore(1)))
1751     return false;
1752 
1753   if (!replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(Sub, Sub->getOperand(0), Sub->getOperand(1),
1754                                    Cmp, Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow))
1755     return false;
1756 
1757   // Reset callers - do not crash by iterating over a dead instruction.
1758   ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::ModifyInstDT;
1759   return true;
1760 }
1761 
1762 // Decanonicalizes icmp+ctpop power-of-two test if ctpop is slow.
1763 // The same transformation exists in DAG combiner, but we repeat it here because
1764 // DAG builder can break the pattern by moving icmp into a successor block.
unfoldPowerOf2Test(CmpInst * Cmp)1765 bool CodeGenPrepare::unfoldPowerOf2Test(CmpInst *Cmp) {
1766   CmpPredicate Pred;
1767   Value *X;
1768   const APInt *C;
1769 
1770   // (icmp (ctpop x), c)
1771   if (!match(Cmp, m_ICmp(Pred, m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::ctpop>(m_Value(X)),
1772                          m_APIntAllowPoison(C))))
1773     return false;
1774 
1775   // We're only interested in "is power of 2 [or zero]" patterns.
1776   bool IsStrictlyPowerOf2Test = ICmpInst::isEquality(Pred) && *C == 1;
1777   bool IsPowerOf2OrZeroTest = (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_ULT && *C == 2) ||
1778                               (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_UGT && *C == 1);
1779   if (!IsStrictlyPowerOf2Test && !IsPowerOf2OrZeroTest)
1780     return false;
1781 
1782   // Some targets have better codegen for `ctpop(x) u</u>= 2/1`than for
1783   // `ctpop(x) ==/!= 1`. If ctpop is fast, only try changing the comparison,
1784   // and otherwise expand ctpop into a few simple instructions.
1785   Type *OpTy = X->getType();
1786   if (TLI->isCtpopFast(TLI->getValueType(*DL, OpTy))) {
1787     // Look for `ctpop(x) ==/!= 1`, where `ctpop(x)` is known to be non-zero.
1788     if (!IsStrictlyPowerOf2Test || !isKnownNonZero(Cmp->getOperand(0), *DL))
1789       return false;
1790 
1791     // ctpop(x) == 1 -> ctpop(x) u< 2
1792     // ctpop(x) != 1 -> ctpop(x) u> 1
1793     if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ) {
1794       Cmp->setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(OpTy, 2));
1795       Cmp->setPredicate(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
1796     } else {
1797       Cmp->setPredicate(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
1798     }
1799     return true;
1800   }
1801 
1802   Value *NewCmp;
1803   if (IsPowerOf2OrZeroTest ||
1804       (IsStrictlyPowerOf2Test && isKnownNonZero(Cmp->getOperand(0), *DL))) {
1805     // ctpop(x) u< 2 -> (x & (x - 1)) == 0
1806     // ctpop(x) u> 1 -> (x & (x - 1)) != 0
1807     IRBuilder<> Builder(Cmp);
1808     Value *Sub = Builder.CreateAdd(X, Constant::getAllOnesValue(OpTy));
1809     Value *And = Builder.CreateAnd(X, Sub);
1810     CmpInst::Predicate NewPred =
1811         (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_ULT || Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
1812             ? CmpInst::ICMP_EQ
1813             : CmpInst::ICMP_NE;
1814     NewCmp = Builder.CreateICmp(NewPred, And, ConstantInt::getNullValue(OpTy));
1815   } else {
1816     // ctpop(x) == 1 -> (x ^ (x - 1)) u> (x - 1)
1817     // ctpop(x) != 1 -> (x ^ (x - 1)) u<= (x - 1)
1818     IRBuilder<> Builder(Cmp);
1819     Value *Sub = Builder.CreateAdd(X, Constant::getAllOnesValue(OpTy));
1820     Value *Xor = Builder.CreateXor(X, Sub);
1821     CmpInst::Predicate NewPred =
1822         Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_EQ ? CmpInst::ICMP_UGT : CmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
1823     NewCmp = Builder.CreateICmp(NewPred, Xor, Sub);
1824   }
1825 
1826   Cmp->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCmp);
1827   RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(Cmp);
1828   return true;
1829 }
1830 
1831 /// Sink the given CmpInst into user blocks to reduce the number of virtual
1832 /// registers that must be created and coalesced. This is a clear win except on
1833 /// targets with multiple condition code registers (PowerPC), where it might
1834 /// lose; some adjustment may be wanted there.
1835 ///
1836 /// Return true if any changes are made.
sinkCmpExpression(CmpInst * Cmp,const TargetLowering & TLI)1837 static bool sinkCmpExpression(CmpInst *Cmp, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
1838   if (TLI.hasMultipleConditionRegisters())
1839     return false;
1840 
1841   // Avoid sinking soft-FP comparisons, since this can move them into a loop.
1842   if (TLI.useSoftFloat() && isa<FCmpInst>(Cmp))
1843     return false;
1844 
1845   // Only insert a cmp in each block once.
1846   DenseMap<BasicBlock *, CmpInst *> InsertedCmps;
1847 
1848   bool MadeChange = false;
1849   for (Value::user_iterator UI = Cmp->user_begin(), E = Cmp->user_end();
1850        UI != E;) {
1851     Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
1852     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
1853 
1854     // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
1855     ++UI;
1856 
1857     // Don't bother for PHI nodes.
1858     if (isa<PHINode>(User))
1859       continue;
1860 
1861     // Figure out which BB this cmp is used in.
1862     BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
1863     BasicBlock *DefBB = Cmp->getParent();
1864 
1865     // If this user is in the same block as the cmp, don't change the cmp.
1866     if (UserBB == DefBB)
1867       continue;
1868 
1869     // If we have already inserted a cmp into this block, use it.
1870     CmpInst *&InsertedCmp = InsertedCmps[UserBB];
1871 
1872     if (!InsertedCmp) {
1873       BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
1874       assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
1875       InsertedCmp = CmpInst::Create(Cmp->getOpcode(), Cmp->getPredicate(),
1876                                     Cmp->getOperand(0), Cmp->getOperand(1), "");
1877       InsertedCmp->insertBefore(*UserBB, InsertPt);
1878       // Propagate the debug info.
1879       InsertedCmp->setDebugLoc(Cmp->getDebugLoc());
1880     }
1881 
1882     // Replace a use of the cmp with a use of the new cmp.
1883     TheUse = InsertedCmp;
1884     MadeChange = true;
1885     ++NumCmpUses;
1886   }
1887 
1888   // If we removed all uses, nuke the cmp.
1889   if (Cmp->use_empty()) {
1890     Cmp->eraseFromParent();
1891     MadeChange = true;
1892   }
1893 
1894   return MadeChange;
1895 }
1896 
1897 /// For pattern like:
1898 ///
1899 ///   DomCond = icmp sgt/slt CmpOp0, CmpOp1 (might not be in DomBB)
1900 ///   ...
1901 /// DomBB:
1902 ///   ...
1903 ///   br DomCond, TrueBB, CmpBB
1904 /// CmpBB: (with DomBB being the single predecessor)
1905 ///   ...
1906 ///   Cmp = icmp eq CmpOp0, CmpOp1
1907 ///   ...
1908 ///
1909 /// It would use two comparison on targets that lowering of icmp sgt/slt is
1910 /// different from lowering of icmp eq (PowerPC). This function try to convert
1911 /// 'Cmp = icmp eq CmpOp0, CmpOp1' to ' Cmp = icmp slt/sgt CmpOp0, CmpOp1'.
1912 /// After that, DomCond and Cmp can use the same comparison so reduce one
1913 /// comparison.
1914 ///
1915 /// Return true if any changes are made.
foldICmpWithDominatingICmp(CmpInst * Cmp,const TargetLowering & TLI)1916 static bool foldICmpWithDominatingICmp(CmpInst *Cmp,
1917                                        const TargetLowering &TLI) {
1918   if (!EnableICMP_EQToICMP_ST && TLI.isEqualityCmpFoldedWithSignedCmp())
1919     return false;
1920 
1921   ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = Cmp->getPredicate();
1922   if (Pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
1923     return false;
1924 
1925   // If icmp eq has users other than BranchInst and SelectInst, converting it to
1926   // icmp slt/sgt would introduce more redundant LLVM IR.
1927   for (User *U : Cmp->users()) {
1928     if (isa<BranchInst>(U))
1929       continue;
1930     if (isa<SelectInst>(U) && cast<SelectInst>(U)->getCondition() == Cmp)
1931       continue;
1932     return false;
1933   }
1934 
1935   // This is a cheap/incomplete check for dominance - just match a single
1936   // predecessor with a conditional branch.
1937   BasicBlock *CmpBB = Cmp->getParent();
1938   BasicBlock *DomBB = CmpBB->getSinglePredecessor();
1939   if (!DomBB)
1940     return false;
1941 
1942   // We want to ensure that the only way control gets to the comparison of
1943   // interest is that a less/greater than comparison on the same operands is
1944   // false.
1945   Value *DomCond;
1946   BasicBlock *TrueBB, *FalseBB;
1947   if (!match(DomBB->getTerminator(), m_Br(m_Value(DomCond), TrueBB, FalseBB)))
1948     return false;
1949   if (CmpBB != FalseBB)
1950     return false;
1951 
1952   Value *CmpOp0 = Cmp->getOperand(0), *CmpOp1 = Cmp->getOperand(1);
1953   CmpPredicate DomPred;
1954   if (!match(DomCond, m_ICmp(DomPred, m_Specific(CmpOp0), m_Specific(CmpOp1))))
1955     return false;
1956   if (DomPred != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && DomPred != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
1957     return false;
1958 
1959   // Convert the equality comparison to the opposite of the dominating
1960   // comparison and swap the direction for all branch/select users.
1961   // We have conceptually converted:
1962   // Res = (a < b) ? <LT_RES> : (a == b) ? <EQ_RES> : <GT_RES>;
1963   // to
1964   // Res = (a < b) ? <LT_RES> : (a > b)  ? <GT_RES> : <EQ_RES>;
1965   // And similarly for branches.
1966   for (User *U : Cmp->users()) {
1967     if (auto *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(U)) {
1968       assert(BI->isConditional() && "Must be conditional");
1969       BI->swapSuccessors();
1970       continue;
1971     }
1972     if (auto *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(U)) {
1973       // Swap operands
1974       SI->swapValues();
1975       SI->swapProfMetadata();
1976       continue;
1977     }
1978     llvm_unreachable("Must be a branch or a select");
1979   }
1980   Cmp->setPredicate(CmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(DomPred));
1981   return true;
1982 }
1983 
1984 /// Many architectures use the same instruction for both subtract and cmp. Try
1985 /// to swap cmp operands to match subtract operations to allow for CSE.
swapICmpOperandsToExposeCSEOpportunities(CmpInst * Cmp)1986 static bool swapICmpOperandsToExposeCSEOpportunities(CmpInst *Cmp) {
1987   Value *Op0 = Cmp->getOperand(0);
1988   Value *Op1 = Cmp->getOperand(1);
1989   if (!Op0->getType()->isIntegerTy() || isa<Constant>(Op0) ||
1990       isa<Constant>(Op1) || Op0 == Op1)
1991     return false;
1992 
1993   // If a subtract already has the same operands as a compare, swapping would be
1994   // bad. If a subtract has the same operands as a compare but in reverse order,
1995   // then swapping is good.
1996   int GoodToSwap = 0;
1997   unsigned NumInspected = 0;
1998   for (const User *U : Op0->users()) {
1999     // Avoid walking many users.
2000     if (++NumInspected > 128)
2001       return false;
2002     if (match(U, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op1), m_Specific(Op0))))
2003       GoodToSwap++;
2004     else if (match(U, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op0), m_Specific(Op1))))
2005       GoodToSwap--;
2006   }
2007 
2008   if (GoodToSwap > 0) {
2009     Cmp->swapOperands();
2010     return true;
2011   }
2012   return false;
2013 }
2014 
foldFCmpToFPClassTest(CmpInst * Cmp,const TargetLowering & TLI,const DataLayout & DL)2015 static bool foldFCmpToFPClassTest(CmpInst *Cmp, const TargetLowering &TLI,
2016                                   const DataLayout &DL) {
2017   FCmpInst *FCmp = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Cmp);
2018   if (!FCmp)
2019     return false;
2020 
2021   // Don't fold if the target offers free fabs and the predicate is legal.
2022   EVT VT = TLI.getValueType(DL, Cmp->getOperand(0)->getType());
2023   if (TLI.isFAbsFree(VT) &&
2024       TLI.isCondCodeLegal(getFCmpCondCode(FCmp->getPredicate()),
2025                           VT.getSimpleVT()))
2026     return false;
2027 
2028   // Reverse the canonicalization if it is a FP class test
2029   auto ShouldReverseTransform = [](FPClassTest ClassTest) {
2030     return ClassTest == fcInf || ClassTest == (fcInf | fcNan);
2031   };
2032   auto [ClassVal, ClassTest] =
2033       fcmpToClassTest(FCmp->getPredicate(), *FCmp->getParent()->getParent(),
2034                       FCmp->getOperand(0), FCmp->getOperand(1));
2035   if (!ClassVal)
2036     return false;
2037 
2038   if (!ShouldReverseTransform(ClassTest) && !ShouldReverseTransform(~ClassTest))
2039     return false;
2040 
2041   IRBuilder<> Builder(Cmp);
2042   Value *IsFPClass = Builder.createIsFPClass(ClassVal, ClassTest);
2043   Cmp->replaceAllUsesWith(IsFPClass);
2044   RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(Cmp);
2045   return true;
2046 }
2047 
isRemOfLoopIncrementWithLoopInvariant(Instruction * Rem,const LoopInfo * LI,Value * & RemAmtOut,Value * & AddInstOut,Value * & AddOffsetOut,PHINode * & LoopIncrPNOut)2048 static bool isRemOfLoopIncrementWithLoopInvariant(
2049     Instruction *Rem, const LoopInfo *LI, Value *&RemAmtOut, Value *&AddInstOut,
2050     Value *&AddOffsetOut, PHINode *&LoopIncrPNOut) {
2051   Value *Incr, *RemAmt;
2052   // NB: If RemAmt is a power of 2 it *should* have been transformed by now.
2053   if (!match(Rem, m_URem(m_Value(Incr), m_Value(RemAmt))))
2054     return false;
2055 
2056   Value *AddInst, *AddOffset;
2057   // Find out loop increment PHI.
2058   auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Incr);
2059   if (PN != nullptr) {
2060     AddInst = nullptr;
2061     AddOffset = nullptr;
2062   } else {
2063     // Search through a NUW add on top of the loop increment.
2064     Value *V0, *V1;
2065     if (!match(Incr, m_NUWAdd(m_Value(V0), m_Value(V1))))
2066       return false;
2067 
2068     AddInst = Incr;
2069     PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V0);
2070     if (PN != nullptr) {
2071       AddOffset = V1;
2072     } else {
2073       PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V1);
2074       AddOffset = V0;
2075     }
2076   }
2077 
2078   if (!PN)
2079     return false;
2080 
2081   // This isn't strictly necessary, what we really need is one increment and any
2082   // amount of initial values all being the same.
2083   if (PN->getNumIncomingValues() != 2)
2084     return false;
2085 
2086   // Only trivially analyzable loops.
2087   Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(PN->getParent());
2088   if (!L || !L->getLoopPreheader() || !L->getLoopLatch())
2089     return false;
2090 
2091   // Req that the remainder is in the loop
2092   if (!L->contains(Rem))
2093     return false;
2094 
2095   // Only works if the remainder amount is a loop invaraint
2096   if (!L->isLoopInvariant(RemAmt))
2097     return false;
2098 
2099   // Only works if the AddOffset is a loop invaraint
2100   if (AddOffset && !L->isLoopInvariant(AddOffset))
2101     return false;
2102 
2103   // Is the PHI a loop increment?
2104   auto LoopIncrInfo = getIVIncrement(PN, LI);
2105   if (!LoopIncrInfo)
2106     return false;
2107 
2108   // We need remainder_amount % increment_amount to be zero. Increment of one
2109   // satisfies that without any special logic and is overwhelmingly the common
2110   // case.
2111   if (!match(LoopIncrInfo->second, m_One()))
2112     return false;
2113 
2114   // Need the increment to not overflow.
2115   if (!match(LoopIncrInfo->first, m_c_NUWAdd(m_Specific(PN), m_Value())))
2116     return false;
2117 
2118   // Set output variables.
2119   RemAmtOut = RemAmt;
2120   LoopIncrPNOut = PN;
2121   AddInstOut = AddInst;
2122   AddOffsetOut = AddOffset;
2123 
2124   return true;
2125 }
2126 
2127 // Try to transform:
2128 //
2129 // for(i = Start; i < End; ++i)
2130 //    Rem = (i nuw+ IncrLoopInvariant) u% RemAmtLoopInvariant;
2131 //
2132 // ->
2133 //
2134 // Rem = (Start nuw+ IncrLoopInvariant) % RemAmtLoopInvariant;
2135 // for(i = Start; i < End; ++i, ++rem)
2136 //    Rem = rem == RemAmtLoopInvariant ? 0 : Rem;
foldURemOfLoopIncrement(Instruction * Rem,const DataLayout * DL,const LoopInfo * LI,SmallSet<BasicBlock *,32> & FreshBBs,bool IsHuge)2137 static bool foldURemOfLoopIncrement(Instruction *Rem, const DataLayout *DL,
2138                                     const LoopInfo *LI,
2139                                     SmallSet<BasicBlock *, 32> &FreshBBs,
2140                                     bool IsHuge) {
2141   Value *AddOffset, *RemAmt, *AddInst;
2142   PHINode *LoopIncrPN;
2143   if (!isRemOfLoopIncrementWithLoopInvariant(Rem, LI, RemAmt, AddInst,
2144                                              AddOffset, LoopIncrPN))
2145     return false;
2146 
2147   // Only non-constant remainder as the extra IV is probably not profitable
2148   // in that case.
2149   //
2150   // Potential TODO(1): `urem` of a const ends up as `mul` + `shift` + `add`. If
2151   // we can rule out register pressure and ensure this `urem` is executed each
2152   // iteration, its probably profitable to handle the const case as well.
2153   //
2154   // Potential TODO(2): Should we have a check for how "nested" this remainder
2155   // operation is? The new code runs every iteration so if the remainder is
2156   // guarded behind unlikely conditions this might not be worth it.
2157   if (match(RemAmt, m_ImmConstant()))
2158     return false;
2159 
2160   Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(LoopIncrPN->getParent());
2161   Value *Start = LoopIncrPN->getIncomingValueForBlock(L->getLoopPreheader());
2162   // If we have add create initial value for remainder.
2163   // The logic here is:
2164   // (urem (add nuw Start, IncrLoopInvariant), RemAmtLoopInvariant
2165   //
2166   // Only proceed if the expression simplifies (otherwise we can't fully
2167   // optimize out the urem).
2168   if (AddInst) {
2169     assert(AddOffset && "We found an add but missing values");
2170     // Without dom-condition/assumption cache we aren't likely to get much out
2171     // of a context instruction.
2172     Start = simplifyAddInst(Start, AddOffset,
2173                             match(AddInst, m_NSWAdd(m_Value(), m_Value())),
2174                             /*IsNUW=*/true, *DL);
2175     if (!Start)
2176       return false;
2177   }
2178 
2179   // If we can't fully optimize out the `rem`, skip this transform.
2180   Start = simplifyURemInst(Start, RemAmt, *DL);
2181   if (!Start)
2182     return false;
2183 
2184   // Create new remainder with induction variable.
2185   Type *Ty = Rem->getType();
2186   IRBuilder<> Builder(Rem->getContext());
2187 
2188   Builder.SetInsertPoint(LoopIncrPN);
2189   PHINode *NewRem = Builder.CreatePHI(Ty, 2);
2190 
2191   Builder.SetInsertPoint(cast<Instruction>(
2192       LoopIncrPN->getIncomingValueForBlock(L->getLoopLatch())));
2193   // `(add (urem x, y), 1)` is always nuw.
2194   Value *RemAdd = Builder.CreateNUWAdd(NewRem, ConstantInt::get(Ty, 1));
2195   Value *RemCmp = Builder.CreateICmp(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, RemAdd, RemAmt);
2196   Value *RemSel =
2197       Builder.CreateSelect(RemCmp, Constant::getNullValue(Ty), RemAdd);
2198 
2199   NewRem->addIncoming(Start, L->getLoopPreheader());
2200   NewRem->addIncoming(RemSel, L->getLoopLatch());
2201 
2202   // Insert all touched BBs.
2203   FreshBBs.insert(LoopIncrPN->getParent());
2204   FreshBBs.insert(L->getLoopLatch());
2205   FreshBBs.insert(Rem->getParent());
2206   if (AddInst)
2207     FreshBBs.insert(cast<Instruction>(AddInst)->getParent());
2208   replaceAllUsesWith(Rem, NewRem, FreshBBs, IsHuge);
2209   Rem->eraseFromParent();
2210   if (AddInst && AddInst->use_empty())
2211     cast<Instruction>(AddInst)->eraseFromParent();
2212   return true;
2213 }
2214 
optimizeURem(Instruction * Rem)2215 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeURem(Instruction *Rem) {
2216   if (foldURemOfLoopIncrement(Rem, DL, LI, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc))
2217     return true;
2218   return false;
2219 }
2220 
optimizeCmp(CmpInst * Cmp,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)2221 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeCmp(CmpInst *Cmp, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
2222   if (sinkCmpExpression(Cmp, *TLI))
2223     return true;
2224 
2225   if (combineToUAddWithOverflow(Cmp, ModifiedDT))
2226     return true;
2227 
2228   if (combineToUSubWithOverflow(Cmp, ModifiedDT))
2229     return true;
2230 
2231   if (unfoldPowerOf2Test(Cmp))
2232     return true;
2233 
2234   if (foldICmpWithDominatingICmp(Cmp, *TLI))
2235     return true;
2236 
2237   if (swapICmpOperandsToExposeCSEOpportunities(Cmp))
2238     return true;
2239 
2240   if (foldFCmpToFPClassTest(Cmp, *TLI, *DL))
2241     return true;
2242 
2243   return false;
2244 }
2245 
2246 /// Duplicate and sink the given 'and' instruction into user blocks where it is
2247 /// used in a compare to allow isel to generate better code for targets where
2248 /// this operation can be combined.
2249 ///
2250 /// Return true if any changes are made.
sinkAndCmp0Expression(Instruction * AndI,const TargetLowering & TLI,SetOfInstrs & InsertedInsts)2251 static bool sinkAndCmp0Expression(Instruction *AndI, const TargetLowering &TLI,
2252                                   SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts) {
2253   // Double-check that we're not trying to optimize an instruction that was
2254   // already optimized by some other part of this pass.
2255   assert(!InsertedInsts.count(AndI) &&
2256          "Attempting to optimize already optimized and instruction");
2257   (void)InsertedInsts;
2258 
2259   // Nothing to do for single use in same basic block.
2260   if (AndI->hasOneUse() &&
2261       AndI->getParent() == cast<Instruction>(*AndI->user_begin())->getParent())
2262     return false;
2263 
2264   // Try to avoid cases where sinking/duplicating is likely to increase register
2265   // pressure.
2266   if (!isa<ConstantInt>(AndI->getOperand(0)) &&
2267       !isa<ConstantInt>(AndI->getOperand(1)) &&
2268       AndI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && AndI->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse())
2269     return false;
2270 
2271   for (auto *U : AndI->users()) {
2272     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(U);
2273 
2274     // Only sink 'and' feeding icmp with 0.
2275     if (!isa<ICmpInst>(User))
2276       return false;
2277 
2278     auto *CmpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1));
2279     if (!CmpC || !CmpC->isZero())
2280       return false;
2281   }
2282 
2283   if (!TLI.isMaskAndCmp0FoldingBeneficial(*AndI))
2284     return false;
2285 
2286   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "found 'and' feeding only icmp 0;\n");
2287   LLVM_DEBUG(AndI->getParent()->dump());
2288 
2289   // Push the 'and' into the same block as the icmp 0.  There should only be
2290   // one (icmp (and, 0)) in each block, since CSE/GVN should have removed any
2291   // others, so we don't need to keep track of which BBs we insert into.
2292   for (Value::user_iterator UI = AndI->user_begin(), E = AndI->user_end();
2293        UI != E;) {
2294     Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
2295     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
2296 
2297     // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
2298     ++UI;
2299 
2300     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "sinking 'and' use: " << *User << "\n");
2301 
2302     // Keep the 'and' in the same place if the use is already in the same block.
2303     Instruction *InsertPt =
2304         User->getParent() == AndI->getParent() ? AndI : User;
2305     Instruction *InsertedAnd = BinaryOperator::Create(
2306         Instruction::And, AndI->getOperand(0), AndI->getOperand(1), "",
2307         InsertPt->getIterator());
2308     // Propagate the debug info.
2309     InsertedAnd->setDebugLoc(AndI->getDebugLoc());
2310 
2311     // Replace a use of the 'and' with a use of the new 'and'.
2312     TheUse = InsertedAnd;
2313     ++NumAndUses;
2314     LLVM_DEBUG(User->getParent()->dump());
2315   }
2316 
2317   // We removed all uses, nuke the and.
2318   AndI->eraseFromParent();
2319   return true;
2320 }
2321 
2322 /// Check if the candidates could be combined with a shift instruction, which
2323 /// includes:
2324 /// 1. Truncate instruction
2325 /// 2. And instruction and the imm is a mask of the low bits:
2326 /// imm & (imm+1) == 0
isExtractBitsCandidateUse(Instruction * User)2327 static bool isExtractBitsCandidateUse(Instruction *User) {
2328   if (!isa<TruncInst>(User)) {
2329     if (User->getOpcode() != Instruction::And ||
2330         !isa<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1)))
2331       return false;
2332 
2333     const APInt &Cimm = cast<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1))->getValue();
2334 
2335     if ((Cimm & (Cimm + 1)).getBoolValue())
2336       return false;
2337   }
2338   return true;
2339 }
2340 
2341 /// Sink both shift and truncate instruction to the use of truncate's BB.
2342 static bool
SinkShiftAndTruncate(BinaryOperator * ShiftI,Instruction * User,ConstantInt * CI,DenseMap<BasicBlock *,BinaryOperator * > & InsertedShifts,const TargetLowering & TLI,const DataLayout & DL)2343 SinkShiftAndTruncate(BinaryOperator *ShiftI, Instruction *User, ConstantInt *CI,
2344                      DenseMap<BasicBlock *, BinaryOperator *> &InsertedShifts,
2345                      const TargetLowering &TLI, const DataLayout &DL) {
2346   BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
2347   DenseMap<BasicBlock *, CastInst *> InsertedTruncs;
2348   auto *TruncI = cast<TruncInst>(User);
2349   bool MadeChange = false;
2350 
2351   for (Value::user_iterator TruncUI = TruncI->user_begin(),
2352                             TruncE = TruncI->user_end();
2353        TruncUI != TruncE;) {
2354 
2355     Use &TruncTheUse = TruncUI.getUse();
2356     Instruction *TruncUser = cast<Instruction>(*TruncUI);
2357     // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
2358 
2359     ++TruncUI;
2360 
2361     int ISDOpcode = TLI.InstructionOpcodeToISD(TruncUser->getOpcode());
2362     if (!ISDOpcode)
2363       continue;
2364 
2365     // If the use is actually a legal node, there will not be an
2366     // implicit truncate.
2367     // FIXME: always querying the result type is just an
2368     // approximation; some nodes' legality is determined by the
2369     // operand or other means. There's no good way to find out though.
2370     if (TLI.isOperationLegalOrCustom(
2371             ISDOpcode, TLI.getValueType(DL, TruncUser->getType(), true)))
2372       continue;
2373 
2374     // Don't bother for PHI nodes.
2375     if (isa<PHINode>(TruncUser))
2376       continue;
2377 
2378     BasicBlock *TruncUserBB = TruncUser->getParent();
2379 
2380     if (UserBB == TruncUserBB)
2381       continue;
2382 
2383     BinaryOperator *&InsertedShift = InsertedShifts[TruncUserBB];
2384     CastInst *&InsertedTrunc = InsertedTruncs[TruncUserBB];
2385 
2386     if (!InsertedShift && !InsertedTrunc) {
2387       BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = TruncUserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
2388       assert(InsertPt != TruncUserBB->end());
2389       // Sink the shift
2390       if (ShiftI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
2391         InsertedShift =
2392             BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI, "");
2393       else
2394         InsertedShift =
2395             BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI, "");
2396       InsertedShift->setDebugLoc(ShiftI->getDebugLoc());
2397       InsertedShift->insertBefore(*TruncUserBB, InsertPt);
2398 
2399       // Sink the trunc
2400       BasicBlock::iterator TruncInsertPt = TruncUserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
2401       TruncInsertPt++;
2402       // It will go ahead of any debug-info.
2403       TruncInsertPt.setHeadBit(true);
2404       assert(TruncInsertPt != TruncUserBB->end());
2405 
2406       InsertedTrunc = CastInst::Create(TruncI->getOpcode(), InsertedShift,
2407                                        TruncI->getType(), "");
2408       InsertedTrunc->insertBefore(*TruncUserBB, TruncInsertPt);
2409       InsertedTrunc->setDebugLoc(TruncI->getDebugLoc());
2410 
2411       MadeChange = true;
2412 
2413       TruncTheUse = InsertedTrunc;
2414     }
2415   }
2416   return MadeChange;
2417 }
2418 
2419 /// Sink the shift *right* instruction into user blocks if the uses could
2420 /// potentially be combined with this shift instruction and generate BitExtract
2421 /// instruction. It will only be applied if the architecture supports BitExtract
2422 /// instruction. Here is an example:
2423 /// BB1:
2424 ///   %x.extract.shift = lshr i64 %arg1, 32
2425 /// BB2:
2426 ///   %x.extract.trunc = trunc i64 %x.extract.shift to i16
2427 /// ==>
2428 ///
2429 /// BB2:
2430 ///   %x.extract.shift.1 = lshr i64 %arg1, 32
2431 ///   %x.extract.trunc = trunc i64 %x.extract.shift.1 to i16
2432 ///
2433 /// CodeGen will recognize the pattern in BB2 and generate BitExtract
2434 /// instruction.
2435 /// Return true if any changes are made.
OptimizeExtractBits(BinaryOperator * ShiftI,ConstantInt * CI,const TargetLowering & TLI,const DataLayout & DL)2436 static bool OptimizeExtractBits(BinaryOperator *ShiftI, ConstantInt *CI,
2437                                 const TargetLowering &TLI,
2438                                 const DataLayout &DL) {
2439   BasicBlock *DefBB = ShiftI->getParent();
2440 
2441   /// Only insert instructions in each block once.
2442   DenseMap<BasicBlock *, BinaryOperator *> InsertedShifts;
2443 
2444   bool shiftIsLegal = TLI.isTypeLegal(TLI.getValueType(DL, ShiftI->getType()));
2445 
2446   bool MadeChange = false;
2447   for (Value::user_iterator UI = ShiftI->user_begin(), E = ShiftI->user_end();
2448        UI != E;) {
2449     Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
2450     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
2451     // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
2452     ++UI;
2453 
2454     // Don't bother for PHI nodes.
2455     if (isa<PHINode>(User))
2456       continue;
2457 
2458     if (!isExtractBitsCandidateUse(User))
2459       continue;
2460 
2461     BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
2462 
2463     if (UserBB == DefBB) {
2464       // If the shift and truncate instruction are in the same BB. The use of
2465       // the truncate(TruncUse) may still introduce another truncate if not
2466       // legal. In this case, we would like to sink both shift and truncate
2467       // instruction to the BB of TruncUse.
2468       // for example:
2469       // BB1:
2470       // i64 shift.result = lshr i64 opnd, imm
2471       // trunc.result = trunc shift.result to i16
2472       //
2473       // BB2:
2474       //   ----> We will have an implicit truncate here if the architecture does
2475       //   not have i16 compare.
2476       // cmp i16 trunc.result, opnd2
2477       //
2478       if (isa<TruncInst>(User) &&
2479           shiftIsLegal
2480           // If the type of the truncate is legal, no truncate will be
2481           // introduced in other basic blocks.
2482           && (!TLI.isTypeLegal(TLI.getValueType(DL, User->getType()))))
2483         MadeChange =
2484             SinkShiftAndTruncate(ShiftI, User, CI, InsertedShifts, TLI, DL);
2485 
2486       continue;
2487     }
2488     // If we have already inserted a shift into this block, use it.
2489     BinaryOperator *&InsertedShift = InsertedShifts[UserBB];
2490 
2491     if (!InsertedShift) {
2492       BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
2493       assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
2494 
2495       if (ShiftI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
2496         InsertedShift =
2497             BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI, "");
2498       else
2499         InsertedShift =
2500             BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI, "");
2501       InsertedShift->insertBefore(*UserBB, InsertPt);
2502       InsertedShift->setDebugLoc(ShiftI->getDebugLoc());
2503 
2504       MadeChange = true;
2505     }
2506 
2507     // Replace a use of the shift with a use of the new shift.
2508     TheUse = InsertedShift;
2509   }
2510 
2511   // If we removed all uses, or there are none, nuke the shift.
2512   if (ShiftI->use_empty()) {
2513     salvageDebugInfo(*ShiftI);
2514     ShiftI->eraseFromParent();
2515     MadeChange = true;
2516   }
2517 
2518   return MadeChange;
2519 }
2520 
2521 /// If counting leading or trailing zeros is an expensive operation and a zero
2522 /// input is defined, add a check for zero to avoid calling the intrinsic.
2523 ///
2524 /// We want to transform:
2525 ///     %z = call i64 @llvm.cttz.i64(i64 %A, i1 false)
2526 ///
2527 /// into:
2528 ///   entry:
2529 ///     %cmpz = icmp eq i64 %A, 0
2530 ///     br i1 %cmpz, label %cond.end, label %cond.false
2531 ///   cond.false:
2532 ///     %z = call i64 @llvm.cttz.i64(i64 %A, i1 true)
2533 ///     br label %cond.end
2534 ///   cond.end:
2535 ///     %ctz = phi i64 [ 64, %entry ], [ %z, %cond.false ]
2536 ///
2537 /// If the transform is performed, return true and set ModifiedDT to true.
despeculateCountZeros(IntrinsicInst * CountZeros,LoopInfo & LI,const TargetLowering * TLI,const DataLayout * DL,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT,SmallSet<BasicBlock *,32> & FreshBBs,bool IsHugeFunc)2538 static bool despeculateCountZeros(IntrinsicInst *CountZeros,
2539                                   LoopInfo &LI,
2540                                   const TargetLowering *TLI,
2541                                   const DataLayout *DL, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT,
2542                                   SmallSet<BasicBlock *, 32> &FreshBBs,
2543                                   bool IsHugeFunc) {
2544   // If a zero input is undefined, it doesn't make sense to despeculate that.
2545   if (match(CountZeros->getOperand(1), m_One()))
2546     return false;
2547 
2548   // If it's cheap to speculate, there's nothing to do.
2549   Type *Ty = CountZeros->getType();
2550   auto IntrinsicID = CountZeros->getIntrinsicID();
2551   if ((IntrinsicID == Intrinsic::cttz && TLI->isCheapToSpeculateCttz(Ty)) ||
2552       (IntrinsicID == Intrinsic::ctlz && TLI->isCheapToSpeculateCtlz(Ty)))
2553     return false;
2554 
2555   // Only handle scalar cases. Anything else requires too much work.
2556   unsigned SizeInBits = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
2557   if (Ty->isVectorTy())
2558     return false;
2559 
2560   // Bail if the value is never zero.
2561   Use &Op = CountZeros->getOperandUse(0);
2562   if (isKnownNonZero(Op, *DL))
2563     return false;
2564 
2565   // The intrinsic will be sunk behind a compare against zero and branch.
2566   BasicBlock *StartBlock = CountZeros->getParent();
2567   BasicBlock *CallBlock = StartBlock->splitBasicBlock(CountZeros, "cond.false");
2568   if (IsHugeFunc)
2569     FreshBBs.insert(CallBlock);
2570 
2571   // Create another block after the count zero intrinsic. A PHI will be added
2572   // in this block to select the result of the intrinsic or the bit-width
2573   // constant if the input to the intrinsic is zero.
2574   BasicBlock::iterator SplitPt = std::next(BasicBlock::iterator(CountZeros));
2575   // Any debug-info after CountZeros should not be included.
2576   SplitPt.setHeadBit(true);
2577   BasicBlock *EndBlock = CallBlock->splitBasicBlock(SplitPt, "cond.end");
2578   if (IsHugeFunc)
2579     FreshBBs.insert(EndBlock);
2580 
2581   // Update the LoopInfo. The new blocks are in the same loop as the start
2582   // block.
2583   if (Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(StartBlock)) {
2584     L->addBasicBlockToLoop(CallBlock, LI);
2585     L->addBasicBlockToLoop(EndBlock, LI);
2586   }
2587 
2588   // Set up a builder to create a compare, conditional branch, and PHI.
2589   IRBuilder<> Builder(CountZeros->getContext());
2590   Builder.SetInsertPoint(StartBlock->getTerminator());
2591   Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(CountZeros->getDebugLoc());
2592 
2593   // Replace the unconditional branch that was created by the first split with
2594   // a compare against zero and a conditional branch.
2595   Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Ty);
2596   // Avoid introducing branch on poison. This also replaces the ctz operand.
2597   if (!isGuaranteedNotToBeUndefOrPoison(Op))
2598     Op = Builder.CreateFreeze(Op, Op->getName() + ".fr");
2599   Value *Cmp = Builder.CreateICmpEQ(Op, Zero, "cmpz");
2600   Builder.CreateCondBr(Cmp, EndBlock, CallBlock);
2601   StartBlock->getTerminator()->eraseFromParent();
2602 
2603   // Create a PHI in the end block to select either the output of the intrinsic
2604   // or the bit width of the operand.
2605   Builder.SetInsertPoint(EndBlock, EndBlock->begin());
2606   PHINode *PN = Builder.CreatePHI(Ty, 2, "ctz");
2607   replaceAllUsesWith(CountZeros, PN, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
2608   Value *BitWidth = Builder.getInt(APInt(SizeInBits, SizeInBits));
2609   PN->addIncoming(BitWidth, StartBlock);
2610   PN->addIncoming(CountZeros, CallBlock);
2611 
2612   // We are explicitly handling the zero case, so we can set the intrinsic's
2613   // undefined zero argument to 'true'. This will also prevent reprocessing the
2614   // intrinsic; we only despeculate when a zero input is defined.
2615   CountZeros->setArgOperand(1, Builder.getTrue());
2616   ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::ModifyBBDT;
2617   return true;
2618 }
2619 
optimizeCallInst(CallInst * CI,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)2620 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeCallInst(CallInst *CI, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
2621   BasicBlock *BB = CI->getParent();
2622 
2623   // Lower inline assembly if we can.
2624   // If we found an inline asm expession, and if the target knows how to
2625   // lower it to normal LLVM code, do so now.
2626   if (CI->isInlineAsm()) {
2627     if (TLI->ExpandInlineAsm(CI)) {
2628       // Avoid invalidating the iterator.
2629       CurInstIterator = BB->begin();
2630       // Avoid processing instructions out of order, which could cause
2631       // reuse before a value is defined.
2632       SunkAddrs.clear();
2633       return true;
2634     }
2635     // Sink address computing for memory operands into the block.
2636     if (optimizeInlineAsmInst(CI))
2637       return true;
2638   }
2639 
2640   // Align the pointer arguments to this call if the target thinks it's a good
2641   // idea
2642   unsigned MinSize;
2643   Align PrefAlign;
2644   if (TLI->shouldAlignPointerArgs(CI, MinSize, PrefAlign)) {
2645     for (auto &Arg : CI->args()) {
2646       // We want to align both objects whose address is used directly and
2647       // objects whose address is used in casts and GEPs, though it only makes
2648       // sense for GEPs if the offset is a multiple of the desired alignment and
2649       // if size - offset meets the size threshold.
2650       if (!Arg->getType()->isPointerTy())
2651         continue;
2652       APInt Offset(DL->getIndexSizeInBits(
2653                        cast<PointerType>(Arg->getType())->getAddressSpace()),
2654                    0);
2655       Value *Val = Arg->stripAndAccumulateInBoundsConstantOffsets(*DL, Offset);
2656       uint64_t Offset2 = Offset.getLimitedValue();
2657       if (!isAligned(PrefAlign, Offset2))
2658         continue;
2659       AllocaInst *AI;
2660       if ((AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(Val)) && AI->getAlign() < PrefAlign &&
2661           DL->getTypeAllocSize(AI->getAllocatedType()) >= MinSize + Offset2)
2662         AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
2663       // Global variables can only be aligned if they are defined in this
2664       // object (i.e. they are uniquely initialized in this object), and
2665       // over-aligning global variables that have an explicit section is
2666       // forbidden.
2667       GlobalVariable *GV;
2668       if ((GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Val)) && GV->canIncreaseAlignment() &&
2669           GV->getPointerAlignment(*DL) < PrefAlign &&
2670           DL->getTypeAllocSize(GV->getValueType()) >= MinSize + Offset2)
2671         GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
2672     }
2673   }
2674   // If this is a memcpy (or similar) then we may be able to improve the
2675   // alignment.
2676   if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(CI)) {
2677     Align DestAlign = getKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), *DL);
2678     MaybeAlign MIDestAlign = MI->getDestAlign();
2679     if (!MIDestAlign || DestAlign > *MIDestAlign)
2680       MI->setDestAlignment(DestAlign);
2681     if (MemTransferInst *MTI = dyn_cast<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
2682       MaybeAlign MTISrcAlign = MTI->getSourceAlign();
2683       Align SrcAlign = getKnownAlignment(MTI->getSource(), *DL);
2684       if (!MTISrcAlign || SrcAlign > *MTISrcAlign)
2685         MTI->setSourceAlignment(SrcAlign);
2686     }
2687   }
2688 
2689   // If we have a cold call site, try to sink addressing computation into the
2690   // cold block.  This interacts with our handling for loads and stores to
2691   // ensure that we can fold all uses of a potential addressing computation
2692   // into their uses.  TODO: generalize this to work over profiling data
2693   if (CI->hasFnAttr(Attribute::Cold) &&
2694       !llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(BB, PSI, BFI.get()))
2695     for (auto &Arg : CI->args()) {
2696       if (!Arg->getType()->isPointerTy())
2697         continue;
2698       unsigned AS = Arg->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
2699       if (optimizeMemoryInst(CI, Arg, Arg->getType(), AS))
2700         return true;
2701     }
2702 
2703   IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(CI);
2704   if (II) {
2705     switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
2706     default:
2707       break;
2708     case Intrinsic::assume:
2709       llvm_unreachable("llvm.assume should have been removed already");
2710     case Intrinsic::allow_runtime_check:
2711     case Intrinsic::allow_ubsan_check:
2712     case Intrinsic::experimental_widenable_condition: {
2713       // Give up on future widening opportunities so that we can fold away dead
2714       // paths and merge blocks before going into block-local instruction
2715       // selection.
2716       if (II->use_empty()) {
2717         II->eraseFromParent();
2718         return true;
2719       }
2720       Constant *RetVal = ConstantInt::getTrue(II->getContext());
2721       resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(BB, [&]() {
2722         replaceAndRecursivelySimplify(CI, RetVal, TLInfo, nullptr);
2723       });
2724       return true;
2725     }
2726     case Intrinsic::objectsize:
2727       llvm_unreachable("llvm.objectsize.* should have been lowered already");
2728     case Intrinsic::is_constant:
2729       llvm_unreachable("llvm.is.constant.* should have been lowered already");
2730     case Intrinsic::aarch64_stlxr:
2731     case Intrinsic::aarch64_stxr: {
2732       ZExtInst *ExtVal = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(CI->getArgOperand(0));
2733       if (!ExtVal || !ExtVal->hasOneUse() ||
2734           ExtVal->getParent() == CI->getParent())
2735         return false;
2736       // Sink a zext feeding stlxr/stxr before it, so it can be folded into it.
2737       ExtVal->moveBefore(CI->getIterator());
2738       // Mark this instruction as "inserted by CGP", so that other
2739       // optimizations don't touch it.
2740       InsertedInsts.insert(ExtVal);
2741       return true;
2742     }
2743 
2744     case Intrinsic::launder_invariant_group:
2745     case Intrinsic::strip_invariant_group: {
2746       Value *ArgVal = II->getArgOperand(0);
2747       auto it = LargeOffsetGEPMap.find(II);
2748       if (it != LargeOffsetGEPMap.end()) {
2749         // Merge entries in LargeOffsetGEPMap to reflect the RAUW.
2750         // Make sure not to have to deal with iterator invalidation
2751         // after possibly adding ArgVal to LargeOffsetGEPMap.
2752         auto GEPs = std::move(it->second);
2753         LargeOffsetGEPMap[ArgVal].append(GEPs.begin(), GEPs.end());
2754         LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(II);
2755       }
2756 
2757       replaceAllUsesWith(II, ArgVal, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
2758       II->eraseFromParent();
2759       return true;
2760     }
2761     case Intrinsic::cttz:
2762     case Intrinsic::ctlz:
2763       // If counting zeros is expensive, try to avoid it.
2764       return despeculateCountZeros(II, *LI, TLI, DL, ModifiedDT, FreshBBs,
2765                                    IsHugeFunc);
2766     case Intrinsic::fshl:
2767     case Intrinsic::fshr:
2768       return optimizeFunnelShift(II);
2769     case Intrinsic::dbg_assign:
2770     case Intrinsic::dbg_value:
2771       return fixupDbgValue(II);
2772     case Intrinsic::masked_gather:
2773       return optimizeGatherScatterInst(II, II->getArgOperand(0));
2774     case Intrinsic::masked_scatter:
2775       return optimizeGatherScatterInst(II, II->getArgOperand(1));
2776     }
2777 
2778     SmallVector<Value *, 2> PtrOps;
2779     Type *AccessTy;
2780     if (TLI->getAddrModeArguments(II, PtrOps, AccessTy))
2781       while (!PtrOps.empty()) {
2782         Value *PtrVal = PtrOps.pop_back_val();
2783         unsigned AS = PtrVal->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
2784         if (optimizeMemoryInst(II, PtrVal, AccessTy, AS))
2785           return true;
2786       }
2787   }
2788 
2789   // From here on out we're working with named functions.
2790   auto *Callee = CI->getCalledFunction();
2791   if (!Callee)
2792     return false;
2793 
2794   // Lower all default uses of _chk calls.  This is very similar
2795   // to what InstCombineCalls does, but here we are only lowering calls
2796   // to fortified library functions (e.g. __memcpy_chk) that have the default
2797   // "don't know" as the objectsize.  Anything else should be left alone.
2798   FortifiedLibCallSimplifier Simplifier(TLInfo, true);
2799   IRBuilder<> Builder(CI);
2800   if (Value *V = Simplifier.optimizeCall(CI, Builder)) {
2801     replaceAllUsesWith(CI, V, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
2802     CI->eraseFromParent();
2803     return true;
2804   }
2805 
2806   // SCCP may have propagated, among other things, C++ static variables across
2807   // calls. If this happens to be the case, we may want to undo it in order to
2808   // avoid redundant pointer computation of the constant, as the function method
2809   // returning the constant needs to be executed anyways.
2810   auto GetUniformReturnValue = [](const Function *F) -> GlobalVariable * {
2811     if (!F->getReturnType()->isPointerTy())
2812       return nullptr;
2813 
2814     GlobalVariable *UniformValue = nullptr;
2815     for (auto &BB : *F) {
2816       if (auto *RI = dyn_cast<ReturnInst>(BB.getTerminator())) {
2817         if (auto *V = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(RI->getReturnValue())) {
2818           if (!UniformValue)
2819             UniformValue = V;
2820           else if (V != UniformValue)
2821             return nullptr;
2822         } else {
2823           return nullptr;
2824         }
2825       }
2826     }
2827 
2828     return UniformValue;
2829   };
2830 
2831   if (Callee->hasExactDefinition()) {
2832     if (GlobalVariable *RV = GetUniformReturnValue(Callee)) {
2833       bool MadeChange = false;
2834       for (Use &U : make_early_inc_range(RV->uses())) {
2835         auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
2836         if (!I || I->getParent() != CI->getParent()) {
2837           // Limit to the same basic block to avoid extending the call-site live
2838           // range, which otherwise could increase register pressure.
2839           continue;
2840         }
2841         if (CI->comesBefore(I)) {
2842           U.set(CI);
2843           MadeChange = true;
2844         }
2845       }
2846 
2847       return MadeChange;
2848     }
2849   }
2850 
2851   return false;
2852 }
2853 
isIntrinsicOrLFToBeTailCalled(const TargetLibraryInfo * TLInfo,const CallInst * CI)2854 static bool isIntrinsicOrLFToBeTailCalled(const TargetLibraryInfo *TLInfo,
2855                                           const CallInst *CI) {
2856   assert(CI && CI->use_empty());
2857 
2858   if (const auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(CI))
2859     switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
2860     case Intrinsic::memset:
2861     case Intrinsic::memcpy:
2862     case Intrinsic::memmove:
2863       return true;
2864     default:
2865       return false;
2866     }
2867 
2868   LibFunc LF;
2869   Function *Callee = CI->getCalledFunction();
2870   if (Callee && TLInfo && TLInfo->getLibFunc(*Callee, LF))
2871     switch (LF) {
2872     case LibFunc_strcpy:
2873     case LibFunc_strncpy:
2874     case LibFunc_strcat:
2875     case LibFunc_strncat:
2876       return true;
2877     default:
2878       return false;
2879     }
2880 
2881   return false;
2882 }
2883 
2884 /// Look for opportunities to duplicate return instructions to the predecessor
2885 /// to enable tail call optimizations. The case it is currently looking for is
2886 /// the following one. Known intrinsics or library function that may be tail
2887 /// called are taken into account as well.
2888 /// @code
2889 /// bb0:
2890 ///   %tmp0 = tail call i32 @f0()
2891 ///   br label %return
2892 /// bb1:
2893 ///   %tmp1 = tail call i32 @f1()
2894 ///   br label %return
2895 /// bb2:
2896 ///   %tmp2 = tail call i32 @f2()
2897 ///   br label %return
2898 /// return:
2899 ///   %retval = phi i32 [ %tmp0, %bb0 ], [ %tmp1, %bb1 ], [ %tmp2, %bb2 ]
2900 ///   ret i32 %retval
2901 /// @endcode
2902 ///
2903 /// =>
2904 ///
2905 /// @code
2906 /// bb0:
2907 ///   %tmp0 = tail call i32 @f0()
2908 ///   ret i32 %tmp0
2909 /// bb1:
2910 ///   %tmp1 = tail call i32 @f1()
2911 ///   ret i32 %tmp1
2912 /// bb2:
2913 ///   %tmp2 = tail call i32 @f2()
2914 ///   ret i32 %tmp2
2915 /// @endcode
dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(BasicBlock * BB,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)2916 bool CodeGenPrepare::dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(BasicBlock *BB,
2917                                                 ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
2918   if (!BB->getTerminator())
2919     return false;
2920 
2921   ReturnInst *RetI = dyn_cast<ReturnInst>(BB->getTerminator());
2922   if (!RetI)
2923     return false;
2924 
2925   assert(LI->getLoopFor(BB) == nullptr && "A return block cannot be in a loop");
2926 
2927   PHINode *PN = nullptr;
2928   ExtractValueInst *EVI = nullptr;
2929   BitCastInst *BCI = nullptr;
2930   Value *V = RetI->getReturnValue();
2931   if (V) {
2932     BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V);
2933     if (BCI)
2934       V = BCI->getOperand(0);
2935 
2936     EVI = dyn_cast<ExtractValueInst>(V);
2937     if (EVI) {
2938       V = EVI->getOperand(0);
2939       if (!llvm::all_of(EVI->indices(), [](unsigned idx) { return idx == 0; }))
2940         return false;
2941     }
2942 
2943     PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V);
2944   }
2945 
2946   if (PN && PN->getParent() != BB)
2947     return false;
2948 
2949   auto isLifetimeEndOrBitCastFor = [](const Instruction *Inst) {
2950     const BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Inst);
2951     if (BC && BC->hasOneUse())
2952       Inst = BC->user_back();
2953 
2954     if (const IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Inst))
2955       return II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::lifetime_end;
2956     return false;
2957   };
2958 
2959   SmallVector<const IntrinsicInst *, 4> FakeUses;
2960 
2961   auto isFakeUse = [&FakeUses](const Instruction *Inst) {
2962     if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Inst);
2963         II && II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::fake_use) {
2964       // Record the instruction so it can be preserved when the exit block is
2965       // removed. Do not preserve the fake use that uses the result of the
2966       // PHI instruction.
2967       // Do not copy fake uses that use the result of a PHI node.
2968       // FIXME: If we do want to copy the fake use into the return blocks, we
2969       // have to figure out which of the PHI node operands to use for each
2970       // copy.
2971       if (!isa<PHINode>(II->getOperand(0))) {
2972         FakeUses.push_back(II);
2973       }
2974       return true;
2975     }
2976 
2977     return false;
2978   };
2979 
2980   // Make sure there are no instructions between the first instruction
2981   // and return.
2982   BasicBlock::const_iterator BI = BB->getFirstNonPHIIt();
2983   // Skip over pseudo-probes and the bitcast.
2984   while (&*BI == BCI || &*BI == EVI || isa<PseudoProbeInst>(BI) ||
2985          isLifetimeEndOrBitCastFor(&*BI) || isFakeUse(&*BI))
2986     BI = std::next(BI);
2987   if (&*BI != RetI)
2988     return false;
2989 
2990   /// Only dup the ReturnInst if the CallInst is likely to be emitted as a tail
2991   /// call.
2992   const Function *F = BB->getParent();
2993   SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 4> TailCallBBs;
2994   // Record the call instructions so we can insert any fake uses
2995   // that need to be preserved before them.
2996   SmallVector<CallInst *, 4> CallInsts;
2997   if (PN) {
2998     for (unsigned I = 0, E = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); I != E; ++I) {
2999       // Look through bitcasts.
3000       Value *IncomingVal = PN->getIncomingValue(I)->stripPointerCasts();
3001       CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(IncomingVal);
3002       BasicBlock *PredBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(I);
3003       // Make sure the phi value is indeed produced by the tail call.
3004       if (CI && CI->hasOneUse() && CI->getParent() == PredBB &&
3005           TLI->mayBeEmittedAsTailCall(CI) &&
3006           attributesPermitTailCall(F, CI, RetI, *TLI)) {
3007         TailCallBBs.push_back(PredBB);
3008         CallInsts.push_back(CI);
3009       } else {
3010         // Consider the cases in which the phi value is indirectly produced by
3011         // the tail call, for example when encountering memset(), memmove(),
3012         // strcpy(), whose return value may have been optimized out. In such
3013         // cases, the value needs to be the first function argument.
3014         //
3015         // bb0:
3016         //   tail call void @llvm.memset.p0.i64(ptr %0, i8 0, i64 %1)
3017         //   br label %return
3018         // return:
3019         //   %phi = phi ptr [ %0, %bb0 ], [ %2, %entry ]
3020         if (PredBB && PredBB->getSingleSuccessor() == BB)
3021           CI = dyn_cast_or_null<CallInst>(
3022               PredBB->getTerminator()->getPrevNonDebugInstruction(true));
3023 
3024         if (CI && CI->use_empty() &&
3025             isIntrinsicOrLFToBeTailCalled(TLInfo, CI) &&
3026             IncomingVal == CI->getArgOperand(0) &&
3027             TLI->mayBeEmittedAsTailCall(CI) &&
3028             attributesPermitTailCall(F, CI, RetI, *TLI)) {
3029           TailCallBBs.push_back(PredBB);
3030           CallInsts.push_back(CI);
3031         }
3032       }
3033     }
3034   } else {
3035     SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock *, 4> VisitedBBs;
3036     for (BasicBlock *Pred : predecessors(BB)) {
3037       if (!VisitedBBs.insert(Pred).second)
3038         continue;
3039       if (Instruction *I = Pred->rbegin()->getPrevNonDebugInstruction(true)) {
3040         CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(I);
3041         if (CI && CI->use_empty() && TLI->mayBeEmittedAsTailCall(CI) &&
3042             attributesPermitTailCall(F, CI, RetI, *TLI)) {
3043           // Either we return void or the return value must be the first
3044           // argument of a known intrinsic or library function.
3045           if (!V || isa<UndefValue>(V) ||
3046               (isIntrinsicOrLFToBeTailCalled(TLInfo, CI) &&
3047                V == CI->getArgOperand(0))) {
3048             TailCallBBs.push_back(Pred);
3049             CallInsts.push_back(CI);
3050           }
3051         }
3052       }
3053     }
3054   }
3055 
3056   bool Changed = false;
3057   for (auto const &TailCallBB : TailCallBBs) {
3058     // Make sure the call instruction is followed by an unconditional branch to
3059     // the return block.
3060     BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TailCallBB->getTerminator());
3061     if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional() || BI->getSuccessor(0) != BB)
3062       continue;
3063 
3064     // Duplicate the return into TailCallBB.
3065     (void)FoldReturnIntoUncondBranch(RetI, BB, TailCallBB);
3066     assert(!VerifyBFIUpdates ||
3067            BFI->getBlockFreq(BB) >= BFI->getBlockFreq(TailCallBB));
3068     BFI->setBlockFreq(BB,
3069                       (BFI->getBlockFreq(BB) - BFI->getBlockFreq(TailCallBB)));
3070     ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::ModifyBBDT;
3071     Changed = true;
3072     ++NumRetsDup;
3073   }
3074 
3075   // If we eliminated all predecessors of the block, delete the block now.
3076   if (Changed && !BB->hasAddressTaken() && pred_empty(BB)) {
3077     // Copy the fake uses found in the original return block to all blocks
3078     // that contain tail calls.
3079     for (auto *CI : CallInsts) {
3080       for (auto const *FakeUse : FakeUses) {
3081         auto *ClonedInst = FakeUse->clone();
3082         ClonedInst->insertBefore(CI->getIterator());
3083       }
3084     }
3085     BB->eraseFromParent();
3086   }
3087 
3088   return Changed;
3089 }
3090 
3091 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3092 // Memory Optimization
3093 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3094 
3095 namespace {
3096 
3097 /// This is an extended version of TargetLowering::AddrMode
3098 /// which holds actual Value*'s for register values.
3099 struct ExtAddrMode : public TargetLowering::AddrMode {
3100   Value *BaseReg = nullptr;
3101   Value *ScaledReg = nullptr;
3102   Value *OriginalValue = nullptr;
3103   bool InBounds = true;
3104 
3105   enum FieldName {
3106     NoField = 0x00,
3107     BaseRegField = 0x01,
3108     BaseGVField = 0x02,
3109     BaseOffsField = 0x04,
3110     ScaledRegField = 0x08,
3111     ScaleField = 0x10,
3112     MultipleFields = 0xff
3113   };
3114 
3115   ExtAddrMode() = default;
3116 
3117   void print(raw_ostream &OS) const;
3118   void dump() const;
3119 
3120   // Replace From in ExtAddrMode with To.
3121   // E.g., SExt insts may be promoted and deleted. We should replace them with
3122   // the promoted values.
replaceWith__anon1d600f580c11::ExtAddrMode3123   void replaceWith(Value *From, Value *To) {
3124     if (ScaledReg == From)
3125       ScaledReg = To;
3126   }
3127 
compare__anon1d600f580c11::ExtAddrMode3128   FieldName compare(const ExtAddrMode &other) {
3129     // First check that the types are the same on each field, as differing types
3130     // is something we can't cope with later on.
3131     if (BaseReg && other.BaseReg &&
3132         BaseReg->getType() != other.BaseReg->getType())
3133       return MultipleFields;
3134     if (BaseGV && other.BaseGV && BaseGV->getType() != other.BaseGV->getType())
3135       return MultipleFields;
3136     if (ScaledReg && other.ScaledReg &&
3137         ScaledReg->getType() != other.ScaledReg->getType())
3138       return MultipleFields;
3139 
3140     // Conservatively reject 'inbounds' mismatches.
3141     if (InBounds != other.InBounds)
3142       return MultipleFields;
3143 
3144     // Check each field to see if it differs.
3145     unsigned Result = NoField;
3146     if (BaseReg != other.BaseReg)
3147       Result |= BaseRegField;
3148     if (BaseGV != other.BaseGV)
3149       Result |= BaseGVField;
3150     if (BaseOffs != other.BaseOffs)
3151       Result |= BaseOffsField;
3152     if (ScaledReg != other.ScaledReg)
3153       Result |= ScaledRegField;
3154     // Don't count 0 as being a different scale, because that actually means
3155     // unscaled (which will already be counted by having no ScaledReg).
3156     if (Scale && other.Scale && Scale != other.Scale)
3157       Result |= ScaleField;
3158 
3159     if (llvm::popcount(Result) > 1)
3160       return MultipleFields;
3161     else
3162       return static_cast<FieldName>(Result);
3163   }
3164 
3165   // An AddrMode is trivial if it involves no calculation i.e. it is just a base
3166   // with no offset.
isTrivial__anon1d600f580c11::ExtAddrMode3167   bool isTrivial() {
3168     // An AddrMode is (BaseGV + BaseReg + BaseOffs + ScaleReg * Scale) so it is
3169     // trivial if at most one of these terms is nonzero, except that BaseGV and
3170     // BaseReg both being zero actually means a null pointer value, which we
3171     // consider to be 'non-zero' here.
3172     return !BaseOffs && !Scale && !(BaseGV && BaseReg);
3173   }
3174 
GetFieldAsValue__anon1d600f580c11::ExtAddrMode3175   Value *GetFieldAsValue(FieldName Field, Type *IntPtrTy) {
3176     switch (Field) {
3177     default:
3178       return nullptr;
3179     case BaseRegField:
3180       return BaseReg;
3181     case BaseGVField:
3182       return BaseGV;
3183     case ScaledRegField:
3184       return ScaledReg;
3185     case BaseOffsField:
3186       return ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, BaseOffs);
3187     }
3188   }
3189 
SetCombinedField__anon1d600f580c11::ExtAddrMode3190   void SetCombinedField(FieldName Field, Value *V,
3191                         const SmallVectorImpl<ExtAddrMode> &AddrModes) {
3192     switch (Field) {
3193     default:
3194       llvm_unreachable("Unhandled fields are expected to be rejected earlier");
3195       break;
3196     case ExtAddrMode::BaseRegField:
3197       BaseReg = V;
3198       break;
3199     case ExtAddrMode::BaseGVField:
3200       // A combined BaseGV is an Instruction, not a GlobalValue, so it goes
3201       // in the BaseReg field.
3202       assert(BaseReg == nullptr);
3203       BaseReg = V;
3204       BaseGV = nullptr;
3205       break;
3206     case ExtAddrMode::ScaledRegField:
3207       ScaledReg = V;
3208       // If we have a mix of scaled and unscaled addrmodes then we want scale
3209       // to be the scale and not zero.
3210       if (!Scale)
3211         for (const ExtAddrMode &AM : AddrModes)
3212           if (AM.Scale) {
3213             Scale = AM.Scale;
3214             break;
3215           }
3216       break;
3217     case ExtAddrMode::BaseOffsField:
3218       // The offset is no longer a constant, so it goes in ScaledReg with a
3219       // scale of 1.
3220       assert(ScaledReg == nullptr);
3221       ScaledReg = V;
3222       Scale = 1;
3223       BaseOffs = 0;
3224       break;
3225     }
3226   }
3227 };
3228 
3229 #ifndef NDEBUG
operator <<(raw_ostream & OS,const ExtAddrMode & AM)3230 static inline raw_ostream &operator<<(raw_ostream &OS, const ExtAddrMode &AM) {
3231   AM.print(OS);
3232   return OS;
3233 }
3234 #endif
3235 
3236 #if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(LLVM_ENABLE_DUMP)
print(raw_ostream & OS) const3237 void ExtAddrMode::print(raw_ostream &OS) const {
3238   bool NeedPlus = false;
3239   OS << "[";
3240   if (InBounds)
3241     OS << "inbounds ";
3242   if (BaseGV) {
3243     OS << "GV:";
3244     BaseGV->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
3245     NeedPlus = true;
3246   }
3247 
3248   if (BaseOffs) {
3249     OS << (NeedPlus ? " + " : "") << BaseOffs;
3250     NeedPlus = true;
3251   }
3252 
3253   if (BaseReg) {
3254     OS << (NeedPlus ? " + " : "") << "Base:";
3255     BaseReg->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
3256     NeedPlus = true;
3257   }
3258   if (Scale) {
3259     OS << (NeedPlus ? " + " : "") << Scale << "*";
3260     ScaledReg->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
3261   }
3262 
3263   OS << ']';
3264 }
3265 
dump() const3266 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void ExtAddrMode::dump() const {
3267   print(dbgs());
3268   dbgs() << '\n';
3269 }
3270 #endif
3271 
3272 } // end anonymous namespace
3273 
3274 namespace {
3275 
3276 /// This class provides transaction based operation on the IR.
3277 /// Every change made through this class is recorded in the internal state and
3278 /// can be undone (rollback) until commit is called.
3279 /// CGP does not check if instructions could be speculatively executed when
3280 /// moved. Preserving the original location would pessimize the debugging
3281 /// experience, as well as negatively impact the quality of sample PGO.
3282 class TypePromotionTransaction {
3283   /// This represents the common interface of the individual transaction.
3284   /// Each class implements the logic for doing one specific modification on
3285   /// the IR via the TypePromotionTransaction.
3286   class TypePromotionAction {
3287   protected:
3288     /// The Instruction modified.
3289     Instruction *Inst;
3290 
3291   public:
3292     /// Constructor of the action.
3293     /// The constructor performs the related action on the IR.
TypePromotionAction(Instruction * Inst)3294     TypePromotionAction(Instruction *Inst) : Inst(Inst) {}
3295 
3296     virtual ~TypePromotionAction() = default;
3297 
3298     /// Undo the modification done by this action.
3299     /// When this method is called, the IR must be in the same state as it was
3300     /// before this action was applied.
3301     /// \pre Undoing the action works if and only if the IR is in the exact same
3302     /// state as it was directly after this action was applied.
3303     virtual void undo() = 0;
3304 
3305     /// Advocate every change made by this action.
3306     /// When the results on the IR of the action are to be kept, it is important
3307     /// to call this function, otherwise hidden information may be kept forever.
commit()3308     virtual void commit() {
3309       // Nothing to be done, this action is not doing anything.
3310     }
3311   };
3312 
3313   /// Utility to remember the position of an instruction.
3314   class InsertionHandler {
3315     /// Position of an instruction.
3316     /// Either an instruction:
3317     /// - Is the first in a basic block: BB is used.
3318     /// - Has a previous instruction: PrevInst is used.
3319     struct {
3320       BasicBlock::iterator PrevInst;
3321       BasicBlock *BB;
3322     } Point;
3323     std::optional<DbgRecord::self_iterator> BeforeDbgRecord = std::nullopt;
3324 
3325     /// Remember whether or not the instruction had a previous instruction.
3326     bool HasPrevInstruction;
3327 
3328   public:
3329     /// Record the position of \p Inst.
InsertionHandler(Instruction * Inst)3330     InsertionHandler(Instruction *Inst) {
3331       HasPrevInstruction = (Inst != &*(Inst->getParent()->begin()));
3332       BasicBlock *BB = Inst->getParent();
3333 
3334       // Record where we would have to re-insert the instruction in the sequence
3335       // of DbgRecords, if we ended up reinserting.
3336       BeforeDbgRecord = Inst->getDbgReinsertionPosition();
3337 
3338       if (HasPrevInstruction) {
3339         Point.PrevInst = std::prev(Inst->getIterator());
3340       } else {
3341         Point.BB = BB;
3342       }
3343     }
3344 
3345     /// Insert \p Inst at the recorded position.
insert(Instruction * Inst)3346     void insert(Instruction *Inst) {
3347       if (HasPrevInstruction) {
3348         if (Inst->getParent())
3349           Inst->removeFromParent();
3350         Inst->insertAfter(Point.PrevInst);
3351       } else {
3352         BasicBlock::iterator Position = Point.BB->getFirstInsertionPt();
3353         if (Inst->getParent())
3354           Inst->moveBefore(*Point.BB, Position);
3355         else
3356           Inst->insertBefore(*Point.BB, Position);
3357       }
3358 
3359       Inst->getParent()->reinsertInstInDbgRecords(Inst, BeforeDbgRecord);
3360     }
3361   };
3362 
3363   /// Move an instruction before another.
3364   class InstructionMoveBefore : public TypePromotionAction {
3365     /// Original position of the instruction.
3366     InsertionHandler Position;
3367 
3368   public:
3369     /// Move \p Inst before \p Before.
InstructionMoveBefore(Instruction * Inst,BasicBlock::iterator Before)3370     InstructionMoveBefore(Instruction *Inst, BasicBlock::iterator Before)
3371         : TypePromotionAction(Inst), Position(Inst) {
3372       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: move: " << *Inst << "\nbefore: " << *Before
3373                         << "\n");
3374       Inst->moveBefore(Before);
3375     }
3376 
3377     /// Move the instruction back to its original position.
undo()3378     void undo() override {
3379       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: moveBefore: " << *Inst << "\n");
3380       Position.insert(Inst);
3381     }
3382   };
3383 
3384   /// Set the operand of an instruction with a new value.
3385   class OperandSetter : public TypePromotionAction {
3386     /// Original operand of the instruction.
3387     Value *Origin;
3388 
3389     /// Index of the modified instruction.
3390     unsigned Idx;
3391 
3392   public:
3393     /// Set \p Idx operand of \p Inst with \p NewVal.
OperandSetter(Instruction * Inst,unsigned Idx,Value * NewVal)3394     OperandSetter(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx, Value *NewVal)
3395         : TypePromotionAction(Inst), Idx(Idx) {
3396       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: setOperand: " << Idx << "\n"
3397                         << "for:" << *Inst << "\n"
3398                         << "with:" << *NewVal << "\n");
3399       Origin = Inst->getOperand(Idx);
3400       Inst->setOperand(Idx, NewVal);
3401     }
3402 
3403     /// Restore the original value of the instruction.
undo()3404     void undo() override {
3405       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: setOperand:" << Idx << "\n"
3406                         << "for: " << *Inst << "\n"
3407                         << "with: " << *Origin << "\n");
3408       Inst->setOperand(Idx, Origin);
3409     }
3410   };
3411 
3412   /// Hide the operands of an instruction.
3413   /// Do as if this instruction was not using any of its operands.
3414   class OperandsHider : public TypePromotionAction {
3415     /// The list of original operands.
3416     SmallVector<Value *, 4> OriginalValues;
3417 
3418   public:
3419     /// Remove \p Inst from the uses of the operands of \p Inst.
OperandsHider(Instruction * Inst)3420     OperandsHider(Instruction *Inst) : TypePromotionAction(Inst) {
3421       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: OperandsHider: " << *Inst << "\n");
3422       unsigned NumOpnds = Inst->getNumOperands();
3423       OriginalValues.reserve(NumOpnds);
3424       for (unsigned It = 0; It < NumOpnds; ++It) {
3425         // Save the current operand.
3426         Value *Val = Inst->getOperand(It);
3427         OriginalValues.push_back(Val);
3428         // Set a dummy one.
3429         // We could use OperandSetter here, but that would imply an overhead
3430         // that we are not willing to pay.
3431         Inst->setOperand(It, PoisonValue::get(Val->getType()));
3432       }
3433     }
3434 
3435     /// Restore the original list of uses.
undo()3436     void undo() override {
3437       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: OperandsHider: " << *Inst << "\n");
3438       for (unsigned It = 0, EndIt = OriginalValues.size(); It != EndIt; ++It)
3439         Inst->setOperand(It, OriginalValues[It]);
3440     }
3441   };
3442 
3443   /// Build a truncate instruction.
3444   class TruncBuilder : public TypePromotionAction {
3445     Value *Val;
3446 
3447   public:
3448     /// Build a truncate instruction of \p Opnd producing a \p Ty
3449     /// result.
3450     /// trunc Opnd to Ty.
TruncBuilder(Instruction * Opnd,Type * Ty)3451     TruncBuilder(Instruction *Opnd, Type *Ty) : TypePromotionAction(Opnd) {
3452       IRBuilder<> Builder(Opnd);
3453       Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(DebugLoc());
3454       Val = Builder.CreateTrunc(Opnd, Ty, "promoted");
3455       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: TruncBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3456     }
3457 
3458     /// Get the built value.
getBuiltValue()3459     Value *getBuiltValue() { return Val; }
3460 
3461     /// Remove the built instruction.
undo()3462     void undo() override {
3463       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: TruncBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3464       if (Instruction *IVal = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
3465         IVal->eraseFromParent();
3466     }
3467   };
3468 
3469   /// Build a sign extension instruction.
3470   class SExtBuilder : public TypePromotionAction {
3471     Value *Val;
3472 
3473   public:
3474     /// Build a sign extension instruction of \p Opnd producing a \p Ty
3475     /// result.
3476     /// sext Opnd to Ty.
SExtBuilder(Instruction * InsertPt,Value * Opnd,Type * Ty)3477     SExtBuilder(Instruction *InsertPt, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty)
3478         : TypePromotionAction(InsertPt) {
3479       IRBuilder<> Builder(InsertPt);
3480       Val = Builder.CreateSExt(Opnd, Ty, "promoted");
3481       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: SExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3482     }
3483 
3484     /// Get the built value.
getBuiltValue()3485     Value *getBuiltValue() { return Val; }
3486 
3487     /// Remove the built instruction.
undo()3488     void undo() override {
3489       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: SExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3490       if (Instruction *IVal = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
3491         IVal->eraseFromParent();
3492     }
3493   };
3494 
3495   /// Build a zero extension instruction.
3496   class ZExtBuilder : public TypePromotionAction {
3497     Value *Val;
3498 
3499   public:
3500     /// Build a zero extension instruction of \p Opnd producing a \p Ty
3501     /// result.
3502     /// zext Opnd to Ty.
ZExtBuilder(Instruction * InsertPt,Value * Opnd,Type * Ty)3503     ZExtBuilder(Instruction *InsertPt, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty)
3504         : TypePromotionAction(InsertPt) {
3505       IRBuilder<> Builder(InsertPt);
3506       Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(DebugLoc());
3507       Val = Builder.CreateZExt(Opnd, Ty, "promoted");
3508       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: ZExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3509     }
3510 
3511     /// Get the built value.
getBuiltValue()3512     Value *getBuiltValue() { return Val; }
3513 
3514     /// Remove the built instruction.
undo()3515     void undo() override {
3516       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: ZExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
3517       if (Instruction *IVal = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
3518         IVal->eraseFromParent();
3519     }
3520   };
3521 
3522   /// Mutate an instruction to another type.
3523   class TypeMutator : public TypePromotionAction {
3524     /// Record the original type.
3525     Type *OrigTy;
3526 
3527   public:
3528     /// Mutate the type of \p Inst into \p NewTy.
TypeMutator(Instruction * Inst,Type * NewTy)3529     TypeMutator(Instruction *Inst, Type *NewTy)
3530         : TypePromotionAction(Inst), OrigTy(Inst->getType()) {
3531       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: MutateType: " << *Inst << " with " << *NewTy
3532                         << "\n");
3533       Inst->mutateType(NewTy);
3534     }
3535 
3536     /// Mutate the instruction back to its original type.
undo()3537     void undo() override {
3538       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: MutateType: " << *Inst << " with " << *OrigTy
3539                         << "\n");
3540       Inst->mutateType(OrigTy);
3541     }
3542   };
3543 
3544   /// Replace the uses of an instruction by another instruction.
3545   class UsesReplacer : public TypePromotionAction {
3546     /// Helper structure to keep track of the replaced uses.
3547     struct InstructionAndIdx {
3548       /// The instruction using the instruction.
3549       Instruction *Inst;
3550 
3551       /// The index where this instruction is used for Inst.
3552       unsigned Idx;
3553 
InstructionAndIdx__anon1d600f580d11::TypePromotionTransaction::UsesReplacer::InstructionAndIdx3554       InstructionAndIdx(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx)
3555           : Inst(Inst), Idx(Idx) {}
3556     };
3557 
3558     /// Keep track of the original uses (pair Instruction, Index).
3559     SmallVector<InstructionAndIdx, 4> OriginalUses;
3560     /// Keep track of the debug users.
3561     SmallVector<DbgValueInst *, 1> DbgValues;
3562     /// And non-instruction debug-users too.
3563     SmallVector<DbgVariableRecord *, 1> DbgVariableRecords;
3564 
3565     /// Keep track of the new value so that we can undo it by replacing
3566     /// instances of the new value with the original value.
3567     Value *New;
3568 
3569     using use_iterator = SmallVectorImpl<InstructionAndIdx>::iterator;
3570 
3571   public:
3572     /// Replace all the use of \p Inst by \p New.
UsesReplacer(Instruction * Inst,Value * New)3573     UsesReplacer(Instruction *Inst, Value *New)
3574         : TypePromotionAction(Inst), New(New) {
3575       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: UsersReplacer: " << *Inst << " with " << *New
3576                         << "\n");
3577       // Record the original uses.
3578       for (Use &U : Inst->uses()) {
3579         Instruction *UserI = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
3580         OriginalUses.push_back(InstructionAndIdx(UserI, U.getOperandNo()));
3581       }
3582       // Record the debug uses separately. They are not in the instruction's
3583       // use list, but they are replaced by RAUW.
3584       findDbgValues(DbgValues, Inst, &DbgVariableRecords);
3585 
3586       // Now, we can replace the uses.
3587       Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
3588     }
3589 
3590     /// Reassign the original uses of Inst to Inst.
undo()3591     void undo() override {
3592       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: UsersReplacer: " << *Inst << "\n");
3593       for (InstructionAndIdx &Use : OriginalUses)
3594         Use.Inst->setOperand(Use.Idx, Inst);
3595       // RAUW has replaced all original uses with references to the new value,
3596       // including the debug uses. Since we are undoing the replacements,
3597       // the original debug uses must also be reinstated to maintain the
3598       // correctness and utility of debug value instructions.
3599       for (auto *DVI : DbgValues)
3600         DVI->replaceVariableLocationOp(New, Inst);
3601       // Similar story with DbgVariableRecords, the non-instruction
3602       // representation of dbg.values.
3603       for (DbgVariableRecord *DVR : DbgVariableRecords)
3604         DVR->replaceVariableLocationOp(New, Inst);
3605     }
3606   };
3607 
3608   /// Remove an instruction from the IR.
3609   class InstructionRemover : public TypePromotionAction {
3610     /// Original position of the instruction.
3611     InsertionHandler Inserter;
3612 
3613     /// Helper structure to hide all the link to the instruction. In other
3614     /// words, this helps to do as if the instruction was removed.
3615     OperandsHider Hider;
3616 
3617     /// Keep track of the uses replaced, if any.
3618     UsesReplacer *Replacer = nullptr;
3619 
3620     /// Keep track of instructions removed.
3621     SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts;
3622 
3623   public:
3624     /// Remove all reference of \p Inst and optionally replace all its
3625     /// uses with New.
3626     /// \p RemovedInsts Keep track of the instructions removed by this Action.
3627     /// \pre If !Inst->use_empty(), then New != nullptr
InstructionRemover(Instruction * Inst,SetOfInstrs & RemovedInsts,Value * New=nullptr)3628     InstructionRemover(Instruction *Inst, SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts,
3629                        Value *New = nullptr)
3630         : TypePromotionAction(Inst), Inserter(Inst), Hider(Inst),
3631           RemovedInsts(RemovedInsts) {
3632       if (New)
3633         Replacer = new UsesReplacer(Inst, New);
3634       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: InstructionRemover: " << *Inst << "\n");
3635       RemovedInsts.insert(Inst);
3636       /// The instructions removed here will be freed after completing
3637       /// optimizeBlock() for all blocks as we need to keep track of the
3638       /// removed instructions during promotion.
3639       Inst->removeFromParent();
3640     }
3641 
~InstructionRemover()3642     ~InstructionRemover() override { delete Replacer; }
3643 
3644     InstructionRemover &operator=(const InstructionRemover &other) = delete;
3645     InstructionRemover(const InstructionRemover &other) = delete;
3646 
3647     /// Resurrect the instruction and reassign it to the proper uses if
3648     /// new value was provided when build this action.
undo()3649     void undo() override {
3650       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: InstructionRemover: " << *Inst << "\n");
3651       Inserter.insert(Inst);
3652       if (Replacer)
3653         Replacer->undo();
3654       Hider.undo();
3655       RemovedInsts.erase(Inst);
3656     }
3657   };
3658 
3659 public:
3660   /// Restoration point.
3661   /// The restoration point is a pointer to an action instead of an iterator
3662   /// because the iterator may be invalidated but not the pointer.
3663   using ConstRestorationPt = const TypePromotionAction *;
3664 
TypePromotionTransaction(SetOfInstrs & RemovedInsts)3665   TypePromotionTransaction(SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts)
3666       : RemovedInsts(RemovedInsts) {}
3667 
3668   /// Advocate every changes made in that transaction. Return true if any change
3669   /// happen.
3670   bool commit();
3671 
3672   /// Undo all the changes made after the given point.
3673   void rollback(ConstRestorationPt Point);
3674 
3675   /// Get the current restoration point.
3676   ConstRestorationPt getRestorationPoint() const;
3677 
3678   /// \name API for IR modification with state keeping to support rollback.
3679   /// @{
3680   /// Same as Instruction::setOperand.
3681   void setOperand(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx, Value *NewVal);
3682 
3683   /// Same as Instruction::eraseFromParent.
3684   void eraseInstruction(Instruction *Inst, Value *NewVal = nullptr);
3685 
3686   /// Same as Value::replaceAllUsesWith.
3687   void replaceAllUsesWith(Instruction *Inst, Value *New);
3688 
3689   /// Same as Value::mutateType.
3690   void mutateType(Instruction *Inst, Type *NewTy);
3691 
3692   /// Same as IRBuilder::createTrunc.
3693   Value *createTrunc(Instruction *Opnd, Type *Ty);
3694 
3695   /// Same as IRBuilder::createSExt.
3696   Value *createSExt(Instruction *Inst, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty);
3697 
3698   /// Same as IRBuilder::createZExt.
3699   Value *createZExt(Instruction *Inst, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty);
3700 
3701 private:
3702   /// The ordered list of actions made so far.
3703   SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction>, 16> Actions;
3704 
3705   using CommitPt =
3706       SmallVectorImpl<std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction>>::iterator;
3707 
3708   SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts;
3709 };
3710 
3711 } // end anonymous namespace
3712 
setOperand(Instruction * Inst,unsigned Idx,Value * NewVal)3713 void TypePromotionTransaction::setOperand(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx,
3714                                           Value *NewVal) {
3715   Actions.push_back(std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::OperandSetter>(
3716       Inst, Idx, NewVal));
3717 }
3718 
eraseInstruction(Instruction * Inst,Value * NewVal)3719 void TypePromotionTransaction::eraseInstruction(Instruction *Inst,
3720                                                 Value *NewVal) {
3721   Actions.push_back(
3722       std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::InstructionRemover>(
3723           Inst, RemovedInsts, NewVal));
3724 }
3725 
replaceAllUsesWith(Instruction * Inst,Value * New)3726 void TypePromotionTransaction::replaceAllUsesWith(Instruction *Inst,
3727                                                   Value *New) {
3728   Actions.push_back(
3729       std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::UsesReplacer>(Inst, New));
3730 }
3731 
mutateType(Instruction * Inst,Type * NewTy)3732 void TypePromotionTransaction::mutateType(Instruction *Inst, Type *NewTy) {
3733   Actions.push_back(
3734       std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::TypeMutator>(Inst, NewTy));
3735 }
3736 
createTrunc(Instruction * Opnd,Type * Ty)3737 Value *TypePromotionTransaction::createTrunc(Instruction *Opnd, Type *Ty) {
3738   std::unique_ptr<TruncBuilder> Ptr(new TruncBuilder(Opnd, Ty));
3739   Value *Val = Ptr->getBuiltValue();
3740   Actions.push_back(std::move(Ptr));
3741   return Val;
3742 }
3743 
createSExt(Instruction * Inst,Value * Opnd,Type * Ty)3744 Value *TypePromotionTransaction::createSExt(Instruction *Inst, Value *Opnd,
3745                                             Type *Ty) {
3746   std::unique_ptr<SExtBuilder> Ptr(new SExtBuilder(Inst, Opnd, Ty));
3747   Value *Val = Ptr->getBuiltValue();
3748   Actions.push_back(std::move(Ptr));
3749   return Val;
3750 }
3751 
createZExt(Instruction * Inst,Value * Opnd,Type * Ty)3752 Value *TypePromotionTransaction::createZExt(Instruction *Inst, Value *Opnd,
3753                                             Type *Ty) {
3754   std::unique_ptr<ZExtBuilder> Ptr(new ZExtBuilder(Inst, Opnd, Ty));
3755   Value *Val = Ptr->getBuiltValue();
3756   Actions.push_back(std::move(Ptr));
3757   return Val;
3758 }
3759 
3760 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt
getRestorationPoint() const3761 TypePromotionTransaction::getRestorationPoint() const {
3762   return !Actions.empty() ? Actions.back().get() : nullptr;
3763 }
3764 
commit()3765 bool TypePromotionTransaction::commit() {
3766   for (std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction> &Action : Actions)
3767     Action->commit();
3768   bool Modified = !Actions.empty();
3769   Actions.clear();
3770   return Modified;
3771 }
3772 
rollback(TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt Point)3773 void TypePromotionTransaction::rollback(
3774     TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt Point) {
3775   while (!Actions.empty() && Point != Actions.back().get()) {
3776     std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction> Curr = Actions.pop_back_val();
3777     Curr->undo();
3778   }
3779 }
3780 
3781 namespace {
3782 
3783 /// A helper class for matching addressing modes.
3784 ///
3785 /// This encapsulates the logic for matching the target-legal addressing modes.
3786 class AddressingModeMatcher {
3787   SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &AddrModeInsts;
3788   const TargetLowering &TLI;
3789   const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI;
3790   const DataLayout &DL;
3791   const LoopInfo &LI;
3792   const std::function<const DominatorTree &()> getDTFn;
3793 
3794   /// AccessTy/MemoryInst - This is the type for the access (e.g. double) and
3795   /// the memory instruction that we're computing this address for.
3796   Type *AccessTy;
3797   unsigned AddrSpace;
3798   Instruction *MemoryInst;
3799 
3800   /// This is the addressing mode that we're building up. This is
3801   /// part of the return value of this addressing mode matching stuff.
3802   ExtAddrMode &AddrMode;
3803 
3804   /// The instructions inserted by other CodeGenPrepare optimizations.
3805   const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts;
3806 
3807   /// A map from the instructions to their type before promotion.
3808   InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts;
3809 
3810   /// The ongoing transaction where every action should be registered.
3811   TypePromotionTransaction &TPT;
3812 
3813   // A GEP which has too large offset to be folded into the addressing mode.
3814   std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> &LargeOffsetGEP;
3815 
3816   /// This is set to true when we should not do profitability checks.
3817   /// When true, IsProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode always returns true.
3818   bool IgnoreProfitability;
3819 
3820   /// True if we are optimizing for size.
3821   bool OptSize = false;
3822 
3823   ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI;
3824   BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI;
3825 
AddressingModeMatcher(SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & AMI,const TargetLowering & TLI,const TargetRegisterInfo & TRI,const LoopInfo & LI,const std::function<const DominatorTree & ()> getDTFn,Type * AT,unsigned AS,Instruction * MI,ExtAddrMode & AM,const SetOfInstrs & InsertedInsts,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>,int64_t> & LargeOffsetGEP,bool OptSize,ProfileSummaryInfo * PSI,BlockFrequencyInfo * BFI)3826   AddressingModeMatcher(
3827       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &AMI, const TargetLowering &TLI,
3828       const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, const LoopInfo &LI,
3829       const std::function<const DominatorTree &()> getDTFn, Type *AT,
3830       unsigned AS, Instruction *MI, ExtAddrMode &AM,
3831       const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts, InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
3832       TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
3833       std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> &LargeOffsetGEP,
3834       bool OptSize, ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI, BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI)
3835       : AddrModeInsts(AMI), TLI(TLI), TRI(TRI),
3836         DL(MI->getDataLayout()), LI(LI), getDTFn(getDTFn),
3837         AccessTy(AT), AddrSpace(AS), MemoryInst(MI), AddrMode(AM),
3838         InsertedInsts(InsertedInsts), PromotedInsts(PromotedInsts), TPT(TPT),
3839         LargeOffsetGEP(LargeOffsetGEP), OptSize(OptSize), PSI(PSI), BFI(BFI) {
3840     IgnoreProfitability = false;
3841   }
3842 
3843 public:
3844   /// Find the maximal addressing mode that a load/store of V can fold,
3845   /// give an access type of AccessTy.  This returns a list of involved
3846   /// instructions in AddrModeInsts.
3847   /// \p InsertedInsts The instructions inserted by other CodeGenPrepare
3848   /// optimizations.
3849   /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
3850   /// \p The ongoing transaction where every action should be registered.
3851   static ExtAddrMode
Match(Value * V,Type * AccessTy,unsigned AS,Instruction * MemoryInst,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & AddrModeInsts,const TargetLowering & TLI,const LoopInfo & LI,const std::function<const DominatorTree & ()> getDTFn,const TargetRegisterInfo & TRI,const SetOfInstrs & InsertedInsts,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>,int64_t> & LargeOffsetGEP,bool OptSize,ProfileSummaryInfo * PSI,BlockFrequencyInfo * BFI)3852   Match(Value *V, Type *AccessTy, unsigned AS, Instruction *MemoryInst,
3853         SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &AddrModeInsts,
3854         const TargetLowering &TLI, const LoopInfo &LI,
3855         const std::function<const DominatorTree &()> getDTFn,
3856         const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts,
3857         InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
3858         std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> &LargeOffsetGEP,
3859         bool OptSize, ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI, BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI) {
3860     ExtAddrMode Result;
3861 
3862     bool Success = AddressingModeMatcher(AddrModeInsts, TLI, TRI, LI, getDTFn,
3863                                          AccessTy, AS, MemoryInst, Result,
3864                                          InsertedInsts, PromotedInsts, TPT,
3865                                          LargeOffsetGEP, OptSize, PSI, BFI)
3866                        .matchAddr(V, 0);
3867     (void)Success;
3868     assert(Success && "Couldn't select *anything*?");
3869     return Result;
3870   }
3871 
3872 private:
3873   bool matchScaledValue(Value *ScaleReg, int64_t Scale, unsigned Depth);
3874   bool matchAddr(Value *Addr, unsigned Depth);
3875   bool matchOperationAddr(User *AddrInst, unsigned Opcode, unsigned Depth,
3876                           bool *MovedAway = nullptr);
3877   bool isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(Instruction *I,
3878                                             ExtAddrMode &AMBefore,
3879                                             ExtAddrMode &AMAfter);
3880   bool valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(Value *Val, Value *KnownLive1, Value *KnownLive2);
3881   bool isPromotionProfitable(unsigned NewCost, unsigned OldCost,
3882                              Value *PromotedOperand) const;
3883 };
3884 
3885 class PhiNodeSet;
3886 
3887 /// An iterator for PhiNodeSet.
3888 class PhiNodeSetIterator {
3889   PhiNodeSet *const Set;
3890   size_t CurrentIndex = 0;
3891 
3892 public:
3893   /// The constructor. Start should point to either a valid element, or be equal
3894   /// to the size of the underlying SmallVector of the PhiNodeSet.
3895   PhiNodeSetIterator(PhiNodeSet *const Set, size_t Start);
3896   PHINode *operator*() const;
3897   PhiNodeSetIterator &operator++();
3898   bool operator==(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const;
3899   bool operator!=(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const;
3900 };
3901 
3902 /// Keeps a set of PHINodes.
3903 ///
3904 /// This is a minimal set implementation for a specific use case:
3905 /// It is very fast when there are very few elements, but also provides good
3906 /// performance when there are many. It is similar to SmallPtrSet, but also
3907 /// provides iteration by insertion order, which is deterministic and stable
3908 /// across runs. It is also similar to SmallSetVector, but provides removing
3909 /// elements in O(1) time. This is achieved by not actually removing the element
3910 /// from the underlying vector, so comes at the cost of using more memory, but
3911 /// that is fine, since PhiNodeSets are used as short lived objects.
3912 class PhiNodeSet {
3913   friend class PhiNodeSetIterator;
3914 
3915   using MapType = SmallDenseMap<PHINode *, size_t, 32>;
3916   using iterator = PhiNodeSetIterator;
3917 
3918   /// Keeps the elements in the order of their insertion in the underlying
3919   /// vector. To achieve constant time removal, it never deletes any element.
3920   SmallVector<PHINode *, 32> NodeList;
3921 
3922   /// Keeps the elements in the underlying set implementation. This (and not the
3923   /// NodeList defined above) is the source of truth on whether an element
3924   /// is actually in the collection.
3925   MapType NodeMap;
3926 
3927   /// Points to the first valid (not deleted) element when the set is not empty
3928   /// and the value is not zero. Equals to the size of the underlying vector
3929   /// when the set is empty. When the value is 0, as in the beginning, the
3930   /// first element may or may not be valid.
3931   size_t FirstValidElement = 0;
3932 
3933 public:
3934   /// Inserts a new element to the collection.
3935   /// \returns true if the element is actually added, i.e. was not in the
3936   /// collection before the operation.
insert(PHINode * Ptr)3937   bool insert(PHINode *Ptr) {
3938     if (NodeMap.insert(std::make_pair(Ptr, NodeList.size())).second) {
3939       NodeList.push_back(Ptr);
3940       return true;
3941     }
3942     return false;
3943   }
3944 
3945   /// Removes the element from the collection.
3946   /// \returns whether the element is actually removed, i.e. was in the
3947   /// collection before the operation.
erase(PHINode * Ptr)3948   bool erase(PHINode *Ptr) {
3949     if (NodeMap.erase(Ptr)) {
3950       SkipRemovedElements(FirstValidElement);
3951       return true;
3952     }
3953     return false;
3954   }
3955 
3956   /// Removes all elements and clears the collection.
clear()3957   void clear() {
3958     NodeMap.clear();
3959     NodeList.clear();
3960     FirstValidElement = 0;
3961   }
3962 
3963   /// \returns an iterator that will iterate the elements in the order of
3964   /// insertion.
begin()3965   iterator begin() {
3966     if (FirstValidElement == 0)
3967       SkipRemovedElements(FirstValidElement);
3968     return PhiNodeSetIterator(this, FirstValidElement);
3969   }
3970 
3971   /// \returns an iterator that points to the end of the collection.
end()3972   iterator end() { return PhiNodeSetIterator(this, NodeList.size()); }
3973 
3974   /// Returns the number of elements in the collection.
size() const3975   size_t size() const { return NodeMap.size(); }
3976 
3977   /// \returns 1 if the given element is in the collection, and 0 if otherwise.
count(PHINode * Ptr) const3978   size_t count(PHINode *Ptr) const { return NodeMap.count(Ptr); }
3979 
3980 private:
3981   /// Updates the CurrentIndex so that it will point to a valid element.
3982   ///
3983   /// If the element of NodeList at CurrentIndex is valid, it does not
3984   /// change it. If there are no more valid elements, it updates CurrentIndex
3985   /// to point to the end of the NodeList.
SkipRemovedElements(size_t & CurrentIndex)3986   void SkipRemovedElements(size_t &CurrentIndex) {
3987     while (CurrentIndex < NodeList.size()) {
3988       auto it = NodeMap.find(NodeList[CurrentIndex]);
3989       // If the element has been deleted and added again later, NodeMap will
3990       // point to a different index, so CurrentIndex will still be invalid.
3991       if (it != NodeMap.end() && it->second == CurrentIndex)
3992         break;
3993       ++CurrentIndex;
3994     }
3995   }
3996 };
3997 
PhiNodeSetIterator(PhiNodeSet * const Set,size_t Start)3998 PhiNodeSetIterator::PhiNodeSetIterator(PhiNodeSet *const Set, size_t Start)
3999     : Set(Set), CurrentIndex(Start) {}
4000 
operator *() const4001 PHINode *PhiNodeSetIterator::operator*() const {
4002   assert(CurrentIndex < Set->NodeList.size() &&
4003          "PhiNodeSet access out of range");
4004   return Set->NodeList[CurrentIndex];
4005 }
4006 
operator ++()4007 PhiNodeSetIterator &PhiNodeSetIterator::operator++() {
4008   assert(CurrentIndex < Set->NodeList.size() &&
4009          "PhiNodeSet access out of range");
4010   ++CurrentIndex;
4011   Set->SkipRemovedElements(CurrentIndex);
4012   return *this;
4013 }
4014 
operator ==(const PhiNodeSetIterator & RHS) const4015 bool PhiNodeSetIterator::operator==(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const {
4016   return CurrentIndex == RHS.CurrentIndex;
4017 }
4018 
operator !=(const PhiNodeSetIterator & RHS) const4019 bool PhiNodeSetIterator::operator!=(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const {
4020   return !((*this) == RHS);
4021 }
4022 
4023 /// Keep track of simplification of Phi nodes.
4024 /// Accept the set of all phi nodes and erase phi node from this set
4025 /// if it is simplified.
4026 class SimplificationTracker {
4027   DenseMap<Value *, Value *> Storage;
4028   const SimplifyQuery &SQ;
4029   // Tracks newly created Phi nodes. The elements are iterated by insertion
4030   // order.
4031   PhiNodeSet AllPhiNodes;
4032   // Tracks newly created Select nodes.
4033   SmallPtrSet<SelectInst *, 32> AllSelectNodes;
4034 
4035 public:
SimplificationTracker(const SimplifyQuery & sq)4036   SimplificationTracker(const SimplifyQuery &sq) : SQ(sq) {}
4037 
Get(Value * V)4038   Value *Get(Value *V) {
4039     do {
4040       auto SV = Storage.find(V);
4041       if (SV == Storage.end())
4042         return V;
4043       V = SV->second;
4044     } while (true);
4045   }
4046 
Simplify(Value * Val)4047   Value *Simplify(Value *Val) {
4048     SmallVector<Value *, 32> WorkList;
4049     SmallPtrSet<Value *, 32> Visited;
4050     WorkList.push_back(Val);
4051     while (!WorkList.empty()) {
4052       auto *P = WorkList.pop_back_val();
4053       if (!Visited.insert(P).second)
4054         continue;
4055       if (auto *PI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(P))
4056         if (Value *V = simplifyInstruction(cast<Instruction>(PI), SQ)) {
4057           for (auto *U : PI->users())
4058             WorkList.push_back(cast<Value>(U));
4059           Put(PI, V);
4060           PI->replaceAllUsesWith(V);
4061           if (auto *PHI = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PI))
4062             AllPhiNodes.erase(PHI);
4063           if (auto *Select = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(PI))
4064             AllSelectNodes.erase(Select);
4065           PI->eraseFromParent();
4066         }
4067     }
4068     return Get(Val);
4069   }
4070 
Put(Value * From,Value * To)4071   void Put(Value *From, Value *To) { Storage.insert({From, To}); }
4072 
ReplacePhi(PHINode * From,PHINode * To)4073   void ReplacePhi(PHINode *From, PHINode *To) {
4074     Value *OldReplacement = Get(From);
4075     while (OldReplacement != From) {
4076       From = To;
4077       To = dyn_cast<PHINode>(OldReplacement);
4078       OldReplacement = Get(From);
4079     }
4080     assert(To && Get(To) == To && "Replacement PHI node is already replaced.");
4081     Put(From, To);
4082     From->replaceAllUsesWith(To);
4083     AllPhiNodes.erase(From);
4084     From->eraseFromParent();
4085   }
4086 
newPhiNodes()4087   PhiNodeSet &newPhiNodes() { return AllPhiNodes; }
4088 
insertNewPhi(PHINode * PN)4089   void insertNewPhi(PHINode *PN) { AllPhiNodes.insert(PN); }
4090 
insertNewSelect(SelectInst * SI)4091   void insertNewSelect(SelectInst *SI) { AllSelectNodes.insert(SI); }
4092 
countNewPhiNodes() const4093   unsigned countNewPhiNodes() const { return AllPhiNodes.size(); }
4094 
countNewSelectNodes() const4095   unsigned countNewSelectNodes() const { return AllSelectNodes.size(); }
4096 
destroyNewNodes(Type * CommonType)4097   void destroyNewNodes(Type *CommonType) {
4098     // For safe erasing, replace the uses with dummy value first.
4099     auto *Dummy = PoisonValue::get(CommonType);
4100     for (auto *I : AllPhiNodes) {
4101       I->replaceAllUsesWith(Dummy);
4102       I->eraseFromParent();
4103     }
4104     AllPhiNodes.clear();
4105     for (auto *I : AllSelectNodes) {
4106       I->replaceAllUsesWith(Dummy);
4107       I->eraseFromParent();
4108     }
4109     AllSelectNodes.clear();
4110   }
4111 };
4112 
4113 /// A helper class for combining addressing modes.
4114 class AddressingModeCombiner {
4115   typedef DenseMap<Value *, Value *> FoldAddrToValueMapping;
4116   typedef std::pair<PHINode *, PHINode *> PHIPair;
4117 
4118 private:
4119   /// The addressing modes we've collected.
4120   SmallVector<ExtAddrMode, 16> AddrModes;
4121 
4122   /// The field in which the AddrModes differ, when we have more than one.
4123   ExtAddrMode::FieldName DifferentField = ExtAddrMode::NoField;
4124 
4125   /// Are the AddrModes that we have all just equal to their original values?
4126   bool AllAddrModesTrivial = true;
4127 
4128   /// Common Type for all different fields in addressing modes.
4129   Type *CommonType = nullptr;
4130 
4131   /// SimplifyQuery for simplifyInstruction utility.
4132   const SimplifyQuery &SQ;
4133 
4134   /// Original Address.
4135   Value *Original;
4136 
4137   /// Common value among addresses
4138   Value *CommonValue = nullptr;
4139 
4140 public:
AddressingModeCombiner(const SimplifyQuery & _SQ,Value * OriginalValue)4141   AddressingModeCombiner(const SimplifyQuery &_SQ, Value *OriginalValue)
4142       : SQ(_SQ), Original(OriginalValue) {}
4143 
~AddressingModeCombiner()4144   ~AddressingModeCombiner() { eraseCommonValueIfDead(); }
4145 
4146   /// Get the combined AddrMode
getAddrMode() const4147   const ExtAddrMode &getAddrMode() const { return AddrModes[0]; }
4148 
4149   /// Add a new AddrMode if it's compatible with the AddrModes we already
4150   /// have.
4151   /// \return True iff we succeeded in doing so.
addNewAddrMode(ExtAddrMode & NewAddrMode)4152   bool addNewAddrMode(ExtAddrMode &NewAddrMode) {
4153     // Take note of if we have any non-trivial AddrModes, as we need to detect
4154     // when all AddrModes are trivial as then we would introduce a phi or select
4155     // which just duplicates what's already there.
4156     AllAddrModesTrivial = AllAddrModesTrivial && NewAddrMode.isTrivial();
4157 
4158     // If this is the first addrmode then everything is fine.
4159     if (AddrModes.empty()) {
4160       AddrModes.emplace_back(NewAddrMode);
4161       return true;
4162     }
4163 
4164     // Figure out how different this is from the other address modes, which we
4165     // can do just by comparing against the first one given that we only care
4166     // about the cumulative difference.
4167     ExtAddrMode::FieldName ThisDifferentField =
4168         AddrModes[0].compare(NewAddrMode);
4169     if (DifferentField == ExtAddrMode::NoField)
4170       DifferentField = ThisDifferentField;
4171     else if (DifferentField != ThisDifferentField)
4172       DifferentField = ExtAddrMode::MultipleFields;
4173 
4174     // If NewAddrMode differs in more than one dimension we cannot handle it.
4175     bool CanHandle = DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::MultipleFields;
4176 
4177     // If Scale Field is different then we reject.
4178     CanHandle = CanHandle && DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::ScaleField;
4179 
4180     // We also must reject the case when base offset is different and
4181     // scale reg is not null, we cannot handle this case due to merge of
4182     // different offsets will be used as ScaleReg.
4183     CanHandle = CanHandle && (DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::BaseOffsField ||
4184                               !NewAddrMode.ScaledReg);
4185 
4186     // We also must reject the case when GV is different and BaseReg installed
4187     // due to we want to use base reg as a merge of GV values.
4188     CanHandle = CanHandle && (DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::BaseGVField ||
4189                               !NewAddrMode.HasBaseReg);
4190 
4191     // Even if NewAddMode is the same we still need to collect it due to
4192     // original value is different. And later we will need all original values
4193     // as anchors during finding the common Phi node.
4194     if (CanHandle)
4195       AddrModes.emplace_back(NewAddrMode);
4196     else
4197       AddrModes.clear();
4198 
4199     return CanHandle;
4200   }
4201 
4202   /// Combine the addressing modes we've collected into a single
4203   /// addressing mode.
4204   /// \return True iff we successfully combined them or we only had one so
4205   /// didn't need to combine them anyway.
combineAddrModes()4206   bool combineAddrModes() {
4207     // If we have no AddrModes then they can't be combined.
4208     if (AddrModes.size() == 0)
4209       return false;
4210 
4211     // A single AddrMode can trivially be combined.
4212     if (AddrModes.size() == 1 || DifferentField == ExtAddrMode::NoField)
4213       return true;
4214 
4215     // If the AddrModes we collected are all just equal to the value they are
4216     // derived from then combining them wouldn't do anything useful.
4217     if (AllAddrModesTrivial)
4218       return false;
4219 
4220     if (!addrModeCombiningAllowed())
4221       return false;
4222 
4223     // Build a map between <original value, basic block where we saw it> to
4224     // value of base register.
4225     // Bail out if there is no common type.
4226     FoldAddrToValueMapping Map;
4227     if (!initializeMap(Map))
4228       return false;
4229 
4230     CommonValue = findCommon(Map);
4231     if (CommonValue)
4232       AddrModes[0].SetCombinedField(DifferentField, CommonValue, AddrModes);
4233     return CommonValue != nullptr;
4234   }
4235 
4236 private:
4237   /// `CommonValue` may be a placeholder inserted by us.
4238   /// If the placeholder is not used, we should remove this dead instruction.
eraseCommonValueIfDead()4239   void eraseCommonValueIfDead() {
4240     if (CommonValue && CommonValue->use_empty())
4241       if (Instruction *CommonInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CommonValue))
4242         CommonInst->eraseFromParent();
4243   }
4244 
4245   /// Initialize Map with anchor values. For address seen
4246   /// we set the value of different field saw in this address.
4247   /// At the same time we find a common type for different field we will
4248   /// use to create new Phi/Select nodes. Keep it in CommonType field.
4249   /// Return false if there is no common type found.
initializeMap(FoldAddrToValueMapping & Map)4250   bool initializeMap(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map) {
4251     // Keep track of keys where the value is null. We will need to replace it
4252     // with constant null when we know the common type.
4253     SmallVector<Value *, 2> NullValue;
4254     Type *IntPtrTy = SQ.DL.getIntPtrType(AddrModes[0].OriginalValue->getType());
4255     for (auto &AM : AddrModes) {
4256       Value *DV = AM.GetFieldAsValue(DifferentField, IntPtrTy);
4257       if (DV) {
4258         auto *Type = DV->getType();
4259         if (CommonType && CommonType != Type)
4260           return false;
4261         CommonType = Type;
4262         Map[AM.OriginalValue] = DV;
4263       } else {
4264         NullValue.push_back(AM.OriginalValue);
4265       }
4266     }
4267     assert(CommonType && "At least one non-null value must be!");
4268     for (auto *V : NullValue)
4269       Map[V] = Constant::getNullValue(CommonType);
4270     return true;
4271   }
4272 
4273   /// We have mapping between value A and other value B where B was a field in
4274   /// addressing mode represented by A. Also we have an original value C
4275   /// representing an address we start with. Traversing from C through phi and
4276   /// selects we ended up with A's in a map. This utility function tries to find
4277   /// a value V which is a field in addressing mode C and traversing through phi
4278   /// nodes and selects we will end up in corresponded values B in a map.
4279   /// The utility will create a new Phi/Selects if needed.
4280   // The simple example looks as follows:
4281   // BB1:
4282   //   p1 = b1 + 40
4283   //   br cond BB2, BB3
4284   // BB2:
4285   //   p2 = b2 + 40
4286   //   br BB3
4287   // BB3:
4288   //   p = phi [p1, BB1], [p2, BB2]
4289   //   v = load p
4290   // Map is
4291   //   p1 -> b1
4292   //   p2 -> b2
4293   // Request is
4294   //   p -> ?
4295   // The function tries to find or build phi [b1, BB1], [b2, BB2] in BB3.
findCommon(FoldAddrToValueMapping & Map)4296   Value *findCommon(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map) {
4297     // Tracks the simplification of newly created phi nodes. The reason we use
4298     // this mapping is because we will add new created Phi nodes in AddrToBase.
4299     // Simplification of Phi nodes is recursive, so some Phi node may
4300     // be simplified after we added it to AddrToBase. In reality this
4301     // simplification is possible only if original phi/selects were not
4302     // simplified yet.
4303     // Using this mapping we can find the current value in AddrToBase.
4304     SimplificationTracker ST(SQ);
4305 
4306     // First step, DFS to create PHI nodes for all intermediate blocks.
4307     // Also fill traverse order for the second step.
4308     SmallVector<Value *, 32> TraverseOrder;
4309     InsertPlaceholders(Map, TraverseOrder, ST);
4310 
4311     // Second Step, fill new nodes by merged values and simplify if possible.
4312     FillPlaceholders(Map, TraverseOrder, ST);
4313 
4314     if (!AddrSinkNewSelects && ST.countNewSelectNodes() > 0) {
4315       ST.destroyNewNodes(CommonType);
4316       return nullptr;
4317     }
4318 
4319     // Now we'd like to match New Phi nodes to existed ones.
4320     unsigned PhiNotMatchedCount = 0;
4321     if (!MatchPhiSet(ST, AddrSinkNewPhis, PhiNotMatchedCount)) {
4322       ST.destroyNewNodes(CommonType);
4323       return nullptr;
4324     }
4325 
4326     auto *Result = ST.Get(Map.find(Original)->second);
4327     if (Result) {
4328       NumMemoryInstsPhiCreated += ST.countNewPhiNodes() + PhiNotMatchedCount;
4329       NumMemoryInstsSelectCreated += ST.countNewSelectNodes();
4330     }
4331     return Result;
4332   }
4333 
4334   /// Try to match PHI node to Candidate.
4335   /// Matcher tracks the matched Phi nodes.
MatchPhiNode(PHINode * PHI,PHINode * Candidate,SmallSetVector<PHIPair,8> & Matcher,PhiNodeSet & PhiNodesToMatch)4336   bool MatchPhiNode(PHINode *PHI, PHINode *Candidate,
4337                     SmallSetVector<PHIPair, 8> &Matcher,
4338                     PhiNodeSet &PhiNodesToMatch) {
4339     SmallVector<PHIPair, 8> WorkList;
4340     Matcher.insert({PHI, Candidate});
4341     SmallSet<PHINode *, 8> MatchedPHIs;
4342     MatchedPHIs.insert(PHI);
4343     WorkList.push_back({PHI, Candidate});
4344     SmallSet<PHIPair, 8> Visited;
4345     while (!WorkList.empty()) {
4346       auto Item = WorkList.pop_back_val();
4347       if (!Visited.insert(Item).second)
4348         continue;
4349       // We iterate over all incoming values to Phi to compare them.
4350       // If values are different and both of them Phi and the first one is a
4351       // Phi we added (subject to match) and both of them is in the same basic
4352       // block then we can match our pair if values match. So we state that
4353       // these values match and add it to work list to verify that.
4354       for (auto *B : Item.first->blocks()) {
4355         Value *FirstValue = Item.first->getIncomingValueForBlock(B);
4356         Value *SecondValue = Item.second->getIncomingValueForBlock(B);
4357         if (FirstValue == SecondValue)
4358           continue;
4359 
4360         PHINode *FirstPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(FirstValue);
4361         PHINode *SecondPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(SecondValue);
4362 
4363         // One of them is not Phi or
4364         // The first one is not Phi node from the set we'd like to match or
4365         // Phi nodes from different basic blocks then
4366         // we will not be able to match.
4367         if (!FirstPhi || !SecondPhi || !PhiNodesToMatch.count(FirstPhi) ||
4368             FirstPhi->getParent() != SecondPhi->getParent())
4369           return false;
4370 
4371         // If we already matched them then continue.
4372         if (Matcher.count({FirstPhi, SecondPhi}))
4373           continue;
4374         // So the values are different and does not match. So we need them to
4375         // match. (But we register no more than one match per PHI node, so that
4376         // we won't later try to replace them twice.)
4377         if (MatchedPHIs.insert(FirstPhi).second)
4378           Matcher.insert({FirstPhi, SecondPhi});
4379         // But me must check it.
4380         WorkList.push_back({FirstPhi, SecondPhi});
4381       }
4382     }
4383     return true;
4384   }
4385 
4386   /// For the given set of PHI nodes (in the SimplificationTracker) try
4387   /// to find their equivalents.
4388   /// Returns false if this matching fails and creation of new Phi is disabled.
MatchPhiSet(SimplificationTracker & ST,bool AllowNewPhiNodes,unsigned & PhiNotMatchedCount)4389   bool MatchPhiSet(SimplificationTracker &ST, bool AllowNewPhiNodes,
4390                    unsigned &PhiNotMatchedCount) {
4391     // Matched and PhiNodesToMatch iterate their elements in a deterministic
4392     // order, so the replacements (ReplacePhi) are also done in a deterministic
4393     // order.
4394     SmallSetVector<PHIPair, 8> Matched;
4395     SmallPtrSet<PHINode *, 8> WillNotMatch;
4396     PhiNodeSet &PhiNodesToMatch = ST.newPhiNodes();
4397     while (PhiNodesToMatch.size()) {
4398       PHINode *PHI = *PhiNodesToMatch.begin();
4399 
4400       // Add us, if no Phi nodes in the basic block we do not match.
4401       WillNotMatch.clear();
4402       WillNotMatch.insert(PHI);
4403 
4404       // Traverse all Phis until we found equivalent or fail to do that.
4405       bool IsMatched = false;
4406       for (auto &P : PHI->getParent()->phis()) {
4407         // Skip new Phi nodes.
4408         if (PhiNodesToMatch.count(&P))
4409           continue;
4410         if ((IsMatched = MatchPhiNode(PHI, &P, Matched, PhiNodesToMatch)))
4411           break;
4412         // If it does not match, collect all Phi nodes from matcher.
4413         // if we end up with no match, them all these Phi nodes will not match
4414         // later.
4415         WillNotMatch.insert_range(llvm::make_first_range(Matched));
4416         Matched.clear();
4417       }
4418       if (IsMatched) {
4419         // Replace all matched values and erase them.
4420         for (auto MV : Matched)
4421           ST.ReplacePhi(MV.first, MV.second);
4422         Matched.clear();
4423         continue;
4424       }
4425       // If we are not allowed to create new nodes then bail out.
4426       if (!AllowNewPhiNodes)
4427         return false;
4428       // Just remove all seen values in matcher. They will not match anything.
4429       PhiNotMatchedCount += WillNotMatch.size();
4430       for (auto *P : WillNotMatch)
4431         PhiNodesToMatch.erase(P);
4432     }
4433     return true;
4434   }
4435   /// Fill the placeholders with values from predecessors and simplify them.
FillPlaceholders(FoldAddrToValueMapping & Map,SmallVectorImpl<Value * > & TraverseOrder,SimplificationTracker & ST)4436   void FillPlaceholders(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map,
4437                         SmallVectorImpl<Value *> &TraverseOrder,
4438                         SimplificationTracker &ST) {
4439     while (!TraverseOrder.empty()) {
4440       Value *Current = TraverseOrder.pop_back_val();
4441       assert(Map.contains(Current) && "No node to fill!!!");
4442       Value *V = Map[Current];
4443 
4444       if (SelectInst *Select = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
4445         // CurrentValue also must be Select.
4446         auto *CurrentSelect = cast<SelectInst>(Current);
4447         auto *TrueValue = CurrentSelect->getTrueValue();
4448         assert(Map.contains(TrueValue) && "No True Value!");
4449         Select->setTrueValue(ST.Get(Map[TrueValue]));
4450         auto *FalseValue = CurrentSelect->getFalseValue();
4451         assert(Map.contains(FalseValue) && "No False Value!");
4452         Select->setFalseValue(ST.Get(Map[FalseValue]));
4453       } else {
4454         // Must be a Phi node then.
4455         auto *PHI = cast<PHINode>(V);
4456         // Fill the Phi node with values from predecessors.
4457         for (auto *B : predecessors(PHI->getParent())) {
4458           Value *PV = cast<PHINode>(Current)->getIncomingValueForBlock(B);
4459           assert(Map.contains(PV) && "No predecessor Value!");
4460           PHI->addIncoming(ST.Get(Map[PV]), B);
4461         }
4462       }
4463       Map[Current] = ST.Simplify(V);
4464     }
4465   }
4466 
4467   /// Starting from original value recursively iterates over def-use chain up to
4468   /// known ending values represented in a map. For each traversed phi/select
4469   /// inserts a placeholder Phi or Select.
4470   /// Reports all new created Phi/Select nodes by adding them to set.
4471   /// Also reports and order in what values have been traversed.
InsertPlaceholders(FoldAddrToValueMapping & Map,SmallVectorImpl<Value * > & TraverseOrder,SimplificationTracker & ST)4472   void InsertPlaceholders(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map,
4473                           SmallVectorImpl<Value *> &TraverseOrder,
4474                           SimplificationTracker &ST) {
4475     SmallVector<Value *, 32> Worklist;
4476     assert((isa<PHINode>(Original) || isa<SelectInst>(Original)) &&
4477            "Address must be a Phi or Select node");
4478     auto *Dummy = PoisonValue::get(CommonType);
4479     Worklist.push_back(Original);
4480     while (!Worklist.empty()) {
4481       Value *Current = Worklist.pop_back_val();
4482       // if it is already visited or it is an ending value then skip it.
4483       if (Map.contains(Current))
4484         continue;
4485       TraverseOrder.push_back(Current);
4486 
4487       // CurrentValue must be a Phi node or select. All others must be covered
4488       // by anchors.
4489       if (SelectInst *CurrentSelect = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Current)) {
4490         // Is it OK to get metadata from OrigSelect?!
4491         // Create a Select placeholder with dummy value.
4492         SelectInst *Select =
4493             SelectInst::Create(CurrentSelect->getCondition(), Dummy, Dummy,
4494                                CurrentSelect->getName(),
4495                                CurrentSelect->getIterator(), CurrentSelect);
4496         Map[Current] = Select;
4497         ST.insertNewSelect(Select);
4498         // We are interested in True and False values.
4499         Worklist.push_back(CurrentSelect->getTrueValue());
4500         Worklist.push_back(CurrentSelect->getFalseValue());
4501       } else {
4502         // It must be a Phi node then.
4503         PHINode *CurrentPhi = cast<PHINode>(Current);
4504         unsigned PredCount = CurrentPhi->getNumIncomingValues();
4505         PHINode *PHI =
4506             PHINode::Create(CommonType, PredCount, "sunk_phi", CurrentPhi->getIterator());
4507         Map[Current] = PHI;
4508         ST.insertNewPhi(PHI);
4509         append_range(Worklist, CurrentPhi->incoming_values());
4510       }
4511     }
4512   }
4513 
addrModeCombiningAllowed()4514   bool addrModeCombiningAllowed() {
4515     if (DisableComplexAddrModes)
4516       return false;
4517     switch (DifferentField) {
4518     default:
4519       return false;
4520     case ExtAddrMode::BaseRegField:
4521       return AddrSinkCombineBaseReg;
4522     case ExtAddrMode::BaseGVField:
4523       return AddrSinkCombineBaseGV;
4524     case ExtAddrMode::BaseOffsField:
4525       return AddrSinkCombineBaseOffs;
4526     case ExtAddrMode::ScaledRegField:
4527       return AddrSinkCombineScaledReg;
4528     }
4529   }
4530 };
4531 } // end anonymous namespace
4532 
4533 /// Try adding ScaleReg*Scale to the current addressing mode.
4534 /// Return true and update AddrMode if this addr mode is legal for the target,
4535 /// false if not.
matchScaledValue(Value * ScaleReg,int64_t Scale,unsigned Depth)4536 bool AddressingModeMatcher::matchScaledValue(Value *ScaleReg, int64_t Scale,
4537                                              unsigned Depth) {
4538   // If Scale is 1, then this is the same as adding ScaleReg to the addressing
4539   // mode.  Just process that directly.
4540   if (Scale == 1)
4541     return matchAddr(ScaleReg, Depth);
4542 
4543   // If the scale is 0, it takes nothing to add this.
4544   if (Scale == 0)
4545     return true;
4546 
4547   // If we already have a scale of this value, we can add to it, otherwise, we
4548   // need an available scale field.
4549   if (AddrMode.Scale != 0 && AddrMode.ScaledReg != ScaleReg)
4550     return false;
4551 
4552   ExtAddrMode TestAddrMode = AddrMode;
4553 
4554   // Add scale to turn X*4+X*3 -> X*7.  This could also do things like
4555   // [A+B + A*7] -> [B+A*8].
4556   TestAddrMode.Scale += Scale;
4557   TestAddrMode.ScaledReg = ScaleReg;
4558 
4559   // If the new address isn't legal, bail out.
4560   if (!TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, TestAddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
4561     return false;
4562 
4563   // It was legal, so commit it.
4564   AddrMode = TestAddrMode;
4565 
4566   // Okay, we decided that we can add ScaleReg+Scale to AddrMode.  Check now
4567   // to see if ScaleReg is actually X+C.  If so, we can turn this into adding
4568   // X*Scale + C*Scale to addr mode. If we found available IV increment, do not
4569   // go any further: we can reuse it and cannot eliminate it.
4570   ConstantInt *CI = nullptr;
4571   Value *AddLHS = nullptr;
4572   if (isa<Instruction>(ScaleReg) && // not a constant expr.
4573       match(ScaleReg, m_Add(m_Value(AddLHS), m_ConstantInt(CI))) &&
4574       !isIVIncrement(ScaleReg, &LI) && CI->getValue().isSignedIntN(64)) {
4575     TestAddrMode.InBounds = false;
4576     TestAddrMode.ScaledReg = AddLHS;
4577     TestAddrMode.BaseOffs += CI->getSExtValue() * TestAddrMode.Scale;
4578 
4579     // If this addressing mode is legal, commit it and remember that we folded
4580     // this instruction.
4581     if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, TestAddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace)) {
4582       AddrModeInsts.push_back(cast<Instruction>(ScaleReg));
4583       AddrMode = TestAddrMode;
4584       return true;
4585     }
4586     // Restore status quo.
4587     TestAddrMode = AddrMode;
4588   }
4589 
4590   // If this is an add recurrence with a constant step, return the increment
4591   // instruction and the canonicalized step.
4592   auto GetConstantStep =
4593       [this](const Value *V) -> std::optional<std::pair<Instruction *, APInt>> {
4594     auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V);
4595     if (!PN)
4596       return std::nullopt;
4597     auto IVInc = getIVIncrement(PN, &LI);
4598     if (!IVInc)
4599       return std::nullopt;
4600     // TODO: The result of the intrinsics above is two-complement. However when
4601     // IV inc is expressed as add or sub, iv.next is potentially a poison value.
4602     // If it has nuw or nsw flags, we need to make sure that these flags are
4603     // inferrable at the point of memory instruction. Otherwise we are replacing
4604     // well-defined two-complement computation with poison. Currently, to avoid
4605     // potentially complex analysis needed to prove this, we reject such cases.
4606     if (auto *OIVInc = dyn_cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(IVInc->first))
4607       if (OIVInc->hasNoSignedWrap() || OIVInc->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
4608         return std::nullopt;
4609     if (auto *ConstantStep = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IVInc->second))
4610       return std::make_pair(IVInc->first, ConstantStep->getValue());
4611     return std::nullopt;
4612   };
4613 
4614   // Try to account for the following special case:
4615   // 1. ScaleReg is an inductive variable;
4616   // 2. We use it with non-zero offset;
4617   // 3. IV's increment is available at the point of memory instruction.
4618   //
4619   // In this case, we may reuse the IV increment instead of the IV Phi to
4620   // achieve the following advantages:
4621   // 1. If IV step matches the offset, we will have no need in the offset;
4622   // 2. Even if they don't match, we will reduce the overlap of living IV
4623   //    and IV increment, that will potentially lead to better register
4624   //    assignment.
4625   if (AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
4626     if (auto IVStep = GetConstantStep(ScaleReg)) {
4627       Instruction *IVInc = IVStep->first;
4628       // The following assert is important to ensure a lack of infinite loops.
4629       // This transforms is (intentionally) the inverse of the one just above.
4630       // If they don't agree on the definition of an increment, we'd alternate
4631       // back and forth indefinitely.
4632       assert(isIVIncrement(IVInc, &LI) && "implied by GetConstantStep");
4633       APInt Step = IVStep->second;
4634       APInt Offset = Step * AddrMode.Scale;
4635       if (Offset.isSignedIntN(64)) {
4636         TestAddrMode.InBounds = false;
4637         TestAddrMode.ScaledReg = IVInc;
4638         TestAddrMode.BaseOffs -= Offset.getLimitedValue();
4639         // If this addressing mode is legal, commit it..
4640         // (Note that we defer the (expensive) domtree base legality check
4641         // to the very last possible point.)
4642         if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, TestAddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace) &&
4643             getDTFn().dominates(IVInc, MemoryInst)) {
4644           AddrModeInsts.push_back(cast<Instruction>(IVInc));
4645           AddrMode = TestAddrMode;
4646           return true;
4647         }
4648         // Restore status quo.
4649         TestAddrMode = AddrMode;
4650       }
4651     }
4652   }
4653 
4654   // Otherwise, just return what we have.
4655   return true;
4656 }
4657 
4658 /// This is a little filter, which returns true if an addressing computation
4659 /// involving I might be folded into a load/store accessing it.
4660 /// This doesn't need to be perfect, but needs to accept at least
4661 /// the set of instructions that MatchOperationAddr can.
MightBeFoldableInst(Instruction * I)4662 static bool MightBeFoldableInst(Instruction *I) {
4663   switch (I->getOpcode()) {
4664   case Instruction::BitCast:
4665   case Instruction::AddrSpaceCast:
4666     // Don't touch identity bitcasts.
4667     if (I->getType() == I->getOperand(0)->getType())
4668       return false;
4669     return I->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy();
4670   case Instruction::PtrToInt:
4671     // PtrToInt is always a noop, as we know that the int type is pointer sized.
4672     return true;
4673   case Instruction::IntToPtr:
4674     // We know the input is intptr_t, so this is foldable.
4675     return true;
4676   case Instruction::Add:
4677     return true;
4678   case Instruction::Mul:
4679   case Instruction::Shl:
4680     // Can only handle X*C and X << C.
4681     return isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
4682   case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
4683     return true;
4684   default:
4685     return false;
4686   }
4687 }
4688 
4689 /// Check whether or not \p Val is a legal instruction for \p TLI.
4690 /// \note \p Val is assumed to be the product of some type promotion.
4691 /// Therefore if \p Val has an undefined state in \p TLI, this is assumed
4692 /// to be legal, as the non-promoted value would have had the same state.
isPromotedInstructionLegal(const TargetLowering & TLI,const DataLayout & DL,Value * Val)4693 static bool isPromotedInstructionLegal(const TargetLowering &TLI,
4694                                        const DataLayout &DL, Value *Val) {
4695   Instruction *PromotedInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val);
4696   if (!PromotedInst)
4697     return false;
4698   int ISDOpcode = TLI.InstructionOpcodeToISD(PromotedInst->getOpcode());
4699   // If the ISDOpcode is undefined, it was undefined before the promotion.
4700   if (!ISDOpcode)
4701     return true;
4702   // Otherwise, check if the promoted instruction is legal or not.
4703   return TLI.isOperationLegalOrCustom(
4704       ISDOpcode, TLI.getValueType(DL, PromotedInst->getType()));
4705 }
4706 
4707 namespace {
4708 
4709 /// Hepler class to perform type promotion.
4710 class TypePromotionHelper {
4711   /// Utility function to add a promoted instruction \p ExtOpnd to
4712   /// \p PromotedInsts and record the type of extension we have seen.
addPromotedInst(InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,Instruction * ExtOpnd,bool IsSExt)4713   static void addPromotedInst(InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
4714                               Instruction *ExtOpnd, bool IsSExt) {
4715     ExtType ExtTy = IsSExt ? SignExtension : ZeroExtension;
4716     auto [It, Inserted] = PromotedInsts.try_emplace(ExtOpnd);
4717     if (!Inserted) {
4718       // If the new extension is same as original, the information in
4719       // PromotedInsts[ExtOpnd] is still correct.
4720       if (It->second.getInt() == ExtTy)
4721         return;
4722 
4723       // Now the new extension is different from old extension, we make
4724       // the type information invalid by setting extension type to
4725       // BothExtension.
4726       ExtTy = BothExtension;
4727     }
4728     It->second = TypeIsSExt(ExtOpnd->getType(), ExtTy);
4729   }
4730 
4731   /// Utility function to query the original type of instruction \p Opnd
4732   /// with a matched extension type. If the extension doesn't match, we
4733   /// cannot use the information we had on the original type.
4734   /// BothExtension doesn't match any extension type.
getOrigType(const InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,Instruction * Opnd,bool IsSExt)4735   static const Type *getOrigType(const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
4736                                  Instruction *Opnd, bool IsSExt) {
4737     ExtType ExtTy = IsSExt ? SignExtension : ZeroExtension;
4738     InstrToOrigTy::const_iterator It = PromotedInsts.find(Opnd);
4739     if (It != PromotedInsts.end() && It->second.getInt() == ExtTy)
4740       return It->second.getPointer();
4741     return nullptr;
4742   }
4743 
4744   /// Utility function to check whether or not a sign or zero extension
4745   /// of \p Inst with \p ConsideredExtType can be moved through \p Inst by
4746   /// either using the operands of \p Inst or promoting \p Inst.
4747   /// The type of the extension is defined by \p IsSExt.
4748   /// In other words, check if:
4749   /// ext (Ty Inst opnd1 opnd2 ... opndN) to ConsideredExtType.
4750   /// #1 Promotion applies:
4751   /// ConsideredExtType Inst (ext opnd1 to ConsideredExtType, ...).
4752   /// #2 Operand reuses:
4753   /// ext opnd1 to ConsideredExtType.
4754   /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
4755   static bool canGetThrough(const Instruction *Inst, Type *ConsideredExtType,
4756                             const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, bool IsSExt);
4757 
4758   /// Utility function to determine if \p OpIdx should be promoted when
4759   /// promoting \p Inst.
shouldExtOperand(const Instruction * Inst,int OpIdx)4760   static bool shouldExtOperand(const Instruction *Inst, int OpIdx) {
4761     return !(isa<SelectInst>(Inst) && OpIdx == 0);
4762   }
4763 
4764   /// Utility function to promote the operand of \p Ext when this
4765   /// operand is a promotable trunc or sext or zext.
4766   /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
4767   /// \p CreatedInstsCost[out] contains the cost of all instructions
4768   /// created to promote the operand of Ext.
4769   /// Newly added extensions are inserted in \p Exts.
4770   /// Newly added truncates are inserted in \p Truncs.
4771   /// Should never be called directly.
4772   /// \return The promoted value which is used instead of Ext.
4773   static Value *promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt(
4774       Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4775       InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4776       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4777       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI);
4778 
4779   /// Utility function to promote the operand of \p Ext when this
4780   /// operand is promotable and is not a supported trunc or sext.
4781   /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
4782   /// \p CreatedInstsCost[out] contains the cost of all the instructions
4783   /// created to promote the operand of Ext.
4784   /// Newly added extensions are inserted in \p Exts.
4785   /// Newly added truncates are inserted in \p Truncs.
4786   /// Should never be called directly.
4787   /// \return The promoted value which is used instead of Ext.
4788   static Value *promoteOperandForOther(Instruction *Ext,
4789                                        TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4790                                        InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
4791                                        unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4792                                        SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4793                                        SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs,
4794                                        const TargetLowering &TLI, bool IsSExt);
4795 
4796   /// \see promoteOperandForOther.
signExtendOperandForOther(Instruction * Ext,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,unsigned & CreatedInstsCost,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Exts,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Truncs,const TargetLowering & TLI)4797   static Value *signExtendOperandForOther(
4798       Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4799       InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4800       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4801       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
4802     return promoteOperandForOther(Ext, TPT, PromotedInsts, CreatedInstsCost,
4803                                   Exts, Truncs, TLI, true);
4804   }
4805 
4806   /// \see promoteOperandForOther.
zeroExtendOperandForOther(Instruction * Ext,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,unsigned & CreatedInstsCost,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Exts,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Truncs,const TargetLowering & TLI)4807   static Value *zeroExtendOperandForOther(
4808       Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4809       InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4810       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4811       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
4812     return promoteOperandForOther(Ext, TPT, PromotedInsts, CreatedInstsCost,
4813                                   Exts, Truncs, TLI, false);
4814   }
4815 
4816 public:
4817   /// Type for the utility function that promotes the operand of Ext.
4818   using Action = Value *(*)(Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4819                             InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
4820                             unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4821                             SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4822                             SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs,
4823                             const TargetLowering &TLI);
4824 
4825   /// Given a sign/zero extend instruction \p Ext, return the appropriate
4826   /// action to promote the operand of \p Ext instead of using Ext.
4827   /// \return NULL if no promotable action is possible with the current
4828   /// sign extension.
4829   /// \p InsertedInsts keeps track of all the instructions inserted by the
4830   /// other CodeGenPrepare optimizations. This information is important
4831   /// because we do not want to promote these instructions as CodeGenPrepare
4832   /// will reinsert them later. Thus creating an infinite loop: create/remove.
4833   /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
4834   static Action getAction(Instruction *Ext, const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts,
4835                           const TargetLowering &TLI,
4836                           const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts);
4837 };
4838 
4839 } // end anonymous namespace
4840 
canGetThrough(const Instruction * Inst,Type * ConsideredExtType,const InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,bool IsSExt)4841 bool TypePromotionHelper::canGetThrough(const Instruction *Inst,
4842                                         Type *ConsideredExtType,
4843                                         const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
4844                                         bool IsSExt) {
4845   // The promotion helper does not know how to deal with vector types yet.
4846   // To be able to fix that, we would need to fix the places where we
4847   // statically extend, e.g., constants and such.
4848   if (Inst->getType()->isVectorTy())
4849     return false;
4850 
4851   // We can always get through zext.
4852   if (isa<ZExtInst>(Inst))
4853     return true;
4854 
4855   // sext(sext) is ok too.
4856   if (IsSExt && isa<SExtInst>(Inst))
4857     return true;
4858 
4859   // We can get through binary operator, if it is legal. In other words, the
4860   // binary operator must have a nuw or nsw flag.
4861   if (const auto *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Inst))
4862     if (isa<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(BinOp) &&
4863         ((!IsSExt && BinOp->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) ||
4864          (IsSExt && BinOp->hasNoSignedWrap())))
4865       return true;
4866 
4867   // ext(and(opnd, cst)) --> and(ext(opnd), ext(cst))
4868   if ((Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4869        Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or))
4870     return true;
4871 
4872   // ext(xor(opnd, cst)) --> xor(ext(opnd), ext(cst))
4873   if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor) {
4874     // Make sure it is not a NOT.
4875     if (const auto *Cst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1)))
4876       if (!Cst->getValue().isAllOnes())
4877         return true;
4878   }
4879 
4880   // zext(shrl(opnd, cst)) --> shrl(zext(opnd), zext(cst))
4881   // It may change a poisoned value into a regular value, like
4882   //     zext i32 (shrl i8 %val, 12)  -->  shrl i32 (zext i8 %val), 12
4883   //          poisoned value                    regular value
4884   // It should be OK since undef covers valid value.
4885   if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && !IsSExt)
4886     return true;
4887 
4888   // and(ext(shl(opnd, cst)), cst) --> and(shl(ext(opnd), ext(cst)), cst)
4889   // It may change a poisoned value into a regular value, like
4890   //     zext i32 (shl i8 %val, 12)  -->  shl i32 (zext i8 %val), 12
4891   //          poisoned value                    regular value
4892   // It should be OK since undef covers valid value.
4893   if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl && Inst->hasOneUse()) {
4894     const auto *ExtInst = cast<const Instruction>(*Inst->user_begin());
4895     if (ExtInst->hasOneUse()) {
4896       const auto *AndInst = dyn_cast<const Instruction>(*ExtInst->user_begin());
4897       if (AndInst && AndInst->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
4898         const auto *Cst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AndInst->getOperand(1));
4899         if (Cst &&
4900             Cst->getValue().isIntN(Inst->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth()))
4901           return true;
4902       }
4903     }
4904   }
4905 
4906   // Check if we can do the following simplification.
4907   // ext(trunc(opnd)) --> ext(opnd)
4908   if (!isa<TruncInst>(Inst))
4909     return false;
4910 
4911   Value *OpndVal = Inst->getOperand(0);
4912   // Check if we can use this operand in the extension.
4913   // If the type is larger than the result type of the extension, we cannot.
4914   if (!OpndVal->getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
4915       OpndVal->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth() >
4916           ConsideredExtType->getIntegerBitWidth())
4917     return false;
4918 
4919   // If the operand of the truncate is not an instruction, we will not have
4920   // any information on the dropped bits.
4921   // (Actually we could for constant but it is not worth the extra logic).
4922   Instruction *Opnd = dyn_cast<Instruction>(OpndVal);
4923   if (!Opnd)
4924     return false;
4925 
4926   // Check if the source of the type is narrow enough.
4927   // I.e., check that trunc just drops extended bits of the same kind of
4928   // the extension.
4929   // #1 get the type of the operand and check the kind of the extended bits.
4930   const Type *OpndType = getOrigType(PromotedInsts, Opnd, IsSExt);
4931   if (OpndType)
4932     ;
4933   else if ((IsSExt && isa<SExtInst>(Opnd)) || (!IsSExt && isa<ZExtInst>(Opnd)))
4934     OpndType = Opnd->getOperand(0)->getType();
4935   else
4936     return false;
4937 
4938   // #2 check that the truncate just drops extended bits.
4939   return Inst->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth() >=
4940          OpndType->getIntegerBitWidth();
4941 }
4942 
getAction(Instruction * Ext,const SetOfInstrs & InsertedInsts,const TargetLowering & TLI,const InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts)4943 TypePromotionHelper::Action TypePromotionHelper::getAction(
4944     Instruction *Ext, const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts,
4945     const TargetLowering &TLI, const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts) {
4946   assert((isa<SExtInst>(Ext) || isa<ZExtInst>(Ext)) &&
4947          "Unexpected instruction type");
4948   Instruction *ExtOpnd = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Ext->getOperand(0));
4949   Type *ExtTy = Ext->getType();
4950   bool IsSExt = isa<SExtInst>(Ext);
4951   // If the operand of the extension is not an instruction, we cannot
4952   // get through.
4953   // If it, check we can get through.
4954   if (!ExtOpnd || !canGetThrough(ExtOpnd, ExtTy, PromotedInsts, IsSExt))
4955     return nullptr;
4956 
4957   // Do not promote if the operand has been added by codegenprepare.
4958   // Otherwise, it means we are undoing an optimization that is likely to be
4959   // redone, thus causing potential infinite loop.
4960   if (isa<TruncInst>(ExtOpnd) && InsertedInsts.count(ExtOpnd))
4961     return nullptr;
4962 
4963   // SExt or Trunc instructions.
4964   // Return the related handler.
4965   if (isa<SExtInst>(ExtOpnd) || isa<TruncInst>(ExtOpnd) ||
4966       isa<ZExtInst>(ExtOpnd))
4967     return promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt;
4968 
4969   // Regular instruction.
4970   // Abort early if we will have to insert non-free instructions.
4971   if (!ExtOpnd->hasOneUse() && !TLI.isTruncateFree(ExtTy, ExtOpnd->getType()))
4972     return nullptr;
4973   return IsSExt ? signExtendOperandForOther : zeroExtendOperandForOther;
4974 }
4975 
promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt(Instruction * SExt,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,unsigned & CreatedInstsCost,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Exts,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Truncs,const TargetLowering & TLI)4976 Value *TypePromotionHelper::promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt(
4977     Instruction *SExt, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
4978     InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
4979     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
4980     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
4981   // By construction, the operand of SExt is an instruction. Otherwise we cannot
4982   // get through it and this method should not be called.
4983   Instruction *SExtOpnd = cast<Instruction>(SExt->getOperand(0));
4984   Value *ExtVal = SExt;
4985   bool HasMergedNonFreeExt = false;
4986   if (isa<ZExtInst>(SExtOpnd)) {
4987     // Replace s|zext(zext(opnd))
4988     // => zext(opnd).
4989     HasMergedNonFreeExt = !TLI.isExtFree(SExtOpnd);
4990     Value *ZExt =
4991         TPT.createZExt(SExt, SExtOpnd->getOperand(0), SExt->getType());
4992     TPT.replaceAllUsesWith(SExt, ZExt);
4993     TPT.eraseInstruction(SExt);
4994     ExtVal = ZExt;
4995   } else {
4996     // Replace z|sext(trunc(opnd)) or sext(sext(opnd))
4997     // => z|sext(opnd).
4998     TPT.setOperand(SExt, 0, SExtOpnd->getOperand(0));
4999   }
5000   CreatedInstsCost = 0;
5001 
5002   // Remove dead code.
5003   if (SExtOpnd->use_empty())
5004     TPT.eraseInstruction(SExtOpnd);
5005 
5006   // Check if the extension is still needed.
5007   Instruction *ExtInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(ExtVal);
5008   if (!ExtInst || ExtInst->getType() != ExtInst->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
5009     if (ExtInst) {
5010       if (Exts)
5011         Exts->push_back(ExtInst);
5012       CreatedInstsCost = !TLI.isExtFree(ExtInst) && !HasMergedNonFreeExt;
5013     }
5014     return ExtVal;
5015   }
5016 
5017   // At this point we have: ext ty opnd to ty.
5018   // Reassign the uses of ExtInst to the opnd and remove ExtInst.
5019   Value *NextVal = ExtInst->getOperand(0);
5020   TPT.eraseInstruction(ExtInst, NextVal);
5021   return NextVal;
5022 }
5023 
promoteOperandForOther(Instruction * Ext,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,InstrToOrigTy & PromotedInsts,unsigned & CreatedInstsCost,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Exts,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > * Truncs,const TargetLowering & TLI,bool IsSExt)5024 Value *TypePromotionHelper::promoteOperandForOther(
5025     Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
5026     InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
5027     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
5028     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI,
5029     bool IsSExt) {
5030   // By construction, the operand of Ext is an instruction. Otherwise we cannot
5031   // get through it and this method should not be called.
5032   Instruction *ExtOpnd = cast<Instruction>(Ext->getOperand(0));
5033   CreatedInstsCost = 0;
5034   if (!ExtOpnd->hasOneUse()) {
5035     // ExtOpnd will be promoted.
5036     // All its uses, but Ext, will need to use a truncated value of the
5037     // promoted version.
5038     // Create the truncate now.
5039     Value *Trunc = TPT.createTrunc(Ext, ExtOpnd->getType());
5040     if (Instruction *ITrunc = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Trunc)) {
5041       // Insert it just after the definition.
5042       ITrunc->moveAfter(ExtOpnd);
5043       if (Truncs)
5044         Truncs->push_back(ITrunc);
5045     }
5046 
5047     TPT.replaceAllUsesWith(ExtOpnd, Trunc);
5048     // Restore the operand of Ext (which has been replaced by the previous call
5049     // to replaceAllUsesWith) to avoid creating a cycle trunc <-> sext.
5050     TPT.setOperand(Ext, 0, ExtOpnd);
5051   }
5052 
5053   // Get through the Instruction:
5054   // 1. Update its type.
5055   // 2. Replace the uses of Ext by Inst.
5056   // 3. Extend each operand that needs to be extended.
5057 
5058   // Remember the original type of the instruction before promotion.
5059   // This is useful to know that the high bits are sign extended bits.
5060   addPromotedInst(PromotedInsts, ExtOpnd, IsSExt);
5061   // Step #1.
5062   TPT.mutateType(ExtOpnd, Ext->getType());
5063   // Step #2.
5064   TPT.replaceAllUsesWith(Ext, ExtOpnd);
5065   // Step #3.
5066   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Propagate Ext to operands\n");
5067   for (int OpIdx = 0, EndOpIdx = ExtOpnd->getNumOperands(); OpIdx != EndOpIdx;
5068        ++OpIdx) {
5069     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Operand:\n" << *(ExtOpnd->getOperand(OpIdx)) << '\n');
5070     if (ExtOpnd->getOperand(OpIdx)->getType() == Ext->getType() ||
5071         !shouldExtOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx)) {
5072       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "No need to propagate\n");
5073       continue;
5074     }
5075     // Check if we can statically extend the operand.
5076     Value *Opnd = ExtOpnd->getOperand(OpIdx);
5077     if (const ConstantInt *Cst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Opnd)) {
5078       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Statically extend\n");
5079       unsigned BitWidth = Ext->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth();
5080       APInt CstVal = IsSExt ? Cst->getValue().sext(BitWidth)
5081                             : Cst->getValue().zext(BitWidth);
5082       TPT.setOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx, ConstantInt::get(Ext->getType(), CstVal));
5083       continue;
5084     }
5085     // UndefValue are typed, so we have to statically sign extend them.
5086     if (isa<UndefValue>(Opnd)) {
5087       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Statically extend\n");
5088       TPT.setOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx, UndefValue::get(Ext->getType()));
5089       continue;
5090     }
5091 
5092     // Otherwise we have to explicitly sign extend the operand.
5093     Value *ValForExtOpnd = IsSExt
5094                                ? TPT.createSExt(ExtOpnd, Opnd, Ext->getType())
5095                                : TPT.createZExt(ExtOpnd, Opnd, Ext->getType());
5096     TPT.setOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx, ValForExtOpnd);
5097     Instruction *InstForExtOpnd = dyn_cast<Instruction>(ValForExtOpnd);
5098     if (!InstForExtOpnd)
5099       continue;
5100 
5101     if (Exts)
5102       Exts->push_back(InstForExtOpnd);
5103 
5104     CreatedInstsCost += !TLI.isExtFree(InstForExtOpnd);
5105   }
5106   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Extension is useless now\n");
5107   TPT.eraseInstruction(Ext);
5108   return ExtOpnd;
5109 }
5110 
5111 /// Check whether or not promoting an instruction to a wider type is profitable.
5112 /// \p NewCost gives the cost of extension instructions created by the
5113 /// promotion.
5114 /// \p OldCost gives the cost of extension instructions before the promotion
5115 /// plus the number of instructions that have been
5116 /// matched in the addressing mode the promotion.
5117 /// \p PromotedOperand is the value that has been promoted.
5118 /// \return True if the promotion is profitable, false otherwise.
isPromotionProfitable(unsigned NewCost,unsigned OldCost,Value * PromotedOperand) const5119 bool AddressingModeMatcher::isPromotionProfitable(
5120     unsigned NewCost, unsigned OldCost, Value *PromotedOperand) const {
5121   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "OldCost: " << OldCost << "\tNewCost: " << NewCost
5122                     << '\n');
5123   // The cost of the new extensions is greater than the cost of the
5124   // old extension plus what we folded.
5125   // This is not profitable.
5126   if (NewCost > OldCost)
5127     return false;
5128   if (NewCost < OldCost)
5129     return true;
5130   // The promotion is neutral but it may help folding the sign extension in
5131   // loads for instance.
5132   // Check that we did not create an illegal instruction.
5133   return isPromotedInstructionLegal(TLI, DL, PromotedOperand);
5134 }
5135 
5136 /// Given an instruction or constant expr, see if we can fold the operation
5137 /// into the addressing mode. If so, update the addressing mode and return
5138 /// true, otherwise return false without modifying AddrMode.
5139 /// If \p MovedAway is not NULL, it contains the information of whether or
5140 /// not AddrInst has to be folded into the addressing mode on success.
5141 /// If \p MovedAway == true, \p AddrInst will not be part of the addressing
5142 /// because it has been moved away.
5143 /// Thus AddrInst must not be added in the matched instructions.
5144 /// This state can happen when AddrInst is a sext, since it may be moved away.
5145 /// Therefore, AddrInst may not be valid when MovedAway is true and it must
5146 /// not be referenced anymore.
matchOperationAddr(User * AddrInst,unsigned Opcode,unsigned Depth,bool * MovedAway)5147 bool AddressingModeMatcher::matchOperationAddr(User *AddrInst, unsigned Opcode,
5148                                                unsigned Depth,
5149                                                bool *MovedAway) {
5150   // Avoid exponential behavior on extremely deep expression trees.
5151   if (Depth >= 5)
5152     return false;
5153 
5154   // By default, all matched instructions stay in place.
5155   if (MovedAway)
5156     *MovedAway = false;
5157 
5158   switch (Opcode) {
5159   case Instruction::PtrToInt:
5160     // PtrToInt is always a noop, as we know that the int type is pointer sized.
5161     return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
5162   case Instruction::IntToPtr: {
5163     auto AS = AddrInst->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
5164     auto PtrTy = MVT::getIntegerVT(DL.getPointerSizeInBits(AS));
5165     // This inttoptr is a no-op if the integer type is pointer sized.
5166     if (TLI.getValueType(DL, AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType()) == PtrTy)
5167       return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
5168     return false;
5169   }
5170   case Instruction::BitCast:
5171     // BitCast is always a noop, and we can handle it as long as it is
5172     // int->int or pointer->pointer (we don't want int<->fp or something).
5173     if (AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
5174         // Don't touch identity bitcasts.  These were probably put here by LSR,
5175         // and we don't want to mess around with them.  Assume it knows what it
5176         // is doing.
5177         AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType() != AddrInst->getType())
5178       return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
5179     return false;
5180   case Instruction::AddrSpaceCast: {
5181     unsigned SrcAS =
5182         AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
5183     unsigned DestAS = AddrInst->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
5184     if (TLI.getTargetMachine().isNoopAddrSpaceCast(SrcAS, DestAS))
5185       return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
5186     return false;
5187   }
5188   case Instruction::Add: {
5189     // Check to see if we can merge in one operand, then the other.  If so, we
5190     // win.
5191     ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
5192     unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
5193     // Start a transaction at this point.
5194     // The LHS may match but not the RHS.
5195     // Therefore, we need a higher level restoration point to undo partially
5196     // matched operation.
5197     TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
5198         TPT.getRestorationPoint();
5199 
5200     // Try to match an integer constant second to increase its chance of ending
5201     // up in `BaseOffs`, resp. decrease its chance of ending up in `BaseReg`.
5202     int First = 0, Second = 1;
5203     if (isa<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(First))
5204       && !isa<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(Second)))
5205         std::swap(First, Second);
5206     AddrMode.InBounds = false;
5207     if (matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(First), Depth + 1) &&
5208         matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(Second), Depth + 1))
5209       return true;
5210 
5211     // Restore the old addr mode info.
5212     AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5213     AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5214     TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5215 
5216     // Otherwise this was over-aggressive.  Try merging operands in the opposite
5217     // order.
5218     if (matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(Second), Depth + 1) &&
5219         matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(First), Depth + 1))
5220       return true;
5221 
5222     // Otherwise we definitely can't merge the ADD in.
5223     AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5224     AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5225     TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5226     break;
5227   }
5228   // case Instruction::Or:
5229   //  TODO: We can handle "Or Val, Imm" iff this OR is equivalent to an ADD.
5230   // break;
5231   case Instruction::Mul:
5232   case Instruction::Shl: {
5233     // Can only handle X*C and X << C.
5234     AddrMode.InBounds = false;
5235     ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(1));
5236     if (!RHS || RHS->getBitWidth() > 64)
5237       return false;
5238     int64_t Scale = Opcode == Instruction::Shl
5239                         ? 1LL << RHS->getLimitedValue(RHS->getBitWidth() - 1)
5240                         : RHS->getSExtValue();
5241 
5242     return matchScaledValue(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Scale, Depth);
5243   }
5244   case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
5245     // Scan the GEP.  We check it if it contains constant offsets and at most
5246     // one variable offset.
5247     int VariableOperand = -1;
5248     unsigned VariableScale = 0;
5249 
5250     int64_t ConstantOffset = 0;
5251     gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(AddrInst);
5252     for (unsigned i = 1, e = AddrInst->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5253       if (StructType *STy = GTI.getStructTypeOrNull()) {
5254         const StructLayout *SL = DL.getStructLayout(STy);
5255         unsigned Idx =
5256             cast<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
5257         ConstantOffset += SL->getElementOffset(Idx);
5258       } else {
5259         TypeSize TS = GTI.getSequentialElementStride(DL);
5260         if (TS.isNonZero()) {
5261           // The optimisations below currently only work for fixed offsets.
5262           if (TS.isScalable())
5263             return false;
5264           int64_t TypeSize = TS.getFixedValue();
5265           if (ConstantInt *CI =
5266                   dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(i))) {
5267             const APInt &CVal = CI->getValue();
5268             if (CVal.getSignificantBits() <= 64) {
5269               ConstantOffset += CVal.getSExtValue() * TypeSize;
5270               continue;
5271             }
5272           }
5273           // We only allow one variable index at the moment.
5274           if (VariableOperand != -1)
5275             return false;
5276 
5277           // Remember the variable index.
5278           VariableOperand = i;
5279           VariableScale = TypeSize;
5280         }
5281       }
5282     }
5283 
5284     // A common case is for the GEP to only do a constant offset.  In this case,
5285     // just add it to the disp field and check validity.
5286     if (VariableOperand == -1) {
5287       AddrMode.BaseOffs += ConstantOffset;
5288       if (matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth + 1)) {
5289           if (!cast<GEPOperator>(AddrInst)->isInBounds())
5290             AddrMode.InBounds = false;
5291           return true;
5292       }
5293       AddrMode.BaseOffs -= ConstantOffset;
5294 
5295       if (EnableGEPOffsetSplit && isa<GetElementPtrInst>(AddrInst) &&
5296           TLI.shouldConsiderGEPOffsetSplit() && Depth == 0 &&
5297           ConstantOffset > 0) {
5298           // Record GEPs with non-zero offsets as candidates for splitting in
5299           // the event that the offset cannot fit into the r+i addressing mode.
5300           // Simple and common case that only one GEP is used in calculating the
5301           // address for the memory access.
5302           Value *Base = AddrInst->getOperand(0);
5303           auto *BaseI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Base);
5304           auto *GEP = cast<GetElementPtrInst>(AddrInst);
5305           if (isa<Argument>(Base) || isa<GlobalValue>(Base) ||
5306               (BaseI && !isa<CastInst>(BaseI) &&
5307                !isa<GetElementPtrInst>(BaseI))) {
5308             // Make sure the parent block allows inserting non-PHI instructions
5309             // before the terminator.
5310             BasicBlock *Parent = BaseI ? BaseI->getParent()
5311                                        : &GEP->getFunction()->getEntryBlock();
5312             if (!Parent->getTerminator()->isEHPad())
5313             LargeOffsetGEP = std::make_pair(GEP, ConstantOffset);
5314           }
5315       }
5316 
5317       return false;
5318     }
5319 
5320     // Save the valid addressing mode in case we can't match.
5321     ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
5322     unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
5323 
5324     // See if the scale and offset amount is valid for this target.
5325     AddrMode.BaseOffs += ConstantOffset;
5326     if (!cast<GEPOperator>(AddrInst)->isInBounds())
5327       AddrMode.InBounds = false;
5328 
5329     // Match the base operand of the GEP.
5330     if (!matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth + 1)) {
5331       // If it couldn't be matched, just stuff the value in a register.
5332       if (AddrMode.HasBaseReg) {
5333         AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5334         AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5335         return false;
5336       }
5337       AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
5338       AddrMode.BaseReg = AddrInst->getOperand(0);
5339     }
5340 
5341     // Match the remaining variable portion of the GEP.
5342     if (!matchScaledValue(AddrInst->getOperand(VariableOperand), VariableScale,
5343                           Depth)) {
5344       // If it couldn't be matched, try stuffing the base into a register
5345       // instead of matching it, and retrying the match of the scale.
5346       AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5347       AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5348       if (AddrMode.HasBaseReg)
5349         return false;
5350       AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
5351       AddrMode.BaseReg = AddrInst->getOperand(0);
5352       AddrMode.BaseOffs += ConstantOffset;
5353       if (!matchScaledValue(AddrInst->getOperand(VariableOperand),
5354                             VariableScale, Depth)) {
5355         // If even that didn't work, bail.
5356         AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5357         AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5358         return false;
5359       }
5360     }
5361 
5362     return true;
5363   }
5364   case Instruction::SExt:
5365   case Instruction::ZExt: {
5366     Instruction *Ext = dyn_cast<Instruction>(AddrInst);
5367     if (!Ext)
5368       return false;
5369 
5370     // Try to move this ext out of the way of the addressing mode.
5371     // Ask for a method for doing so.
5372     TypePromotionHelper::Action TPH =
5373         TypePromotionHelper::getAction(Ext, InsertedInsts, TLI, PromotedInsts);
5374     if (!TPH)
5375       return false;
5376 
5377     TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
5378         TPT.getRestorationPoint();
5379     unsigned CreatedInstsCost = 0;
5380     unsigned ExtCost = !TLI.isExtFree(Ext);
5381     Value *PromotedOperand =
5382         TPH(Ext, TPT, PromotedInsts, CreatedInstsCost, nullptr, nullptr, TLI);
5383     // SExt has been moved away.
5384     // Thus either it will be rematched later in the recursive calls or it is
5385     // gone. Anyway, we must not fold it into the addressing mode at this point.
5386     // E.g.,
5387     // op = add opnd, 1
5388     // idx = ext op
5389     // addr = gep base, idx
5390     // is now:
5391     // promotedOpnd = ext opnd            <- no match here
5392     // op = promoted_add promotedOpnd, 1  <- match (later in recursive calls)
5393     // addr = gep base, op                <- match
5394     if (MovedAway)
5395       *MovedAway = true;
5396 
5397     assert(PromotedOperand &&
5398            "TypePromotionHelper should have filtered out those cases");
5399 
5400     ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
5401     unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
5402 
5403     if (!matchAddr(PromotedOperand, Depth) ||
5404         // The total of the new cost is equal to the cost of the created
5405         // instructions.
5406         // The total of the old cost is equal to the cost of the extension plus
5407         // what we have saved in the addressing mode.
5408         !isPromotionProfitable(CreatedInstsCost,
5409                                ExtCost + (AddrModeInsts.size() - OldSize),
5410                                PromotedOperand)) {
5411       AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5412       AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5413       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Sign extension does not pay off: rollback\n");
5414       TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5415       return false;
5416     }
5417 
5418     // SExt has been deleted. Make sure it is not referenced by the AddrMode.
5419     AddrMode.replaceWith(Ext, PromotedOperand);
5420     return true;
5421   }
5422   case Instruction::Call:
5423     if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(AddrInst)) {
5424       if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::threadlocal_address) {
5425         GlobalValue &GV = cast<GlobalValue>(*II->getArgOperand(0));
5426         if (TLI.addressingModeSupportsTLS(GV))
5427           return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
5428       }
5429     }
5430     break;
5431   }
5432   return false;
5433 }
5434 
5435 /// If we can, try to add the value of 'Addr' into the current addressing mode.
5436 /// If Addr can't be added to AddrMode this returns false and leaves AddrMode
5437 /// unmodified. This assumes that Addr is either a pointer type or intptr_t
5438 /// for the target.
5439 ///
matchAddr(Value * Addr,unsigned Depth)5440 bool AddressingModeMatcher::matchAddr(Value *Addr, unsigned Depth) {
5441   // Start a transaction at this point that we will rollback if the matching
5442   // fails.
5443   TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
5444       TPT.getRestorationPoint();
5445   if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Addr)) {
5446     if (CI->getValue().isSignedIntN(64)) {
5447       // Check if the addition would result in a signed overflow.
5448       int64_t Result;
5449       bool Overflow =
5450           AddOverflow(AddrMode.BaseOffs, CI->getSExtValue(), Result);
5451       if (!Overflow) {
5452         // Fold in immediates if legal for the target.
5453         AddrMode.BaseOffs = Result;
5454         if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
5455           return true;
5456         AddrMode.BaseOffs -= CI->getSExtValue();
5457       }
5458     }
5459   } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Addr)) {
5460     // If this is a global variable, try to fold it into the addressing mode.
5461     if (!AddrMode.BaseGV) {
5462       AddrMode.BaseGV = GV;
5463       if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
5464         return true;
5465       AddrMode.BaseGV = nullptr;
5466     }
5467   } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Addr)) {
5468     ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
5469     unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
5470 
5471     // Check to see if it is possible to fold this operation.
5472     bool MovedAway = false;
5473     if (matchOperationAddr(I, I->getOpcode(), Depth, &MovedAway)) {
5474       // This instruction may have been moved away. If so, there is nothing
5475       // to check here.
5476       if (MovedAway)
5477         return true;
5478       // Okay, it's possible to fold this.  Check to see if it is actually
5479       // *profitable* to do so.  We use a simple cost model to avoid increasing
5480       // register pressure too much.
5481       if (I->hasOneUse() ||
5482           isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(I, BackupAddrMode, AddrMode)) {
5483         AddrModeInsts.push_back(I);
5484         return true;
5485       }
5486 
5487       // It isn't profitable to do this, roll back.
5488       AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
5489       AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
5490       TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5491     }
5492   } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Addr)) {
5493     if (matchOperationAddr(CE, CE->getOpcode(), Depth))
5494       return true;
5495     TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5496   } else if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Addr)) {
5497     // Null pointer gets folded without affecting the addressing mode.
5498     return true;
5499   }
5500 
5501   // Worse case, the target should support [reg] addressing modes. :)
5502   if (!AddrMode.HasBaseReg) {
5503     AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
5504     AddrMode.BaseReg = Addr;
5505     // Still check for legality in case the target supports [imm] but not [i+r].
5506     if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
5507       return true;
5508     AddrMode.HasBaseReg = false;
5509     AddrMode.BaseReg = nullptr;
5510   }
5511 
5512   // If the base register is already taken, see if we can do [r+r].
5513   if (AddrMode.Scale == 0) {
5514     AddrMode.Scale = 1;
5515     AddrMode.ScaledReg = Addr;
5516     if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
5517       return true;
5518     AddrMode.Scale = 0;
5519     AddrMode.ScaledReg = nullptr;
5520   }
5521   // Couldn't match.
5522   TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5523   return false;
5524 }
5525 
5526 /// Check to see if all uses of OpVal by the specified inline asm call are due
5527 /// to memory operands. If so, return true, otherwise return false.
IsOperandAMemoryOperand(CallInst * CI,InlineAsm * IA,Value * OpVal,const TargetLowering & TLI,const TargetRegisterInfo & TRI)5528 static bool IsOperandAMemoryOperand(CallInst *CI, InlineAsm *IA, Value *OpVal,
5529                                     const TargetLowering &TLI,
5530                                     const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI) {
5531   const Function *F = CI->getFunction();
5532   TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfoVector TargetConstraints =
5533       TLI.ParseConstraints(F->getDataLayout(), &TRI, *CI);
5534 
5535   for (TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfo &OpInfo : TargetConstraints) {
5536     // Compute the constraint code and ConstraintType to use.
5537     TLI.ComputeConstraintToUse(OpInfo, SDValue());
5538 
5539     // If this asm operand is our Value*, and if it isn't an indirect memory
5540     // operand, we can't fold it!  TODO: Also handle C_Address?
5541     if (OpInfo.CallOperandVal == OpVal &&
5542         (OpInfo.ConstraintType != TargetLowering::C_Memory ||
5543          !OpInfo.isIndirect))
5544       return false;
5545   }
5546 
5547   return true;
5548 }
5549 
5550 /// Recursively walk all the uses of I until we find a memory use.
5551 /// If we find an obviously non-foldable instruction, return true.
5552 /// Add accessed addresses and types to MemoryUses.
FindAllMemoryUses(Instruction * I,SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<Use *,Type * >> & MemoryUses,SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction * > & ConsideredInsts,const TargetLowering & TLI,const TargetRegisterInfo & TRI,bool OptSize,ProfileSummaryInfo * PSI,BlockFrequencyInfo * BFI,unsigned & SeenInsts)5553 static bool FindAllMemoryUses(
5554     Instruction *I, SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<Use *, Type *>> &MemoryUses,
5555     SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &ConsideredInsts, const TargetLowering &TLI,
5556     const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, bool OptSize, ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI,
5557     BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI, unsigned &SeenInsts) {
5558   // If we already considered this instruction, we're done.
5559   if (!ConsideredInsts.insert(I).second)
5560     return false;
5561 
5562   // If this is an obviously unfoldable instruction, bail out.
5563   if (!MightBeFoldableInst(I))
5564     return true;
5565 
5566   // Loop over all the uses, recursively processing them.
5567   for (Use &U : I->uses()) {
5568     // Conservatively return true if we're seeing a large number or a deep chain
5569     // of users. This avoids excessive compilation times in pathological cases.
5570     if (SeenInsts++ >= MaxAddressUsersToScan)
5571       return true;
5572 
5573     Instruction *UserI = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
5574     if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(UserI)) {
5575       MemoryUses.push_back({&U, LI->getType()});
5576       continue;
5577     }
5578 
5579     if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(UserI)) {
5580       if (U.getOperandNo() != StoreInst::getPointerOperandIndex())
5581         return true; // Storing addr, not into addr.
5582       MemoryUses.push_back({&U, SI->getValueOperand()->getType()});
5583       continue;
5584     }
5585 
5586     if (AtomicRMWInst *RMW = dyn_cast<AtomicRMWInst>(UserI)) {
5587       if (U.getOperandNo() != AtomicRMWInst::getPointerOperandIndex())
5588         return true; // Storing addr, not into addr.
5589       MemoryUses.push_back({&U, RMW->getValOperand()->getType()});
5590       continue;
5591     }
5592 
5593     if (AtomicCmpXchgInst *CmpX = dyn_cast<AtomicCmpXchgInst>(UserI)) {
5594       if (U.getOperandNo() != AtomicCmpXchgInst::getPointerOperandIndex())
5595         return true; // Storing addr, not into addr.
5596       MemoryUses.push_back({&U, CmpX->getCompareOperand()->getType()});
5597       continue;
5598     }
5599 
5600     if (CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(UserI)) {
5601       if (CI->hasFnAttr(Attribute::Cold)) {
5602         // If this is a cold call, we can sink the addressing calculation into
5603         // the cold path.  See optimizeCallInst
5604         if (!llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(CI->getParent(), PSI, BFI))
5605           continue;
5606       }
5607 
5608       InlineAsm *IA = dyn_cast<InlineAsm>(CI->getCalledOperand());
5609       if (!IA)
5610         return true;
5611 
5612       // If this is a memory operand, we're cool, otherwise bail out.
5613       if (!IsOperandAMemoryOperand(CI, IA, I, TLI, TRI))
5614         return true;
5615       continue;
5616     }
5617 
5618     if (FindAllMemoryUses(UserI, MemoryUses, ConsideredInsts, TLI, TRI, OptSize,
5619                           PSI, BFI, SeenInsts))
5620       return true;
5621   }
5622 
5623   return false;
5624 }
5625 
FindAllMemoryUses(Instruction * I,SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<Use *,Type * >> & MemoryUses,const TargetLowering & TLI,const TargetRegisterInfo & TRI,bool OptSize,ProfileSummaryInfo * PSI,BlockFrequencyInfo * BFI)5626 static bool FindAllMemoryUses(
5627     Instruction *I, SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<Use *, Type *>> &MemoryUses,
5628     const TargetLowering &TLI, const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, bool OptSize,
5629     ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI, BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI) {
5630   unsigned SeenInsts = 0;
5631   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 16> ConsideredInsts;
5632   return FindAllMemoryUses(I, MemoryUses, ConsideredInsts, TLI, TRI, OptSize,
5633                            PSI, BFI, SeenInsts);
5634 }
5635 
5636 
5637 /// Return true if Val is already known to be live at the use site that we're
5638 /// folding it into. If so, there is no cost to include it in the addressing
5639 /// mode. KnownLive1 and KnownLive2 are two values that we know are live at the
5640 /// instruction already.
valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(Value * Val,Value * KnownLive1,Value * KnownLive2)5641 bool AddressingModeMatcher::valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(Value *Val,
5642                                                    Value *KnownLive1,
5643                                                    Value *KnownLive2) {
5644   // If Val is either of the known-live values, we know it is live!
5645   if (Val == nullptr || Val == KnownLive1 || Val == KnownLive2)
5646     return true;
5647 
5648   // All values other than instructions and arguments (e.g. constants) are live.
5649   if (!isa<Instruction>(Val) && !isa<Argument>(Val))
5650     return true;
5651 
5652   // If Val is a constant sized alloca in the entry block, it is live, this is
5653   // true because it is just a reference to the stack/frame pointer, which is
5654   // live for the whole function.
5655   if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(Val))
5656     if (AI->isStaticAlloca())
5657       return true;
5658 
5659   // Check to see if this value is already used in the memory instruction's
5660   // block.  If so, it's already live into the block at the very least, so we
5661   // can reasonably fold it.
5662   return Val->isUsedInBasicBlock(MemoryInst->getParent());
5663 }
5664 
5665 /// It is possible for the addressing mode of the machine to fold the specified
5666 /// instruction into a load or store that ultimately uses it.
5667 /// However, the specified instruction has multiple uses.
5668 /// Given this, it may actually increase register pressure to fold it
5669 /// into the load. For example, consider this code:
5670 ///
5671 ///     X = ...
5672 ///     Y = X+1
5673 ///     use(Y)   -> nonload/store
5674 ///     Z = Y+1
5675 ///     load Z
5676 ///
5677 /// In this case, Y has multiple uses, and can be folded into the load of Z
5678 /// (yielding load [X+2]).  However, doing this will cause both "X" and "X+1" to
5679 /// be live at the use(Y) line.  If we don't fold Y into load Z, we use one
5680 /// fewer register.  Since Y can't be folded into "use(Y)" we don't increase the
5681 /// number of computations either.
5682 ///
5683 /// Note that this (like most of CodeGenPrepare) is just a rough heuristic.  If
5684 /// X was live across 'load Z' for other reasons, we actually *would* want to
5685 /// fold the addressing mode in the Z case.  This would make Y die earlier.
isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(Instruction * I,ExtAddrMode & AMBefore,ExtAddrMode & AMAfter)5686 bool AddressingModeMatcher::isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(
5687     Instruction *I, ExtAddrMode &AMBefore, ExtAddrMode &AMAfter) {
5688   if (IgnoreProfitability)
5689     return true;
5690 
5691   // AMBefore is the addressing mode before this instruction was folded into it,
5692   // and AMAfter is the addressing mode after the instruction was folded.  Get
5693   // the set of registers referenced by AMAfter and subtract out those
5694   // referenced by AMBefore: this is the set of values which folding in this
5695   // address extends the lifetime of.
5696   //
5697   // Note that there are only two potential values being referenced here,
5698   // BaseReg and ScaleReg (global addresses are always available, as are any
5699   // folded immediates).
5700   Value *BaseReg = AMAfter.BaseReg, *ScaledReg = AMAfter.ScaledReg;
5701 
5702   // If the BaseReg or ScaledReg was referenced by the previous addrmode, their
5703   // lifetime wasn't extended by adding this instruction.
5704   if (valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(BaseReg, AMBefore.BaseReg, AMBefore.ScaledReg))
5705     BaseReg = nullptr;
5706   if (valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(ScaledReg, AMBefore.BaseReg, AMBefore.ScaledReg))
5707     ScaledReg = nullptr;
5708 
5709   // If folding this instruction (and it's subexprs) didn't extend any live
5710   // ranges, we're ok with it.
5711   if (!BaseReg && !ScaledReg)
5712     return true;
5713 
5714   // If all uses of this instruction can have the address mode sunk into them,
5715   // we can remove the addressing mode and effectively trade one live register
5716   // for another (at worst.)  In this context, folding an addressing mode into
5717   // the use is just a particularly nice way of sinking it.
5718   SmallVector<std::pair<Use *, Type *>, 16> MemoryUses;
5719   if (FindAllMemoryUses(I, MemoryUses, TLI, TRI, OptSize, PSI, BFI))
5720     return false; // Has a non-memory, non-foldable use!
5721 
5722   // Now that we know that all uses of this instruction are part of a chain of
5723   // computation involving only operations that could theoretically be folded
5724   // into a memory use, loop over each of these memory operation uses and see
5725   // if they could  *actually* fold the instruction.  The assumption is that
5726   // addressing modes are cheap and that duplicating the computation involved
5727   // many times is worthwhile, even on a fastpath. For sinking candidates
5728   // (i.e. cold call sites), this serves as a way to prevent excessive code
5729   // growth since most architectures have some reasonable small and fast way to
5730   // compute an effective address.  (i.e LEA on x86)
5731   SmallVector<Instruction *, 32> MatchedAddrModeInsts;
5732   for (const std::pair<Use *, Type *> &Pair : MemoryUses) {
5733     Value *Address = Pair.first->get();
5734     Instruction *UserI = cast<Instruction>(Pair.first->getUser());
5735     Type *AddressAccessTy = Pair.second;
5736     unsigned AS = Address->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
5737 
5738     // Do a match against the root of this address, ignoring profitability. This
5739     // will tell us if the addressing mode for the memory operation will
5740     // *actually* cover the shared instruction.
5741     ExtAddrMode Result;
5742     std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> LargeOffsetGEP(nullptr,
5743                                                                       0);
5744     TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
5745         TPT.getRestorationPoint();
5746     AddressingModeMatcher Matcher(MatchedAddrModeInsts, TLI, TRI, LI, getDTFn,
5747                                   AddressAccessTy, AS, UserI, Result,
5748                                   InsertedInsts, PromotedInsts, TPT,
5749                                   LargeOffsetGEP, OptSize, PSI, BFI);
5750     Matcher.IgnoreProfitability = true;
5751     bool Success = Matcher.matchAddr(Address, 0);
5752     (void)Success;
5753     assert(Success && "Couldn't select *anything*?");
5754 
5755     // The match was to check the profitability, the changes made are not
5756     // part of the original matcher. Therefore, they should be dropped
5757     // otherwise the original matcher will not present the right state.
5758     TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5759 
5760     // If the match didn't cover I, then it won't be shared by it.
5761     if (!is_contained(MatchedAddrModeInsts, I))
5762       return false;
5763 
5764     MatchedAddrModeInsts.clear();
5765   }
5766 
5767   return true;
5768 }
5769 
5770 /// Return true if the specified values are defined in a
5771 /// different basic block than BB.
IsNonLocalValue(Value * V,BasicBlock * BB)5772 static bool IsNonLocalValue(Value *V, BasicBlock *BB) {
5773   if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
5774     return I->getParent() != BB;
5775   return false;
5776 }
5777 
5778 // Find an insert position of Addr for MemoryInst. We can't guarantee MemoryInst
5779 // is the first instruction that will use Addr. So we need to find the first
5780 // user of Addr in current BB.
findInsertPos(Value * Addr,Instruction * MemoryInst,Value * SunkAddr)5781 static BasicBlock::iterator findInsertPos(Value *Addr, Instruction *MemoryInst,
5782                                           Value *SunkAddr) {
5783   if (Addr->hasOneUse())
5784     return MemoryInst->getIterator();
5785 
5786   // We already have a SunkAddr in current BB, but we may need to insert cast
5787   // instruction after it.
5788   if (SunkAddr) {
5789     if (Instruction *AddrInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SunkAddr))
5790       return std::next(AddrInst->getIterator());
5791   }
5792 
5793   // Find the first user of Addr in current BB.
5794   Instruction *Earliest = MemoryInst;
5795   for (User *U : Addr->users()) {
5796     Instruction *UserInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U);
5797     if (UserInst && UserInst->getParent() == MemoryInst->getParent()) {
5798       if (isa<PHINode>(UserInst) || UserInst->isDebugOrPseudoInst())
5799         continue;
5800       if (UserInst->comesBefore(Earliest))
5801         Earliest = UserInst;
5802     }
5803   }
5804   return Earliest->getIterator();
5805 }
5806 
5807 /// Sink addressing mode computation immediate before MemoryInst if doing so
5808 /// can be done without increasing register pressure.  The need for the
5809 /// register pressure constraint means this can end up being an all or nothing
5810 /// decision for all uses of the same addressing computation.
5811 ///
5812 /// Load and Store Instructions often have addressing modes that can do
5813 /// significant amounts of computation. As such, instruction selection will try
5814 /// to get the load or store to do as much computation as possible for the
5815 /// program. The problem is that isel can only see within a single block. As
5816 /// such, we sink as much legal addressing mode work into the block as possible.
5817 ///
5818 /// This method is used to optimize both load/store and inline asms with memory
5819 /// operands.  It's also used to sink addressing computations feeding into cold
5820 /// call sites into their (cold) basic block.
5821 ///
5822 /// The motivation for handling sinking into cold blocks is that doing so can
5823 /// both enable other address mode sinking (by satisfying the register pressure
5824 /// constraint above), and reduce register pressure globally (by removing the
5825 /// addressing mode computation from the fast path entirely.).
optimizeMemoryInst(Instruction * MemoryInst,Value * Addr,Type * AccessTy,unsigned AddrSpace)5826 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeMemoryInst(Instruction *MemoryInst, Value *Addr,
5827                                         Type *AccessTy, unsigned AddrSpace) {
5828   Value *Repl = Addr;
5829 
5830   // Try to collapse single-value PHI nodes.  This is necessary to undo
5831   // unprofitable PRE transformations.
5832   SmallVector<Value *, 8> worklist;
5833   SmallPtrSet<Value *, 16> Visited;
5834   worklist.push_back(Addr);
5835 
5836   // Use a worklist to iteratively look through PHI and select nodes, and
5837   // ensure that the addressing mode obtained from the non-PHI/select roots of
5838   // the graph are compatible.
5839   bool PhiOrSelectSeen = false;
5840   SmallVector<Instruction *, 16> AddrModeInsts;
5841   const SimplifyQuery SQ(*DL, TLInfo);
5842   AddressingModeCombiner AddrModes(SQ, Addr);
5843   TypePromotionTransaction TPT(RemovedInsts);
5844   TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
5845       TPT.getRestorationPoint();
5846   while (!worklist.empty()) {
5847     Value *V = worklist.pop_back_val();
5848 
5849     // We allow traversing cyclic Phi nodes.
5850     // In case of success after this loop we ensure that traversing through
5851     // Phi nodes ends up with all cases to compute address of the form
5852     //    BaseGV + Base + Scale * Index + Offset
5853     // where Scale and Offset are constans and BaseGV, Base and Index
5854     // are exactly the same Values in all cases.
5855     // It means that BaseGV, Scale and Offset dominate our memory instruction
5856     // and have the same value as they had in address computation represented
5857     // as Phi. So we can safely sink address computation to memory instruction.
5858     if (!Visited.insert(V).second)
5859       continue;
5860 
5861     // For a PHI node, push all of its incoming values.
5862     if (PHINode *P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
5863       append_range(worklist, P->incoming_values());
5864       PhiOrSelectSeen = true;
5865       continue;
5866     }
5867     // Similar for select.
5868     if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
5869       worklist.push_back(SI->getFalseValue());
5870       worklist.push_back(SI->getTrueValue());
5871       PhiOrSelectSeen = true;
5872       continue;
5873     }
5874 
5875     // For non-PHIs, determine the addressing mode being computed.  Note that
5876     // the result may differ depending on what other uses our candidate
5877     // addressing instructions might have.
5878     AddrModeInsts.clear();
5879     std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> LargeOffsetGEP(nullptr,
5880                                                                       0);
5881     // Defer the query (and possible computation of) the dom tree to point of
5882     // actual use.  It's expected that most address matches don't actually need
5883     // the domtree.
5884     auto getDTFn = [MemoryInst, this]() -> const DominatorTree & {
5885       Function *F = MemoryInst->getParent()->getParent();
5886       return this->getDT(*F);
5887     };
5888     ExtAddrMode NewAddrMode = AddressingModeMatcher::Match(
5889         V, AccessTy, AddrSpace, MemoryInst, AddrModeInsts, *TLI, *LI, getDTFn,
5890         *TRI, InsertedInsts, PromotedInsts, TPT, LargeOffsetGEP, OptSize, PSI,
5891         BFI.get());
5892 
5893     GetElementPtrInst *GEP = LargeOffsetGEP.first;
5894     if (GEP && !NewGEPBases.count(GEP)) {
5895       // If splitting the underlying data structure can reduce the offset of a
5896       // GEP, collect the GEP.  Skip the GEPs that are the new bases of
5897       // previously split data structures.
5898       LargeOffsetGEPMap[GEP->getPointerOperand()].push_back(LargeOffsetGEP);
5899       LargeOffsetGEPID.insert(std::make_pair(GEP, LargeOffsetGEPID.size()));
5900     }
5901 
5902     NewAddrMode.OriginalValue = V;
5903     if (!AddrModes.addNewAddrMode(NewAddrMode))
5904       break;
5905   }
5906 
5907   // Try to combine the AddrModes we've collected. If we couldn't collect any,
5908   // or we have multiple but either couldn't combine them or combining them
5909   // wouldn't do anything useful, bail out now.
5910   if (!AddrModes.combineAddrModes()) {
5911     TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
5912     return false;
5913   }
5914   bool Modified = TPT.commit();
5915 
5916   // Get the combined AddrMode (or the only AddrMode, if we only had one).
5917   ExtAddrMode AddrMode = AddrModes.getAddrMode();
5918 
5919   // If all the instructions matched are already in this BB, don't do anything.
5920   // If we saw a Phi node then it is not local definitely, and if we saw a
5921   // select then we want to push the address calculation past it even if it's
5922   // already in this BB.
5923   if (!PhiOrSelectSeen && none_of(AddrModeInsts, [&](Value *V) {
5924         return IsNonLocalValue(V, MemoryInst->getParent());
5925       })) {
5926     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: Found      local addrmode: " << AddrMode
5927                       << "\n");
5928     return Modified;
5929   }
5930 
5931   // Now that we determined the addressing expression we want to use and know
5932   // that we have to sink it into this block.  Check to see if we have already
5933   // done this for some other load/store instr in this block.  If so, reuse
5934   // the computation.  Before attempting reuse, check if the address is valid
5935   // as it may have been erased.
5936 
5937   WeakTrackingVH SunkAddrVH = SunkAddrs[Addr];
5938 
5939   Value *SunkAddr = SunkAddrVH.pointsToAliveValue() ? SunkAddrVH : nullptr;
5940   Type *IntPtrTy = DL->getIntPtrType(Addr->getType());
5941 
5942   // The current BB may be optimized multiple times, we can't guarantee the
5943   // reuse of Addr happens later, call findInsertPos to find an appropriate
5944   // insert position.
5945   auto InsertPos = findInsertPos(Addr, MemoryInst, SunkAddr);
5946 
5947   // TODO: Adjust insert point considering (Base|Scaled)Reg if possible.
5948   if (!SunkAddr) {
5949     auto &DT = getDT(*MemoryInst->getFunction());
5950     if ((AddrMode.BaseReg && !DT.dominates(AddrMode.BaseReg, &*InsertPos)) ||
5951         (AddrMode.ScaledReg && !DT.dominates(AddrMode.ScaledReg, &*InsertPos)))
5952       return Modified;
5953   }
5954 
5955   IRBuilder<> Builder(MemoryInst->getParent(), InsertPos);
5956 
5957   if (SunkAddr) {
5958     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: Reusing nonlocal addrmode: " << AddrMode
5959                       << " for " << *MemoryInst << "\n");
5960     if (SunkAddr->getType() != Addr->getType()) {
5961       if (SunkAddr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace() !=
5962               Addr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace() &&
5963           !DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(Addr->getType())) {
5964         // There are two reasons the address spaces might not match: a no-op
5965         // addrspacecast, or a ptrtoint/inttoptr pair. Either way, we emit a
5966         // ptrtoint/inttoptr pair to ensure we match the original semantics.
5967         // TODO: allow bitcast between different address space pointers with the
5968         // same size.
5969         SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(SunkAddr, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
5970         SunkAddr =
5971             Builder.CreateIntToPtr(SunkAddr, Addr->getType(), "sunkaddr");
5972       } else
5973         SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(SunkAddr, Addr->getType());
5974     }
5975   } else if (AddrSinkUsingGEPs || (!AddrSinkUsingGEPs.getNumOccurrences() &&
5976                                    SubtargetInfo->addrSinkUsingGEPs())) {
5977     // By default, we use the GEP-based method when AA is used later. This
5978     // prevents new inttoptr/ptrtoint pairs from degrading AA capabilities.
5979     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: SINKING nonlocal addrmode: " << AddrMode
5980                       << " for " << *MemoryInst << "\n");
5981     Value *ResultPtr = nullptr, *ResultIndex = nullptr;
5982 
5983     // First, find the pointer.
5984     if (AddrMode.BaseReg && AddrMode.BaseReg->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
5985       ResultPtr = AddrMode.BaseReg;
5986       AddrMode.BaseReg = nullptr;
5987     }
5988 
5989     if (AddrMode.Scale && AddrMode.ScaledReg->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
5990       // We can't add more than one pointer together, nor can we scale a
5991       // pointer (both of which seem meaningless).
5992       if (ResultPtr || AddrMode.Scale != 1)
5993         return Modified;
5994 
5995       ResultPtr = AddrMode.ScaledReg;
5996       AddrMode.Scale = 0;
5997     }
5998 
5999     // It is only safe to sign extend the BaseReg if we know that the math
6000     // required to create it did not overflow before we extend it. Since
6001     // the original IR value was tossed in favor of a constant back when
6002     // the AddrMode was created we need to bail out gracefully if widths
6003     // do not match instead of extending it.
6004     //
6005     // (See below for code to add the scale.)
6006     if (AddrMode.Scale) {
6007       Type *ScaledRegTy = AddrMode.ScaledReg->getType();
6008       if (cast<IntegerType>(IntPtrTy)->getBitWidth() >
6009           cast<IntegerType>(ScaledRegTy)->getBitWidth())
6010         return Modified;
6011     }
6012 
6013     GlobalValue *BaseGV = AddrMode.BaseGV;
6014     if (BaseGV != nullptr) {
6015       if (ResultPtr)
6016         return Modified;
6017 
6018       if (BaseGV->isThreadLocal()) {
6019         ResultPtr = Builder.CreateThreadLocalAddress(BaseGV);
6020       } else {
6021         ResultPtr = BaseGV;
6022       }
6023     }
6024 
6025     // If the real base value actually came from an inttoptr, then the matcher
6026     // will look through it and provide only the integer value. In that case,
6027     // use it here.
6028     if (!DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(Addr->getType())) {
6029       if (!ResultPtr && AddrMode.BaseReg) {
6030         ResultPtr = Builder.CreateIntToPtr(AddrMode.BaseReg, Addr->getType(),
6031                                            "sunkaddr");
6032         AddrMode.BaseReg = nullptr;
6033       } else if (!ResultPtr && AddrMode.Scale == 1) {
6034         ResultPtr = Builder.CreateIntToPtr(AddrMode.ScaledReg, Addr->getType(),
6035                                            "sunkaddr");
6036         AddrMode.Scale = 0;
6037       }
6038     }
6039 
6040     if (!ResultPtr && !AddrMode.BaseReg && !AddrMode.Scale &&
6041         !AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
6042       SunkAddr = Constant::getNullValue(Addr->getType());
6043     } else if (!ResultPtr) {
6044       return Modified;
6045     } else {
6046       Type *I8PtrTy =
6047           Builder.getPtrTy(Addr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace());
6048 
6049       // Start with the base register. Do this first so that subsequent address
6050       // matching finds it last, which will prevent it from trying to match it
6051       // as the scaled value in case it happens to be a mul. That would be
6052       // problematic if we've sunk a different mul for the scale, because then
6053       // we'd end up sinking both muls.
6054       if (AddrMode.BaseReg) {
6055         Value *V = AddrMode.BaseReg;
6056         if (V->getType() != IntPtrTy)
6057           V = Builder.CreateIntCast(V, IntPtrTy, /*isSigned=*/true, "sunkaddr");
6058 
6059         ResultIndex = V;
6060       }
6061 
6062       // Add the scale value.
6063       if (AddrMode.Scale) {
6064         Value *V = AddrMode.ScaledReg;
6065         if (V->getType() == IntPtrTy) {
6066           // done.
6067         } else {
6068           assert(cast<IntegerType>(IntPtrTy)->getBitWidth() <
6069                      cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() &&
6070                  "We can't transform if ScaledReg is too narrow");
6071           V = Builder.CreateTrunc(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6072         }
6073 
6074         if (AddrMode.Scale != 1)
6075           V = Builder.CreateMul(V, ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.Scale),
6076                                 "sunkaddr");
6077         if (ResultIndex)
6078           ResultIndex = Builder.CreateAdd(ResultIndex, V, "sunkaddr");
6079         else
6080           ResultIndex = V;
6081       }
6082 
6083       // Add in the Base Offset if present.
6084       if (AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
6085         Value *V = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.BaseOffs);
6086         if (ResultIndex) {
6087           // We need to add this separately from the scale above to help with
6088           // SDAG consecutive load/store merging.
6089           if (ResultPtr->getType() != I8PtrTy)
6090             ResultPtr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(ResultPtr, I8PtrTy);
6091           ResultPtr = Builder.CreatePtrAdd(ResultPtr, ResultIndex, "sunkaddr",
6092                                            AddrMode.InBounds);
6093         }
6094 
6095         ResultIndex = V;
6096       }
6097 
6098       if (!ResultIndex) {
6099         auto PtrInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(ResultPtr);
6100         // We know that we have a pointer without any offsets. If this pointer
6101         // originates from a different basic block than the current one, we
6102         // must be able to recreate it in the current basic block.
6103         // We do not support the recreation of any instructions yet.
6104         if (PtrInst && PtrInst->getParent() != MemoryInst->getParent())
6105           return Modified;
6106         SunkAddr = ResultPtr;
6107       } else {
6108         if (ResultPtr->getType() != I8PtrTy)
6109           ResultPtr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(ResultPtr, I8PtrTy);
6110         SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePtrAdd(ResultPtr, ResultIndex, "sunkaddr",
6111                                         AddrMode.InBounds);
6112       }
6113 
6114       if (SunkAddr->getType() != Addr->getType()) {
6115         if (SunkAddr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace() !=
6116                 Addr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace() &&
6117             !DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(Addr->getType())) {
6118           // There are two reasons the address spaces might not match: a no-op
6119           // addrspacecast, or a ptrtoint/inttoptr pair. Either way, we emit a
6120           // ptrtoint/inttoptr pair to ensure we match the original semantics.
6121           // TODO: allow bitcast between different address space pointers with
6122           // the same size.
6123           SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(SunkAddr, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6124           SunkAddr =
6125               Builder.CreateIntToPtr(SunkAddr, Addr->getType(), "sunkaddr");
6126         } else
6127           SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(SunkAddr, Addr->getType());
6128       }
6129     }
6130   } else {
6131     // We'd require a ptrtoint/inttoptr down the line, which we can't do for
6132     // non-integral pointers, so in that case bail out now.
6133     Type *BaseTy = AddrMode.BaseReg ? AddrMode.BaseReg->getType() : nullptr;
6134     Type *ScaleTy = AddrMode.Scale ? AddrMode.ScaledReg->getType() : nullptr;
6135     PointerType *BasePtrTy = dyn_cast_or_null<PointerType>(BaseTy);
6136     PointerType *ScalePtrTy = dyn_cast_or_null<PointerType>(ScaleTy);
6137     if (DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(Addr->getType()) ||
6138         (BasePtrTy && DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(BasePtrTy)) ||
6139         (ScalePtrTy && DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(ScalePtrTy)) ||
6140         (AddrMode.BaseGV &&
6141          DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(AddrMode.BaseGV->getType())))
6142       return Modified;
6143 
6144     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: SINKING nonlocal addrmode: " << AddrMode
6145                       << " for " << *MemoryInst << "\n");
6146     Type *IntPtrTy = DL->getIntPtrType(Addr->getType());
6147     Value *Result = nullptr;
6148 
6149     // Start with the base register. Do this first so that subsequent address
6150     // matching finds it last, which will prevent it from trying to match it
6151     // as the scaled value in case it happens to be a mul. That would be
6152     // problematic if we've sunk a different mul for the scale, because then
6153     // we'd end up sinking both muls.
6154     if (AddrMode.BaseReg) {
6155       Value *V = AddrMode.BaseReg;
6156       if (V->getType()->isPointerTy())
6157         V = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6158       if (V->getType() != IntPtrTy)
6159         V = Builder.CreateIntCast(V, IntPtrTy, /*isSigned=*/true, "sunkaddr");
6160       Result = V;
6161     }
6162 
6163     // Add the scale value.
6164     if (AddrMode.Scale) {
6165       Value *V = AddrMode.ScaledReg;
6166       if (V->getType() == IntPtrTy) {
6167         // done.
6168       } else if (V->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
6169         V = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6170       } else if (cast<IntegerType>(IntPtrTy)->getBitWidth() <
6171                  cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth()) {
6172         V = Builder.CreateTrunc(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6173       } else {
6174         // It is only safe to sign extend the BaseReg if we know that the math
6175         // required to create it did not overflow before we extend it. Since
6176         // the original IR value was tossed in favor of a constant back when
6177         // the AddrMode was created we need to bail out gracefully if widths
6178         // do not match instead of extending it.
6179         Instruction *I = dyn_cast_or_null<Instruction>(Result);
6180         if (I && (Result != AddrMode.BaseReg))
6181           I->eraseFromParent();
6182         return Modified;
6183       }
6184       if (AddrMode.Scale != 1)
6185         V = Builder.CreateMul(V, ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.Scale),
6186                               "sunkaddr");
6187       if (Result)
6188         Result = Builder.CreateAdd(Result, V, "sunkaddr");
6189       else
6190         Result = V;
6191     }
6192 
6193     // Add in the BaseGV if present.
6194     GlobalValue *BaseGV = AddrMode.BaseGV;
6195     if (BaseGV != nullptr) {
6196       Value *BaseGVPtr;
6197       if (BaseGV->isThreadLocal()) {
6198         BaseGVPtr = Builder.CreateThreadLocalAddress(BaseGV);
6199       } else {
6200         BaseGVPtr = BaseGV;
6201       }
6202       Value *V = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(BaseGVPtr, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
6203       if (Result)
6204         Result = Builder.CreateAdd(Result, V, "sunkaddr");
6205       else
6206         Result = V;
6207     }
6208 
6209     // Add in the Base Offset if present.
6210     if (AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
6211       Value *V = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.BaseOffs);
6212       if (Result)
6213         Result = Builder.CreateAdd(Result, V, "sunkaddr");
6214       else
6215         Result = V;
6216     }
6217 
6218     if (!Result)
6219       SunkAddr = Constant::getNullValue(Addr->getType());
6220     else
6221       SunkAddr = Builder.CreateIntToPtr(Result, Addr->getType(), "sunkaddr");
6222   }
6223 
6224   MemoryInst->replaceUsesOfWith(Repl, SunkAddr);
6225   // Store the newly computed address into the cache. In the case we reused a
6226   // value, this should be idempotent.
6227   SunkAddrs[Addr] = WeakTrackingVH(SunkAddr);
6228 
6229   // If we have no uses, recursively delete the value and all dead instructions
6230   // using it.
6231   if (Repl->use_empty()) {
6232     resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(CurInstIterator->getParent(), [&]() {
6233       RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
6234           Repl, TLInfo, nullptr,
6235           [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
6236     });
6237   }
6238   ++NumMemoryInsts;
6239   return true;
6240 }
6241 
6242 /// Rewrite GEP input to gather/scatter to enable SelectionDAGBuilder to find
6243 /// a uniform base to use for ISD::MGATHER/MSCATTER. SelectionDAGBuilder can
6244 /// only handle a 2 operand GEP in the same basic block or a splat constant
6245 /// vector. The 2 operands to the GEP must have a scalar pointer and a vector
6246 /// index.
6247 ///
6248 /// If the existing GEP has a vector base pointer that is splat, we can look
6249 /// through the splat to find the scalar pointer. If we can't find a scalar
6250 /// pointer there's nothing we can do.
6251 ///
6252 /// If we have a GEP with more than 2 indices where the middle indices are all
6253 /// zeroes, we can replace it with 2 GEPs where the second has 2 operands.
6254 ///
6255 /// If the final index isn't a vector or is a splat, we can emit a scalar GEP
6256 /// followed by a GEP with an all zeroes vector index. This will enable
6257 /// SelectionDAGBuilder to use the scalar GEP as the uniform base and have a
6258 /// zero index.
optimizeGatherScatterInst(Instruction * MemoryInst,Value * Ptr)6259 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeGatherScatterInst(Instruction *MemoryInst,
6260                                                Value *Ptr) {
6261   Value *NewAddr;
6262 
6263   if (const auto *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
6264     // Don't optimize GEPs that don't have indices.
6265     if (!GEP->hasIndices())
6266       return false;
6267 
6268     // If the GEP and the gather/scatter aren't in the same BB, don't optimize.
6269     // FIXME: We should support this by sinking the GEP.
6270     if (MemoryInst->getParent() != GEP->getParent())
6271       return false;
6272 
6273     SmallVector<Value *, 2> Ops(GEP->operands());
6274 
6275     bool RewriteGEP = false;
6276 
6277     if (Ops[0]->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
6278       Ops[0] = getSplatValue(Ops[0]);
6279       if (!Ops[0])
6280         return false;
6281       RewriteGEP = true;
6282     }
6283 
6284     unsigned FinalIndex = Ops.size() - 1;
6285 
6286     // Ensure all but the last index is 0.
6287     // FIXME: This isn't strictly required. All that's required is that they are
6288     // all scalars or splats.
6289     for (unsigned i = 1; i < FinalIndex; ++i) {
6290       auto *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Ops[i]);
6291       if (!C)
6292         return false;
6293       if (isa<VectorType>(C->getType()))
6294         C = C->getSplatValue();
6295       auto *CI = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(C);
6296       if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
6297         return false;
6298       // Scalarize the index if needed.
6299       Ops[i] = CI;
6300     }
6301 
6302     // Try to scalarize the final index.
6303     if (Ops[FinalIndex]->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
6304       if (Value *V = getSplatValue(Ops[FinalIndex])) {
6305         auto *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V);
6306         // Don't scalarize all zeros vector.
6307         if (!C || !C->isZero()) {
6308           Ops[FinalIndex] = V;
6309           RewriteGEP = true;
6310         }
6311       }
6312     }
6313 
6314     // If we made any changes or the we have extra operands, we need to generate
6315     // new instructions.
6316     if (!RewriteGEP && Ops.size() == 2)
6317       return false;
6318 
6319     auto NumElts = cast<VectorType>(Ptr->getType())->getElementCount();
6320 
6321     IRBuilder<> Builder(MemoryInst);
6322 
6323     Type *SourceTy = GEP->getSourceElementType();
6324     Type *ScalarIndexTy = DL->getIndexType(Ops[0]->getType()->getScalarType());
6325 
6326     // If the final index isn't a vector, emit a scalar GEP containing all ops
6327     // and a vector GEP with all zeroes final index.
6328     if (!Ops[FinalIndex]->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
6329       NewAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(SourceTy, Ops[0], ArrayRef(Ops).drop_front());
6330       auto *IndexTy = VectorType::get(ScalarIndexTy, NumElts);
6331       auto *SecondTy = GetElementPtrInst::getIndexedType(
6332           SourceTy, ArrayRef(Ops).drop_front());
6333       NewAddr =
6334           Builder.CreateGEP(SecondTy, NewAddr, Constant::getNullValue(IndexTy));
6335     } else {
6336       Value *Base = Ops[0];
6337       Value *Index = Ops[FinalIndex];
6338 
6339       // Create a scalar GEP if there are more than 2 operands.
6340       if (Ops.size() != 2) {
6341         // Replace the last index with 0.
6342         Ops[FinalIndex] =
6343             Constant::getNullValue(Ops[FinalIndex]->getType()->getScalarType());
6344         Base = Builder.CreateGEP(SourceTy, Base, ArrayRef(Ops).drop_front());
6345         SourceTy = GetElementPtrInst::getIndexedType(
6346             SourceTy, ArrayRef(Ops).drop_front());
6347       }
6348 
6349       // Now create the GEP with scalar pointer and vector index.
6350       NewAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(SourceTy, Base, Index);
6351     }
6352   } else if (!isa<Constant>(Ptr)) {
6353     // Not a GEP, maybe its a splat and we can create a GEP to enable
6354     // SelectionDAGBuilder to use it as a uniform base.
6355     Value *V = getSplatValue(Ptr);
6356     if (!V)
6357       return false;
6358 
6359     auto NumElts = cast<VectorType>(Ptr->getType())->getElementCount();
6360 
6361     IRBuilder<> Builder(MemoryInst);
6362 
6363     // Emit a vector GEP with a scalar pointer and all 0s vector index.
6364     Type *ScalarIndexTy = DL->getIndexType(V->getType()->getScalarType());
6365     auto *IndexTy = VectorType::get(ScalarIndexTy, NumElts);
6366     Type *ScalarTy;
6367     if (cast<IntrinsicInst>(MemoryInst)->getIntrinsicID() ==
6368         Intrinsic::masked_gather) {
6369       ScalarTy = MemoryInst->getType()->getScalarType();
6370     } else {
6371       assert(cast<IntrinsicInst>(MemoryInst)->getIntrinsicID() ==
6372              Intrinsic::masked_scatter);
6373       ScalarTy = MemoryInst->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarType();
6374     }
6375     NewAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(ScalarTy, V, Constant::getNullValue(IndexTy));
6376   } else {
6377     // Constant, SelectionDAGBuilder knows to check if its a splat.
6378     return false;
6379   }
6380 
6381   MemoryInst->replaceUsesOfWith(Ptr, NewAddr);
6382 
6383   // If we have no uses, recursively delete the value and all dead instructions
6384   // using it.
6385   if (Ptr->use_empty())
6386     RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
6387         Ptr, TLInfo, nullptr,
6388         [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
6389 
6390   return true;
6391 }
6392 
6393 /// If there are any memory operands, use OptimizeMemoryInst to sink their
6394 /// address computing into the block when possible / profitable.
optimizeInlineAsmInst(CallInst * CS)6395 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeInlineAsmInst(CallInst *CS) {
6396   bool MadeChange = false;
6397 
6398   const TargetRegisterInfo *TRI =
6399       TM->getSubtargetImpl(*CS->getFunction())->getRegisterInfo();
6400   TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfoVector TargetConstraints =
6401       TLI->ParseConstraints(*DL, TRI, *CS);
6402   unsigned ArgNo = 0;
6403   for (TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfo &OpInfo : TargetConstraints) {
6404     // Compute the constraint code and ConstraintType to use.
6405     TLI->ComputeConstraintToUse(OpInfo, SDValue());
6406 
6407     // TODO: Also handle C_Address?
6408     if (OpInfo.ConstraintType == TargetLowering::C_Memory &&
6409         OpInfo.isIndirect) {
6410       Value *OpVal = CS->getArgOperand(ArgNo++);
6411       MadeChange |= optimizeMemoryInst(CS, OpVal, OpVal->getType(), ~0u);
6412     } else if (OpInfo.Type == InlineAsm::isInput)
6413       ArgNo++;
6414   }
6415 
6416   return MadeChange;
6417 }
6418 
6419 /// Check if all the uses of \p Val are equivalent (or free) zero or
6420 /// sign extensions.
hasSameExtUse(Value * Val,const TargetLowering & TLI)6421 static bool hasSameExtUse(Value *Val, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
6422   assert(!Val->use_empty() && "Input must have at least one use");
6423   const Instruction *FirstUser = cast<Instruction>(*Val->user_begin());
6424   bool IsSExt = isa<SExtInst>(FirstUser);
6425   Type *ExtTy = FirstUser->getType();
6426   for (const User *U : Val->users()) {
6427     const Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
6428     if ((IsSExt && !isa<SExtInst>(UI)) || (!IsSExt && !isa<ZExtInst>(UI)))
6429       return false;
6430     Type *CurTy = UI->getType();
6431     // Same input and output types: Same instruction after CSE.
6432     if (CurTy == ExtTy)
6433       continue;
6434 
6435     // If IsSExt is true, we are in this situation:
6436     // a = Val
6437     // b = sext ty1 a to ty2
6438     // c = sext ty1 a to ty3
6439     // Assuming ty2 is shorter than ty3, this could be turned into:
6440     // a = Val
6441     // b = sext ty1 a to ty2
6442     // c = sext ty2 b to ty3
6443     // However, the last sext is not free.
6444     if (IsSExt)
6445       return false;
6446 
6447     // This is a ZExt, maybe this is free to extend from one type to another.
6448     // In that case, we would not account for a different use.
6449     Type *NarrowTy;
6450     Type *LargeTy;
6451     if (ExtTy->getScalarType()->getIntegerBitWidth() >
6452         CurTy->getScalarType()->getIntegerBitWidth()) {
6453       NarrowTy = CurTy;
6454       LargeTy = ExtTy;
6455     } else {
6456       NarrowTy = ExtTy;
6457       LargeTy = CurTy;
6458     }
6459 
6460     if (!TLI.isZExtFree(NarrowTy, LargeTy))
6461       return false;
6462   }
6463   // All uses are the same or can be derived from one another for free.
6464   return true;
6465 }
6466 
6467 /// Try to speculatively promote extensions in \p Exts and continue
6468 /// promoting through newly promoted operands recursively as far as doing so is
6469 /// profitable. Save extensions profitably moved up, in \p ProfitablyMovedExts.
6470 /// When some promotion happened, \p TPT contains the proper state to revert
6471 /// them.
6472 ///
6473 /// \return true if some promotion happened, false otherwise.
tryToPromoteExts(TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & Exts,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & ProfitablyMovedExts,unsigned CreatedInstsCost)6474 bool CodeGenPrepare::tryToPromoteExts(
6475     TypePromotionTransaction &TPT, const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &Exts,
6476     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &ProfitablyMovedExts,
6477     unsigned CreatedInstsCost) {
6478   bool Promoted = false;
6479 
6480   // Iterate over all the extensions to try to promote them.
6481   for (auto *I : Exts) {
6482     // Early check if we directly have ext(load).
6483     if (isa<LoadInst>(I->getOperand(0))) {
6484       ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
6485       continue;
6486     }
6487 
6488     // Check whether or not we want to do any promotion.  The reason we have
6489     // this check inside the for loop is to catch the case where an extension
6490     // is directly fed by a load because in such case the extension can be moved
6491     // up without any promotion on its operands.
6492     if (!TLI->enableExtLdPromotion() || DisableExtLdPromotion)
6493       return false;
6494 
6495     // Get the action to perform the promotion.
6496     TypePromotionHelper::Action TPH =
6497         TypePromotionHelper::getAction(I, InsertedInsts, *TLI, PromotedInsts);
6498     // Check if we can promote.
6499     if (!TPH) {
6500       // Save the current extension as we cannot move up through its operand.
6501       ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
6502       continue;
6503     }
6504 
6505     // Save the current state.
6506     TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
6507         TPT.getRestorationPoint();
6508     SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> NewExts;
6509     unsigned NewCreatedInstsCost = 0;
6510     unsigned ExtCost = !TLI->isExtFree(I);
6511     // Promote.
6512     Value *PromotedVal = TPH(I, TPT, PromotedInsts, NewCreatedInstsCost,
6513                              &NewExts, nullptr, *TLI);
6514     assert(PromotedVal &&
6515            "TypePromotionHelper should have filtered out those cases");
6516 
6517     // We would be able to merge only one extension in a load.
6518     // Therefore, if we have more than 1 new extension we heuristically
6519     // cut this search path, because it means we degrade the code quality.
6520     // With exactly 2, the transformation is neutral, because we will merge
6521     // one extension but leave one. However, we optimistically keep going,
6522     // because the new extension may be removed too. Also avoid replacing a
6523     // single free extension with multiple extensions, as this increases the
6524     // number of IR instructions while not providing any savings.
6525     long long TotalCreatedInstsCost = CreatedInstsCost + NewCreatedInstsCost;
6526     // FIXME: It would be possible to propagate a negative value instead of
6527     // conservatively ceiling it to 0.
6528     TotalCreatedInstsCost =
6529         std::max((long long)0, (TotalCreatedInstsCost - ExtCost));
6530     if (!StressExtLdPromotion &&
6531         (TotalCreatedInstsCost > 1 ||
6532          !isPromotedInstructionLegal(*TLI, *DL, PromotedVal) ||
6533          (ExtCost == 0 && NewExts.size() > 1))) {
6534       // This promotion is not profitable, rollback to the previous state, and
6535       // save the current extension in ProfitablyMovedExts as the latest
6536       // speculative promotion turned out to be unprofitable.
6537       TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
6538       ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
6539       continue;
6540     }
6541     // Continue promoting NewExts as far as doing so is profitable.
6542     SmallVector<Instruction *, 2> NewlyMovedExts;
6543     (void)tryToPromoteExts(TPT, NewExts, NewlyMovedExts, TotalCreatedInstsCost);
6544     bool NewPromoted = false;
6545     for (auto *ExtInst : NewlyMovedExts) {
6546       Instruction *MovedExt = cast<Instruction>(ExtInst);
6547       Value *ExtOperand = MovedExt->getOperand(0);
6548       // If we have reached to a load, we need this extra profitability check
6549       // as it could potentially be merged into an ext(load).
6550       if (isa<LoadInst>(ExtOperand) &&
6551           !(StressExtLdPromotion || NewCreatedInstsCost <= ExtCost ||
6552             (ExtOperand->hasOneUse() || hasSameExtUse(ExtOperand, *TLI))))
6553         continue;
6554 
6555       ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(MovedExt);
6556       NewPromoted = true;
6557     }
6558 
6559     // If none of speculative promotions for NewExts is profitable, rollback
6560     // and save the current extension (I) as the last profitable extension.
6561     if (!NewPromoted) {
6562       TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
6563       ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
6564       continue;
6565     }
6566     // The promotion is profitable.
6567     Promoted = true;
6568   }
6569   return Promoted;
6570 }
6571 
6572 /// Merging redundant sexts when one is dominating the other.
mergeSExts(Function & F)6573 bool CodeGenPrepare::mergeSExts(Function &F) {
6574   bool Changed = false;
6575   for (auto &Entry : ValToSExtendedUses) {
6576     SExts &Insts = Entry.second;
6577     SExts CurPts;
6578     for (Instruction *Inst : Insts) {
6579       if (RemovedInsts.count(Inst) || !isa<SExtInst>(Inst) ||
6580           Inst->getOperand(0) != Entry.first)
6581         continue;
6582       bool inserted = false;
6583       for (auto &Pt : CurPts) {
6584         if (getDT(F).dominates(Inst, Pt)) {
6585           replaceAllUsesWith(Pt, Inst, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
6586           RemovedInsts.insert(Pt);
6587           Pt->removeFromParent();
6588           Pt = Inst;
6589           inserted = true;
6590           Changed = true;
6591           break;
6592         }
6593         if (!getDT(F).dominates(Pt, Inst))
6594           // Give up if we need to merge in a common dominator as the
6595           // experiments show it is not profitable.
6596           continue;
6597         replaceAllUsesWith(Inst, Pt, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
6598         RemovedInsts.insert(Inst);
6599         Inst->removeFromParent();
6600         inserted = true;
6601         Changed = true;
6602         break;
6603       }
6604       if (!inserted)
6605         CurPts.push_back(Inst);
6606     }
6607   }
6608   return Changed;
6609 }
6610 
6611 // Splitting large data structures so that the GEPs accessing them can have
6612 // smaller offsets so that they can be sunk to the same blocks as their users.
6613 // For example, a large struct starting from %base is split into two parts
6614 // where the second part starts from %new_base.
6615 //
6616 // Before:
6617 // BB0:
6618 //   %base     =
6619 //
6620 // BB1:
6621 //   %gep0     = gep %base, off0
6622 //   %gep1     = gep %base, off1
6623 //   %gep2     = gep %base, off2
6624 //
6625 // BB2:
6626 //   %load1    = load %gep0
6627 //   %load2    = load %gep1
6628 //   %load3    = load %gep2
6629 //
6630 // After:
6631 // BB0:
6632 //   %base     =
6633 //   %new_base = gep %base, off0
6634 //
6635 // BB1:
6636 //   %new_gep0 = %new_base
6637 //   %new_gep1 = gep %new_base, off1 - off0
6638 //   %new_gep2 = gep %new_base, off2 - off0
6639 //
6640 // BB2:
6641 //   %load1    = load i32, i32* %new_gep0
6642 //   %load2    = load i32, i32* %new_gep1
6643 //   %load3    = load i32, i32* %new_gep2
6644 //
6645 // %new_gep1 and %new_gep2 can be sunk to BB2 now after the splitting because
6646 // their offsets are smaller enough to fit into the addressing mode.
splitLargeGEPOffsets()6647 bool CodeGenPrepare::splitLargeGEPOffsets() {
6648   bool Changed = false;
6649   for (auto &Entry : LargeOffsetGEPMap) {
6650     Value *OldBase = Entry.first;
6651     SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t>>
6652         &LargeOffsetGEPs = Entry.second;
6653     auto compareGEPOffset =
6654         [&](const std::pair<GetElementPtrInst *, int64_t> &LHS,
6655             const std::pair<GetElementPtrInst *, int64_t> &RHS) {
6656           if (LHS.first == RHS.first)
6657             return false;
6658           if (LHS.second != RHS.second)
6659             return LHS.second < RHS.second;
6660           return LargeOffsetGEPID[LHS.first] < LargeOffsetGEPID[RHS.first];
6661         };
6662     // Sorting all the GEPs of the same data structures based on the offsets.
6663     llvm::sort(LargeOffsetGEPs, compareGEPOffset);
6664     LargeOffsetGEPs.erase(llvm::unique(LargeOffsetGEPs), LargeOffsetGEPs.end());
6665     // Skip if all the GEPs have the same offsets.
6666     if (LargeOffsetGEPs.front().second == LargeOffsetGEPs.back().second)
6667       continue;
6668     GetElementPtrInst *BaseGEP = LargeOffsetGEPs.begin()->first;
6669     int64_t BaseOffset = LargeOffsetGEPs.begin()->second;
6670     Value *NewBaseGEP = nullptr;
6671 
6672     auto createNewBase = [&](int64_t BaseOffset, Value *OldBase,
6673                              GetElementPtrInst *GEP) {
6674       LLVMContext &Ctx = GEP->getContext();
6675       Type *PtrIdxTy = DL->getIndexType(GEP->getType());
6676       Type *I8PtrTy =
6677           PointerType::get(Ctx, GEP->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace());
6678 
6679       BasicBlock::iterator NewBaseInsertPt;
6680       BasicBlock *NewBaseInsertBB;
6681       if (auto *BaseI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(OldBase)) {
6682         // If the base of the struct is an instruction, the new base will be
6683         // inserted close to it.
6684         NewBaseInsertBB = BaseI->getParent();
6685         if (isa<PHINode>(BaseI))
6686           NewBaseInsertPt = NewBaseInsertBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
6687         else if (InvokeInst *Invoke = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(BaseI)) {
6688           NewBaseInsertBB =
6689               SplitEdge(NewBaseInsertBB, Invoke->getNormalDest(), DT.get(), LI);
6690           NewBaseInsertPt = NewBaseInsertBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
6691         } else
6692           NewBaseInsertPt = std::next(BaseI->getIterator());
6693       } else {
6694         // If the current base is an argument or global value, the new base
6695         // will be inserted to the entry block.
6696         NewBaseInsertBB = &BaseGEP->getFunction()->getEntryBlock();
6697         NewBaseInsertPt = NewBaseInsertBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
6698       }
6699       IRBuilder<> NewBaseBuilder(NewBaseInsertBB, NewBaseInsertPt);
6700       // Create a new base.
6701       Value *BaseIndex = ConstantInt::get(PtrIdxTy, BaseOffset);
6702       NewBaseGEP = OldBase;
6703       if (NewBaseGEP->getType() != I8PtrTy)
6704         NewBaseGEP = NewBaseBuilder.CreatePointerCast(NewBaseGEP, I8PtrTy);
6705       NewBaseGEP =
6706           NewBaseBuilder.CreatePtrAdd(NewBaseGEP, BaseIndex, "splitgep");
6707       NewGEPBases.insert(NewBaseGEP);
6708       return;
6709     };
6710 
6711     // Check whether all the offsets can be encoded with prefered common base.
6712     if (int64_t PreferBase = TLI->getPreferredLargeGEPBaseOffset(
6713             LargeOffsetGEPs.front().second, LargeOffsetGEPs.back().second)) {
6714       BaseOffset = PreferBase;
6715       // Create a new base if the offset of the BaseGEP can be decoded with one
6716       // instruction.
6717       createNewBase(BaseOffset, OldBase, BaseGEP);
6718     }
6719 
6720     auto *LargeOffsetGEP = LargeOffsetGEPs.begin();
6721     while (LargeOffsetGEP != LargeOffsetGEPs.end()) {
6722       GetElementPtrInst *GEP = LargeOffsetGEP->first;
6723       int64_t Offset = LargeOffsetGEP->second;
6724       if (Offset != BaseOffset) {
6725         TargetLowering::AddrMode AddrMode;
6726         AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
6727         AddrMode.BaseOffs = Offset - BaseOffset;
6728         // The result type of the GEP might not be the type of the memory
6729         // access.
6730         if (!TLI->isLegalAddressingMode(*DL, AddrMode,
6731                                         GEP->getResultElementType(),
6732                                         GEP->getAddressSpace())) {
6733           // We need to create a new base if the offset to the current base is
6734           // too large to fit into the addressing mode. So, a very large struct
6735           // may be split into several parts.
6736           BaseGEP = GEP;
6737           BaseOffset = Offset;
6738           NewBaseGEP = nullptr;
6739         }
6740       }
6741 
6742       // Generate a new GEP to replace the current one.
6743       Type *PtrIdxTy = DL->getIndexType(GEP->getType());
6744 
6745       if (!NewBaseGEP) {
6746         // Create a new base if we don't have one yet.  Find the insertion
6747         // pointer for the new base first.
6748         createNewBase(BaseOffset, OldBase, GEP);
6749       }
6750 
6751       IRBuilder<> Builder(GEP);
6752       Value *NewGEP = NewBaseGEP;
6753       if (Offset != BaseOffset) {
6754         // Calculate the new offset for the new GEP.
6755         Value *Index = ConstantInt::get(PtrIdxTy, Offset - BaseOffset);
6756         NewGEP = Builder.CreatePtrAdd(NewBaseGEP, Index);
6757       }
6758       replaceAllUsesWith(GEP, NewGEP, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
6759       LargeOffsetGEPID.erase(GEP);
6760       LargeOffsetGEP = LargeOffsetGEPs.erase(LargeOffsetGEP);
6761       GEP->eraseFromParent();
6762       Changed = true;
6763     }
6764   }
6765   return Changed;
6766 }
6767 
optimizePhiType(PHINode * I,SmallPtrSetImpl<PHINode * > & Visited,SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction * > & DeletedInstrs)6768 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizePhiType(
6769     PHINode *I, SmallPtrSetImpl<PHINode *> &Visited,
6770     SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &DeletedInstrs) {
6771   // We are looking for a collection on interconnected phi nodes that together
6772   // only use loads/bitcasts and are used by stores/bitcasts, and the bitcasts
6773   // are of the same type. Convert the whole set of nodes to the type of the
6774   // bitcast.
6775   Type *PhiTy = I->getType();
6776   Type *ConvertTy = nullptr;
6777   if (Visited.count(I) ||
6778       (!I->getType()->isIntegerTy() && !I->getType()->isFloatingPointTy()))
6779     return false;
6780 
6781   SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> Worklist;
6782   Worklist.push_back(cast<Instruction>(I));
6783   SmallPtrSet<PHINode *, 4> PhiNodes;
6784   SmallPtrSet<ConstantData *, 4> Constants;
6785   PhiNodes.insert(I);
6786   Visited.insert(I);
6787   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 4> Defs;
6788   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 4> Uses;
6789   // This works by adding extra bitcasts between load/stores and removing
6790   // existing bicasts. If we have a phi(bitcast(load)) or a store(bitcast(phi))
6791   // we can get in the situation where we remove a bitcast in one iteration
6792   // just to add it again in the next. We need to ensure that at least one
6793   // bitcast we remove are anchored to something that will not change back.
6794   bool AnyAnchored = false;
6795 
6796   while (!Worklist.empty()) {
6797     Instruction *II = Worklist.pop_back_val();
6798 
6799     if (auto *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(II)) {
6800       // Handle Defs, which might also be PHI's
6801       for (Value *V : Phi->incoming_values()) {
6802         if (auto *OpPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
6803           if (!PhiNodes.count(OpPhi)) {
6804             if (!Visited.insert(OpPhi).second)
6805               return false;
6806             PhiNodes.insert(OpPhi);
6807             Worklist.push_back(OpPhi);
6808           }
6809         } else if (auto *OpLoad = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(V)) {
6810           if (!OpLoad->isSimple())
6811             return false;
6812           if (Defs.insert(OpLoad).second)
6813             Worklist.push_back(OpLoad);
6814         } else if (auto *OpEx = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(V)) {
6815           if (Defs.insert(OpEx).second)
6816             Worklist.push_back(OpEx);
6817         } else if (auto *OpBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V)) {
6818           if (!ConvertTy)
6819             ConvertTy = OpBC->getOperand(0)->getType();
6820           if (OpBC->getOperand(0)->getType() != ConvertTy)
6821             return false;
6822           if (Defs.insert(OpBC).second) {
6823             Worklist.push_back(OpBC);
6824             AnyAnchored |= !isa<LoadInst>(OpBC->getOperand(0)) &&
6825                            !isa<ExtractElementInst>(OpBC->getOperand(0));
6826           }
6827         } else if (auto *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantData>(V))
6828           Constants.insert(OpC);
6829         else
6830           return false;
6831       }
6832     }
6833 
6834     // Handle uses which might also be phi's
6835     for (User *V : II->users()) {
6836       if (auto *OpPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
6837         if (!PhiNodes.count(OpPhi)) {
6838           if (Visited.count(OpPhi))
6839             return false;
6840           PhiNodes.insert(OpPhi);
6841           Visited.insert(OpPhi);
6842           Worklist.push_back(OpPhi);
6843         }
6844       } else if (auto *OpStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(V)) {
6845         if (!OpStore->isSimple() || OpStore->getOperand(0) != II)
6846           return false;
6847         Uses.insert(OpStore);
6848       } else if (auto *OpBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V)) {
6849         if (!ConvertTy)
6850           ConvertTy = OpBC->getType();
6851         if (OpBC->getType() != ConvertTy)
6852           return false;
6853         Uses.insert(OpBC);
6854         AnyAnchored |=
6855             any_of(OpBC->users(), [](User *U) { return !isa<StoreInst>(U); });
6856       } else {
6857         return false;
6858       }
6859     }
6860   }
6861 
6862   if (!ConvertTy || !AnyAnchored ||
6863       !TLI->shouldConvertPhiType(PhiTy, ConvertTy))
6864     return false;
6865 
6866   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Converting " << *I << "\n  and connected nodes to "
6867                     << *ConvertTy << "\n");
6868 
6869   // Create all the new phi nodes of the new type, and bitcast any loads to the
6870   // correct type.
6871   ValueToValueMap ValMap;
6872   for (ConstantData *C : Constants)
6873     ValMap[C] = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(C, ConvertTy);
6874   for (Instruction *D : Defs) {
6875     if (isa<BitCastInst>(D)) {
6876       ValMap[D] = D->getOperand(0);
6877       DeletedInstrs.insert(D);
6878     } else {
6879       BasicBlock::iterator insertPt = std::next(D->getIterator());
6880       ValMap[D] = new BitCastInst(D, ConvertTy, D->getName() + ".bc", insertPt);
6881     }
6882   }
6883   for (PHINode *Phi : PhiNodes)
6884     ValMap[Phi] = PHINode::Create(ConvertTy, Phi->getNumIncomingValues(),
6885                                   Phi->getName() + ".tc", Phi->getIterator());
6886   // Pipe together all the PhiNodes.
6887   for (PHINode *Phi : PhiNodes) {
6888     PHINode *NewPhi = cast<PHINode>(ValMap[Phi]);
6889     for (int i = 0, e = Phi->getNumIncomingValues(); i < e; i++)
6890       NewPhi->addIncoming(ValMap[Phi->getIncomingValue(i)],
6891                           Phi->getIncomingBlock(i));
6892     Visited.insert(NewPhi);
6893   }
6894   // And finally pipe up the stores and bitcasts
6895   for (Instruction *U : Uses) {
6896     if (isa<BitCastInst>(U)) {
6897       DeletedInstrs.insert(U);
6898       replaceAllUsesWith(U, ValMap[U->getOperand(0)], FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
6899     } else {
6900       U->setOperand(0, new BitCastInst(ValMap[U->getOperand(0)], PhiTy, "bc",
6901                                        U->getIterator()));
6902     }
6903   }
6904 
6905   // Save the removed phis to be deleted later.
6906   DeletedInstrs.insert_range(PhiNodes);
6907   return true;
6908 }
6909 
optimizePhiTypes(Function & F)6910 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizePhiTypes(Function &F) {
6911   if (!OptimizePhiTypes)
6912     return false;
6913 
6914   bool Changed = false;
6915   SmallPtrSet<PHINode *, 4> Visited;
6916   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 4> DeletedInstrs;
6917 
6918   // Attempt to optimize all the phis in the functions to the correct type.
6919   for (auto &BB : F)
6920     for (auto &Phi : BB.phis())
6921       Changed |= optimizePhiType(&Phi, Visited, DeletedInstrs);
6922 
6923   // Remove any old phi's that have been converted.
6924   for (auto *I : DeletedInstrs) {
6925     replaceAllUsesWith(I, PoisonValue::get(I->getType()), FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
6926     I->eraseFromParent();
6927   }
6928 
6929   return Changed;
6930 }
6931 
6932 /// Return true, if an ext(load) can be formed from an extension in
6933 /// \p MovedExts.
canFormExtLd(const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & MovedExts,LoadInst * & LI,Instruction * & Inst,bool HasPromoted)6934 bool CodeGenPrepare::canFormExtLd(
6935     const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &MovedExts, LoadInst *&LI,
6936     Instruction *&Inst, bool HasPromoted) {
6937   for (auto *MovedExtInst : MovedExts) {
6938     if (isa<LoadInst>(MovedExtInst->getOperand(0))) {
6939       LI = cast<LoadInst>(MovedExtInst->getOperand(0));
6940       Inst = MovedExtInst;
6941       break;
6942     }
6943   }
6944   if (!LI)
6945     return false;
6946 
6947   // If they're already in the same block, there's nothing to do.
6948   // Make the cheap checks first if we did not promote.
6949   // If we promoted, we need to check if it is indeed profitable.
6950   if (!HasPromoted && LI->getParent() == Inst->getParent())
6951     return false;
6952 
6953   return TLI->isExtLoad(LI, Inst, *DL);
6954 }
6955 
6956 /// Move a zext or sext fed by a load into the same basic block as the load,
6957 /// unless conditions are unfavorable. This allows SelectionDAG to fold the
6958 /// extend into the load.
6959 ///
6960 /// E.g.,
6961 /// \code
6962 /// %ld = load i32* %addr
6963 /// %add = add nuw i32 %ld, 4
6964 /// %zext = zext i32 %add to i64
6965 // \endcode
6966 /// =>
6967 /// \code
6968 /// %ld = load i32* %addr
6969 /// %zext = zext i32 %ld to i64
6970 /// %add = add nuw i64 %zext, 4
6971 /// \encode
6972 /// Note that the promotion in %add to i64 is done in tryToPromoteExts(), which
6973 /// allow us to match zext(load i32*) to i64.
6974 ///
6975 /// Also, try to promote the computations used to obtain a sign extended
6976 /// value used into memory accesses.
6977 /// E.g.,
6978 /// \code
6979 /// a = add nsw i32 b, 3
6980 /// d = sext i32 a to i64
6981 /// e = getelementptr ..., i64 d
6982 /// \endcode
6983 /// =>
6984 /// \code
6985 /// f = sext i32 b to i64
6986 /// a = add nsw i64 f, 3
6987 /// e = getelementptr ..., i64 a
6988 /// \endcode
6989 ///
6990 /// \p Inst[in/out] the extension may be modified during the process if some
6991 /// promotions apply.
optimizeExt(Instruction * & Inst)6992 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeExt(Instruction *&Inst) {
6993   bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader = false;
6994   /// See if it is an interesting sext operations for the address type
6995   /// promotion before trying to promote it, e.g., the ones with the right
6996   /// type and used in memory accesses.
6997   bool ATPConsiderable = TTI->shouldConsiderAddressTypePromotion(
6998       *Inst, AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader);
6999   TypePromotionTransaction TPT(RemovedInsts);
7000   TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
7001       TPT.getRestorationPoint();
7002   SmallVector<Instruction *, 1> Exts;
7003   SmallVector<Instruction *, 2> SpeculativelyMovedExts;
7004   Exts.push_back(Inst);
7005 
7006   bool HasPromoted = tryToPromoteExts(TPT, Exts, SpeculativelyMovedExts);
7007 
7008   // Look for a load being extended.
7009   LoadInst *LI = nullptr;
7010   Instruction *ExtFedByLoad;
7011 
7012   // Try to promote a chain of computation if it allows to form an extended
7013   // load.
7014   if (canFormExtLd(SpeculativelyMovedExts, LI, ExtFedByLoad, HasPromoted)) {
7015     assert(LI && ExtFedByLoad && "Expect a valid load and extension");
7016     TPT.commit();
7017     // Move the extend into the same block as the load.
7018     ExtFedByLoad->moveAfter(LI);
7019     ++NumExtsMoved;
7020     Inst = ExtFedByLoad;
7021     return true;
7022   }
7023 
7024   // Continue promoting SExts if known as considerable depending on targets.
7025   if (ATPConsiderable &&
7026       performAddressTypePromotion(Inst, AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,
7027                                   HasPromoted, TPT, SpeculativelyMovedExts))
7028     return true;
7029 
7030   TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
7031   return false;
7032 }
7033 
7034 // Perform address type promotion if doing so is profitable.
7035 // If AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader == false, we should find other sext
7036 // instructions that sign extended the same initial value. However, if
7037 // AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader == true, we expect promoting the
7038 // extension is just profitable.
performAddressTypePromotion(Instruction * & Inst,bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,bool HasPromoted,TypePromotionTransaction & TPT,SmallVectorImpl<Instruction * > & SpeculativelyMovedExts)7039 bool CodeGenPrepare::performAddressTypePromotion(
7040     Instruction *&Inst, bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,
7041     bool HasPromoted, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
7042     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
7043   bool Promoted = false;
7044   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 1> UnhandledExts;
7045   bool AllSeenFirst = true;
7046   for (auto *I : SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
7047     Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
7048     DenseMap<Value *, Instruction *>::iterator AlreadySeen =
7049         SeenChainsForSExt.find(HeadOfChain);
7050     // If there is an unhandled SExt which has the same header, try to promote
7051     // it as well.
7052     if (AlreadySeen != SeenChainsForSExt.end()) {
7053       if (AlreadySeen->second != nullptr)
7054         UnhandledExts.insert(AlreadySeen->second);
7055       AllSeenFirst = false;
7056     }
7057   }
7058 
7059   if (!AllSeenFirst || (AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader &&
7060                         SpeculativelyMovedExts.size() == 1)) {
7061     TPT.commit();
7062     if (HasPromoted)
7063       Promoted = true;
7064     for (auto *I : SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
7065       Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
7066       SeenChainsForSExt[HeadOfChain] = nullptr;
7067       ValToSExtendedUses[HeadOfChain].push_back(I);
7068     }
7069     // Update Inst as promotion happen.
7070     Inst = SpeculativelyMovedExts.pop_back_val();
7071   } else {
7072     // This is the first chain visited from the header, keep the current chain
7073     // as unhandled. Defer to promote this until we encounter another SExt
7074     // chain derived from the same header.
7075     for (auto *I : SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
7076       Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
7077       SeenChainsForSExt[HeadOfChain] = Inst;
7078     }
7079     return false;
7080   }
7081 
7082   if (!AllSeenFirst && !UnhandledExts.empty())
7083     for (auto *VisitedSExt : UnhandledExts) {
7084       if (RemovedInsts.count(VisitedSExt))
7085         continue;
7086       TypePromotionTransaction TPT(RemovedInsts);
7087       SmallVector<Instruction *, 1> Exts;
7088       SmallVector<Instruction *, 2> Chains;
7089       Exts.push_back(VisitedSExt);
7090       bool HasPromoted = tryToPromoteExts(TPT, Exts, Chains);
7091       TPT.commit();
7092       if (HasPromoted)
7093         Promoted = true;
7094       for (auto *I : Chains) {
7095         Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
7096         // Mark this as handled.
7097         SeenChainsForSExt[HeadOfChain] = nullptr;
7098         ValToSExtendedUses[HeadOfChain].push_back(I);
7099       }
7100     }
7101   return Promoted;
7102 }
7103 
optimizeExtUses(Instruction * I)7104 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeExtUses(Instruction *I) {
7105   BasicBlock *DefBB = I->getParent();
7106 
7107   // If the result of a {s|z}ext and its source are both live out, rewrite all
7108   // other uses of the source with result of extension.
7109   Value *Src = I->getOperand(0);
7110   if (Src->hasOneUse())
7111     return false;
7112 
7113   // Only do this xform if truncating is free.
7114   if (!TLI->isTruncateFree(I->getType(), Src->getType()))
7115     return false;
7116 
7117   // Only safe to perform the optimization if the source is also defined in
7118   // this block.
7119   if (!isa<Instruction>(Src) || DefBB != cast<Instruction>(Src)->getParent())
7120     return false;
7121 
7122   bool DefIsLiveOut = false;
7123   for (User *U : I->users()) {
7124     Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
7125 
7126     // Figure out which BB this ext is used in.
7127     BasicBlock *UserBB = UI->getParent();
7128     if (UserBB == DefBB)
7129       continue;
7130     DefIsLiveOut = true;
7131     break;
7132   }
7133   if (!DefIsLiveOut)
7134     return false;
7135 
7136   // Make sure none of the uses are PHI nodes.
7137   for (User *U : Src->users()) {
7138     Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
7139     BasicBlock *UserBB = UI->getParent();
7140     if (UserBB == DefBB)
7141       continue;
7142     // Be conservative. We don't want this xform to end up introducing
7143     // reloads just before load / store instructions.
7144     if (isa<PHINode>(UI) || isa<LoadInst>(UI) || isa<StoreInst>(UI))
7145       return false;
7146   }
7147 
7148   // InsertedTruncs - Only insert one trunc in each block once.
7149   DenseMap<BasicBlock *, Instruction *> InsertedTruncs;
7150 
7151   bool MadeChange = false;
7152   for (Use &U : Src->uses()) {
7153     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
7154 
7155     // Figure out which BB this ext is used in.
7156     BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
7157     if (UserBB == DefBB)
7158       continue;
7159 
7160     // Both src and def are live in this block. Rewrite the use.
7161     Instruction *&InsertedTrunc = InsertedTruncs[UserBB];
7162 
7163     if (!InsertedTrunc) {
7164       BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
7165       assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
7166       InsertedTrunc = new TruncInst(I, Src->getType(), "");
7167       InsertedTrunc->insertBefore(*UserBB, InsertPt);
7168       InsertedInsts.insert(InsertedTrunc);
7169     }
7170 
7171     // Replace a use of the {s|z}ext source with a use of the result.
7172     U = InsertedTrunc;
7173     ++NumExtUses;
7174     MadeChange = true;
7175   }
7176 
7177   return MadeChange;
7178 }
7179 
7180 // Find loads whose uses only use some of the loaded value's bits.  Add an "and"
7181 // just after the load if the target can fold this into one extload instruction,
7182 // with the hope of eliminating some of the other later "and" instructions using
7183 // the loaded value.  "and"s that are made trivially redundant by the insertion
7184 // of the new "and" are removed by this function, while others (e.g. those whose
7185 // path from the load goes through a phi) are left for isel to potentially
7186 // remove.
7187 //
7188 // For example:
7189 //
7190 // b0:
7191 //   x = load i32
7192 //   ...
7193 // b1:
7194 //   y = and x, 0xff
7195 //   z = use y
7196 //
7197 // becomes:
7198 //
7199 // b0:
7200 //   x = load i32
7201 //   x' = and x, 0xff
7202 //   ...
7203 // b1:
7204 //   z = use x'
7205 //
7206 // whereas:
7207 //
7208 // b0:
7209 //   x1 = load i32
7210 //   ...
7211 // b1:
7212 //   x2 = load i32
7213 //   ...
7214 // b2:
7215 //   x = phi x1, x2
7216 //   y = and x, 0xff
7217 //
7218 // becomes (after a call to optimizeLoadExt for each load):
7219 //
7220 // b0:
7221 //   x1 = load i32
7222 //   x1' = and x1, 0xff
7223 //   ...
7224 // b1:
7225 //   x2 = load i32
7226 //   x2' = and x2, 0xff
7227 //   ...
7228 // b2:
7229 //   x = phi x1', x2'
7230 //   y = and x, 0xff
optimizeLoadExt(LoadInst * Load)7231 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeLoadExt(LoadInst *Load) {
7232   if (!Load->isSimple() || !Load->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy())
7233     return false;
7234 
7235   // Skip loads we've already transformed.
7236   if (Load->hasOneUse() &&
7237       InsertedInsts.count(cast<Instruction>(*Load->user_begin())))
7238     return false;
7239 
7240   // Look at all uses of Load, looking through phis, to determine how many bits
7241   // of the loaded value are needed.
7242   SmallVector<Instruction *, 8> WorkList;
7243   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 16> Visited;
7244   SmallVector<Instruction *, 8> AndsToMaybeRemove;
7245   SmallVector<Instruction *, 8> DropFlags;
7246   for (auto *U : Load->users())
7247     WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(U));
7248 
7249   EVT LoadResultVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, Load->getType());
7250   unsigned BitWidth = LoadResultVT.getSizeInBits();
7251   // If the BitWidth is 0, do not try to optimize the type
7252   if (BitWidth == 0)
7253     return false;
7254 
7255   APInt DemandBits(BitWidth, 0);
7256   APInt WidestAndBits(BitWidth, 0);
7257 
7258   while (!WorkList.empty()) {
7259     Instruction *I = WorkList.pop_back_val();
7260 
7261     // Break use-def graph loops.
7262     if (!Visited.insert(I).second)
7263       continue;
7264 
7265     // For a PHI node, push all of its users.
7266     if (auto *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) {
7267       for (auto *U : Phi->users())
7268         WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(U));
7269       continue;
7270     }
7271 
7272     switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7273     case Instruction::And: {
7274       auto *AndC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
7275       if (!AndC)
7276         return false;
7277       APInt AndBits = AndC->getValue();
7278       DemandBits |= AndBits;
7279       // Keep track of the widest and mask we see.
7280       if (AndBits.ugt(WidestAndBits))
7281         WidestAndBits = AndBits;
7282       if (AndBits == WidestAndBits && I->getOperand(0) == Load)
7283         AndsToMaybeRemove.push_back(I);
7284       break;
7285     }
7286 
7287     case Instruction::Shl: {
7288       auto *ShlC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
7289       if (!ShlC)
7290         return false;
7291       uint64_t ShiftAmt = ShlC->getLimitedValue(BitWidth - 1);
7292       DemandBits.setLowBits(BitWidth - ShiftAmt);
7293       DropFlags.push_back(I);
7294       break;
7295     }
7296 
7297     case Instruction::Trunc: {
7298       EVT TruncVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, I->getType());
7299       unsigned TruncBitWidth = TruncVT.getSizeInBits();
7300       DemandBits.setLowBits(TruncBitWidth);
7301       DropFlags.push_back(I);
7302       break;
7303     }
7304 
7305     default:
7306       return false;
7307     }
7308   }
7309 
7310   uint32_t ActiveBits = DemandBits.getActiveBits();
7311   // Avoid hoisting (and (load x) 1) since it is unlikely to be folded by the
7312   // target even if isLoadExtLegal says an i1 EXTLOAD is valid.  For example,
7313   // for the AArch64 target isLoadExtLegal(ZEXTLOAD, i32, i1) returns true, but
7314   // (and (load x) 1) is not matched as a single instruction, rather as a LDR
7315   // followed by an AND.
7316   // TODO: Look into removing this restriction by fixing backends to either
7317   // return false for isLoadExtLegal for i1 or have them select this pattern to
7318   // a single instruction.
7319   //
7320   // Also avoid hoisting if we didn't see any ands with the exact DemandBits
7321   // mask, since these are the only ands that will be removed by isel.
7322   if (ActiveBits <= 1 || !DemandBits.isMask(ActiveBits) ||
7323       WidestAndBits != DemandBits)
7324     return false;
7325 
7326   LLVMContext &Ctx = Load->getType()->getContext();
7327   Type *TruncTy = Type::getIntNTy(Ctx, ActiveBits);
7328   EVT TruncVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, TruncTy);
7329 
7330   // Reject cases that won't be matched as extloads.
7331   if (!LoadResultVT.bitsGT(TruncVT) || !TruncVT.isRound() ||
7332       !TLI->isLoadExtLegal(ISD::ZEXTLOAD, LoadResultVT, TruncVT))
7333     return false;
7334 
7335   IRBuilder<> Builder(Load->getNextNonDebugInstruction());
7336   auto *NewAnd = cast<Instruction>(
7337       Builder.CreateAnd(Load, ConstantInt::get(Ctx, DemandBits)));
7338   // Mark this instruction as "inserted by CGP", so that other
7339   // optimizations don't touch it.
7340   InsertedInsts.insert(NewAnd);
7341 
7342   // Replace all uses of load with new and (except for the use of load in the
7343   // new and itself).
7344   replaceAllUsesWith(Load, NewAnd, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7345   NewAnd->setOperand(0, Load);
7346 
7347   // Remove any and instructions that are now redundant.
7348   for (auto *And : AndsToMaybeRemove)
7349     // Check that the and mask is the same as the one we decided to put on the
7350     // new and.
7351     if (cast<ConstantInt>(And->getOperand(1))->getValue() == DemandBits) {
7352       replaceAllUsesWith(And, NewAnd, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7353       if (&*CurInstIterator == And)
7354         CurInstIterator = std::next(And->getIterator());
7355       And->eraseFromParent();
7356       ++NumAndUses;
7357     }
7358 
7359   // NSW flags may not longer hold.
7360   for (auto *Inst : DropFlags)
7361     Inst->setHasNoSignedWrap(false);
7362 
7363   ++NumAndsAdded;
7364   return true;
7365 }
7366 
7367 /// Check if V (an operand of a select instruction) is an expensive instruction
7368 /// that is only used once.
sinkSelectOperand(const TargetTransformInfo * TTI,Value * V)7369 static bool sinkSelectOperand(const TargetTransformInfo *TTI, Value *V) {
7370   auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
7371   // If it's safe to speculatively execute, then it should not have side
7372   // effects; therefore, it's safe to sink and possibly *not* execute.
7373   return I && I->hasOneUse() && isSafeToSpeculativelyExecute(I) &&
7374          TTI->isExpensiveToSpeculativelyExecute(I);
7375 }
7376 
7377 /// Returns true if a SelectInst should be turned into an explicit branch.
isFormingBranchFromSelectProfitable(const TargetTransformInfo * TTI,const TargetLowering * TLI,SelectInst * SI)7378 static bool isFormingBranchFromSelectProfitable(const TargetTransformInfo *TTI,
7379                                                 const TargetLowering *TLI,
7380                                                 SelectInst *SI) {
7381   // If even a predictable select is cheap, then a branch can't be cheaper.
7382   if (!TLI->isPredictableSelectExpensive())
7383     return false;
7384 
7385   // FIXME: This should use the same heuristics as IfConversion to determine
7386   // whether a select is better represented as a branch.
7387 
7388   // If metadata tells us that the select condition is obviously predictable,
7389   // then we want to replace the select with a branch.
7390   uint64_t TrueWeight, FalseWeight;
7391   if (extractBranchWeights(*SI, TrueWeight, FalseWeight)) {
7392     uint64_t Max = std::max(TrueWeight, FalseWeight);
7393     uint64_t Sum = TrueWeight + FalseWeight;
7394     if (Sum != 0) {
7395       auto Probability = BranchProbability::getBranchProbability(Max, Sum);
7396       if (Probability > TTI->getPredictableBranchThreshold())
7397         return true;
7398     }
7399   }
7400 
7401   CmpInst *Cmp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(SI->getCondition());
7402 
7403   // If a branch is predictable, an out-of-order CPU can avoid blocking on its
7404   // comparison condition. If the compare has more than one use, there's
7405   // probably another cmov or setcc around, so it's not worth emitting a branch.
7406   if (!Cmp || !Cmp->hasOneUse())
7407     return false;
7408 
7409   // If either operand of the select is expensive and only needed on one side
7410   // of the select, we should form a branch.
7411   if (sinkSelectOperand(TTI, SI->getTrueValue()) ||
7412       sinkSelectOperand(TTI, SI->getFalseValue()))
7413     return true;
7414 
7415   return false;
7416 }
7417 
7418 /// If \p isTrue is true, return the true value of \p SI, otherwise return
7419 /// false value of \p SI. If the true/false value of \p SI is defined by any
7420 /// select instructions in \p Selects, look through the defining select
7421 /// instruction until the true/false value is not defined in \p Selects.
7422 static Value *
getTrueOrFalseValue(SelectInst * SI,bool isTrue,const SmallPtrSet<const Instruction *,2> & Selects)7423 getTrueOrFalseValue(SelectInst *SI, bool isTrue,
7424                     const SmallPtrSet<const Instruction *, 2> &Selects) {
7425   Value *V = nullptr;
7426 
7427   for (SelectInst *DefSI = SI; DefSI != nullptr && Selects.count(DefSI);
7428        DefSI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
7429     assert(DefSI->getCondition() == SI->getCondition() &&
7430            "The condition of DefSI does not match with SI");
7431     V = (isTrue ? DefSI->getTrueValue() : DefSI->getFalseValue());
7432   }
7433 
7434   assert(V && "Failed to get select true/false value");
7435   return V;
7436 }
7437 
optimizeShiftInst(BinaryOperator * Shift)7438 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeShiftInst(BinaryOperator *Shift) {
7439   assert(Shift->isShift() && "Expected a shift");
7440 
7441   // If this is (1) a vector shift, (2) shifts by scalars are cheaper than
7442   // general vector shifts, and (3) the shift amount is a select-of-splatted
7443   // values, hoist the shifts before the select:
7444   //   shift Op0, (select Cond, TVal, FVal) -->
7445   //   select Cond, (shift Op0, TVal), (shift Op0, FVal)
7446   //
7447   // This is inverting a generic IR transform when we know that the cost of a
7448   // general vector shift is more than the cost of 2 shift-by-scalars.
7449   // We can't do this effectively in SDAG because we may not be able to
7450   // determine if the select operands are splats from within a basic block.
7451   Type *Ty = Shift->getType();
7452   if (!Ty->isVectorTy() || !TTI->isVectorShiftByScalarCheap(Ty))
7453     return false;
7454   Value *Cond, *TVal, *FVal;
7455   if (!match(Shift->getOperand(1),
7456              m_OneUse(m_Select(m_Value(Cond), m_Value(TVal), m_Value(FVal)))))
7457     return false;
7458   if (!isSplatValue(TVal) || !isSplatValue(FVal))
7459     return false;
7460 
7461   IRBuilder<> Builder(Shift);
7462   BinaryOperator::BinaryOps Opcode = Shift->getOpcode();
7463   Value *NewTVal = Builder.CreateBinOp(Opcode, Shift->getOperand(0), TVal);
7464   Value *NewFVal = Builder.CreateBinOp(Opcode, Shift->getOperand(0), FVal);
7465   Value *NewSel = Builder.CreateSelect(Cond, NewTVal, NewFVal);
7466   replaceAllUsesWith(Shift, NewSel, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7467   Shift->eraseFromParent();
7468   return true;
7469 }
7470 
optimizeFunnelShift(IntrinsicInst * Fsh)7471 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeFunnelShift(IntrinsicInst *Fsh) {
7472   Intrinsic::ID Opcode = Fsh->getIntrinsicID();
7473   assert((Opcode == Intrinsic::fshl || Opcode == Intrinsic::fshr) &&
7474          "Expected a funnel shift");
7475 
7476   // If this is (1) a vector funnel shift, (2) shifts by scalars are cheaper
7477   // than general vector shifts, and (3) the shift amount is select-of-splatted
7478   // values, hoist the funnel shifts before the select:
7479   //   fsh Op0, Op1, (select Cond, TVal, FVal) -->
7480   //   select Cond, (fsh Op0, Op1, TVal), (fsh Op0, Op1, FVal)
7481   //
7482   // This is inverting a generic IR transform when we know that the cost of a
7483   // general vector shift is more than the cost of 2 shift-by-scalars.
7484   // We can't do this effectively in SDAG because we may not be able to
7485   // determine if the select operands are splats from within a basic block.
7486   Type *Ty = Fsh->getType();
7487   if (!Ty->isVectorTy() || !TTI->isVectorShiftByScalarCheap(Ty))
7488     return false;
7489   Value *Cond, *TVal, *FVal;
7490   if (!match(Fsh->getOperand(2),
7491              m_OneUse(m_Select(m_Value(Cond), m_Value(TVal), m_Value(FVal)))))
7492     return false;
7493   if (!isSplatValue(TVal) || !isSplatValue(FVal))
7494     return false;
7495 
7496   IRBuilder<> Builder(Fsh);
7497   Value *X = Fsh->getOperand(0), *Y = Fsh->getOperand(1);
7498   Value *NewTVal = Builder.CreateIntrinsic(Opcode, Ty, {X, Y, TVal});
7499   Value *NewFVal = Builder.CreateIntrinsic(Opcode, Ty, {X, Y, FVal});
7500   Value *NewSel = Builder.CreateSelect(Cond, NewTVal, NewFVal);
7501   replaceAllUsesWith(Fsh, NewSel, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7502   Fsh->eraseFromParent();
7503   return true;
7504 }
7505 
7506 /// If we have a SelectInst that will likely profit from branch prediction,
7507 /// turn it into a branch.
optimizeSelectInst(SelectInst * SI)7508 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeSelectInst(SelectInst *SI) {
7509   if (DisableSelectToBranch)
7510     return false;
7511 
7512   // If the SelectOptimize pass is enabled, selects have already been optimized.
7513   if (!getCGPassBuilderOption().DisableSelectOptimize)
7514     return false;
7515 
7516   // Find all consecutive select instructions that share the same condition.
7517   SmallVector<SelectInst *, 2> ASI;
7518   ASI.push_back(SI);
7519   for (BasicBlock::iterator It = ++BasicBlock::iterator(SI);
7520        It != SI->getParent()->end(); ++It) {
7521     SelectInst *I = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(&*It);
7522     if (I && SI->getCondition() == I->getCondition()) {
7523       ASI.push_back(I);
7524     } else {
7525       break;
7526     }
7527   }
7528 
7529   SelectInst *LastSI = ASI.back();
7530   // Increment the current iterator to skip all the rest of select instructions
7531   // because they will be either "not lowered" or "all lowered" to branch.
7532   CurInstIterator = std::next(LastSI->getIterator());
7533   // Examine debug-info attached to the consecutive select instructions. They
7534   // won't be individually optimised by optimizeInst, so we need to perform
7535   // DbgVariableRecord maintenence here instead.
7536   for (SelectInst *SI : ArrayRef(ASI).drop_front())
7537     fixupDbgVariableRecordsOnInst(*SI);
7538 
7539   bool VectorCond = !SI->getCondition()->getType()->isIntegerTy(1);
7540 
7541   // Can we convert the 'select' to CF ?
7542   if (VectorCond || SI->getMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_unpredictable))
7543     return false;
7544 
7545   TargetLowering::SelectSupportKind SelectKind;
7546   if (SI->getType()->isVectorTy())
7547     SelectKind = TargetLowering::ScalarCondVectorVal;
7548   else
7549     SelectKind = TargetLowering::ScalarValSelect;
7550 
7551   if (TLI->isSelectSupported(SelectKind) &&
7552       (!isFormingBranchFromSelectProfitable(TTI, TLI, SI) ||
7553        llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(SI->getParent(), PSI, BFI.get())))
7554     return false;
7555 
7556   // The DominatorTree needs to be rebuilt by any consumers after this
7557   // transformation. We simply reset here rather than setting the ModifiedDT
7558   // flag to avoid restarting the function walk in runOnFunction for each
7559   // select optimized.
7560   DT.reset();
7561 
7562   // Transform a sequence like this:
7563   //    start:
7564   //       %cmp = cmp uge i32 %a, %b
7565   //       %sel = select i1 %cmp, i32 %c, i32 %d
7566   //
7567   // Into:
7568   //    start:
7569   //       %cmp = cmp uge i32 %a, %b
7570   //       %cmp.frozen = freeze %cmp
7571   //       br i1 %cmp.frozen, label %select.true, label %select.false
7572   //    select.true:
7573   //       br label %select.end
7574   //    select.false:
7575   //       br label %select.end
7576   //    select.end:
7577   //       %sel = phi i32 [ %c, %select.true ], [ %d, %select.false ]
7578   //
7579   // %cmp should be frozen, otherwise it may introduce undefined behavior.
7580   // In addition, we may sink instructions that produce %c or %d from
7581   // the entry block into the destination(s) of the new branch.
7582   // If the true or false blocks do not contain a sunken instruction, that
7583   // block and its branch may be optimized away. In that case, one side of the
7584   // first branch will point directly to select.end, and the corresponding PHI
7585   // predecessor block will be the start block.
7586 
7587   // Collect values that go on the true side and the values that go on the false
7588   // side.
7589   SmallVector<Instruction *> TrueInstrs, FalseInstrs;
7590   for (SelectInst *SI : ASI) {
7591     if (Value *V = SI->getTrueValue(); sinkSelectOperand(TTI, V))
7592       TrueInstrs.push_back(cast<Instruction>(V));
7593     if (Value *V = SI->getFalseValue(); sinkSelectOperand(TTI, V))
7594       FalseInstrs.push_back(cast<Instruction>(V));
7595   }
7596 
7597   // Split the select block, according to how many (if any) values go on each
7598   // side.
7599   BasicBlock *StartBlock = SI->getParent();
7600   BasicBlock::iterator SplitPt = std::next(BasicBlock::iterator(LastSI));
7601   // We should split before any debug-info.
7602   SplitPt.setHeadBit(true);
7603 
7604   IRBuilder<> IB(SI);
7605   auto *CondFr = IB.CreateFreeze(SI->getCondition(), SI->getName() + ".frozen");
7606 
7607   BasicBlock *TrueBlock = nullptr;
7608   BasicBlock *FalseBlock = nullptr;
7609   BasicBlock *EndBlock = nullptr;
7610   BranchInst *TrueBranch = nullptr;
7611   BranchInst *FalseBranch = nullptr;
7612   if (TrueInstrs.size() == 0) {
7613     FalseBranch = cast<BranchInst>(SplitBlockAndInsertIfElse(
7614         CondFr, SplitPt, false, nullptr, nullptr, LI));
7615     FalseBlock = FalseBranch->getParent();
7616     EndBlock = cast<BasicBlock>(FalseBranch->getOperand(0));
7617   } else if (FalseInstrs.size() == 0) {
7618     TrueBranch = cast<BranchInst>(SplitBlockAndInsertIfThen(
7619         CondFr, SplitPt, false, nullptr, nullptr, LI));
7620     TrueBlock = TrueBranch->getParent();
7621     EndBlock = cast<BasicBlock>(TrueBranch->getOperand(0));
7622   } else {
7623     Instruction *ThenTerm = nullptr;
7624     Instruction *ElseTerm = nullptr;
7625     SplitBlockAndInsertIfThenElse(CondFr, SplitPt, &ThenTerm, &ElseTerm,
7626                                   nullptr, nullptr, LI);
7627     TrueBranch = cast<BranchInst>(ThenTerm);
7628     FalseBranch = cast<BranchInst>(ElseTerm);
7629     TrueBlock = TrueBranch->getParent();
7630     FalseBlock = FalseBranch->getParent();
7631     EndBlock = cast<BasicBlock>(TrueBranch->getOperand(0));
7632   }
7633 
7634   EndBlock->setName("select.end");
7635   if (TrueBlock)
7636     TrueBlock->setName("select.true.sink");
7637   if (FalseBlock)
7638     FalseBlock->setName(FalseInstrs.size() == 0 ? "select.false"
7639                                                 : "select.false.sink");
7640 
7641   if (IsHugeFunc) {
7642     if (TrueBlock)
7643       FreshBBs.insert(TrueBlock);
7644     if (FalseBlock)
7645       FreshBBs.insert(FalseBlock);
7646     FreshBBs.insert(EndBlock);
7647   }
7648 
7649   BFI->setBlockFreq(EndBlock, BFI->getBlockFreq(StartBlock));
7650 
7651   static const unsigned MD[] = {
7652       LLVMContext::MD_prof, LLVMContext::MD_unpredictable,
7653       LLVMContext::MD_make_implicit, LLVMContext::MD_dbg};
7654   StartBlock->getTerminator()->copyMetadata(*SI, MD);
7655 
7656   // Sink expensive instructions into the conditional blocks to avoid executing
7657   // them speculatively.
7658   for (Instruction *I : TrueInstrs)
7659     I->moveBefore(TrueBranch->getIterator());
7660   for (Instruction *I : FalseInstrs)
7661     I->moveBefore(FalseBranch->getIterator());
7662 
7663   // If we did not create a new block for one of the 'true' or 'false' paths
7664   // of the condition, it means that side of the branch goes to the end block
7665   // directly and the path originates from the start block from the point of
7666   // view of the new PHI.
7667   if (TrueBlock == nullptr)
7668     TrueBlock = StartBlock;
7669   else if (FalseBlock == nullptr)
7670     FalseBlock = StartBlock;
7671 
7672   SmallPtrSet<const Instruction *, 2> INS(llvm::from_range, ASI);
7673   // Use reverse iterator because later select may use the value of the
7674   // earlier select, and we need to propagate value through earlier select
7675   // to get the PHI operand.
7676   for (SelectInst *SI : llvm::reverse(ASI)) {
7677     // The select itself is replaced with a PHI Node.
7678     PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(SI->getType(), 2, "");
7679     PN->insertBefore(EndBlock->begin());
7680     PN->takeName(SI);
7681     PN->addIncoming(getTrueOrFalseValue(SI, true, INS), TrueBlock);
7682     PN->addIncoming(getTrueOrFalseValue(SI, false, INS), FalseBlock);
7683     PN->setDebugLoc(SI->getDebugLoc());
7684 
7685     replaceAllUsesWith(SI, PN, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7686     SI->eraseFromParent();
7687     INS.erase(SI);
7688     ++NumSelectsExpanded;
7689   }
7690 
7691   // Instruct OptimizeBlock to skip to the next block.
7692   CurInstIterator = StartBlock->end();
7693   return true;
7694 }
7695 
7696 /// Some targets only accept certain types for splat inputs. For example a VDUP
7697 /// in MVE takes a GPR (integer) register, and the instruction that incorporate
7698 /// a VDUP (such as a VADD qd, qm, rm) also require a gpr register.
optimizeShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst * SVI)7699 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
7700   // Accept shuf(insertelem(undef/poison, val, 0), undef/poison, <0,0,..>) only
7701   if (!match(SVI, m_Shuffle(m_InsertElt(m_Undef(), m_Value(), m_ZeroInt()),
7702                             m_Undef(), m_ZeroMask())))
7703     return false;
7704   Type *NewType = TLI->shouldConvertSplatType(SVI);
7705   if (!NewType)
7706     return false;
7707 
7708   auto *SVIVecType = cast<FixedVectorType>(SVI->getType());
7709   assert(!NewType->isVectorTy() && "Expected a scalar type!");
7710   assert(NewType->getScalarSizeInBits() == SVIVecType->getScalarSizeInBits() &&
7711          "Expected a type of the same size!");
7712   auto *NewVecType =
7713       FixedVectorType::get(NewType, SVIVecType->getNumElements());
7714 
7715   // Create a bitcast (shuffle (insert (bitcast(..))))
7716   IRBuilder<> Builder(SVI->getContext());
7717   Builder.SetInsertPoint(SVI);
7718   Value *BC1 = Builder.CreateBitCast(
7719       cast<Instruction>(SVI->getOperand(0))->getOperand(1), NewType);
7720   Value *Shuffle = Builder.CreateVectorSplat(NewVecType->getNumElements(), BC1);
7721   Value *BC2 = Builder.CreateBitCast(Shuffle, SVIVecType);
7722 
7723   replaceAllUsesWith(SVI, BC2, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
7724   RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
7725       SVI, TLInfo, nullptr,
7726       [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
7727 
7728   // Also hoist the bitcast up to its operand if it they are not in the same
7729   // block.
7730   if (auto *BCI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BC1))
7731     if (auto *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BCI->getOperand(0)))
7732       if (BCI->getParent() != Op->getParent() && !isa<PHINode>(Op) &&
7733           !Op->isTerminator() && !Op->isEHPad())
7734         BCI->moveAfter(Op);
7735 
7736   return true;
7737 }
7738 
tryToSinkFreeOperands(Instruction * I)7739 bool CodeGenPrepare::tryToSinkFreeOperands(Instruction *I) {
7740   // If the operands of I can be folded into a target instruction together with
7741   // I, duplicate and sink them.
7742   SmallVector<Use *, 4> OpsToSink;
7743   if (!TTI->isProfitableToSinkOperands(I, OpsToSink))
7744     return false;
7745 
7746   // OpsToSink can contain multiple uses in a use chain (e.g.
7747   // (%u1 with %u1 = shufflevector), (%u2 with %u2 = zext %u1)). The dominating
7748   // uses must come first, so we process the ops in reverse order so as to not
7749   // create invalid IR.
7750   BasicBlock *TargetBB = I->getParent();
7751   bool Changed = false;
7752   SmallVector<Use *, 4> ToReplace;
7753   Instruction *InsertPoint = I;
7754   DenseMap<const Instruction *, unsigned long> InstOrdering;
7755   unsigned long InstNumber = 0;
7756   for (const auto &I : *TargetBB)
7757     InstOrdering[&I] = InstNumber++;
7758 
7759   for (Use *U : reverse(OpsToSink)) {
7760     auto *UI = cast<Instruction>(U->get());
7761     if (isa<PHINode>(UI))
7762       continue;
7763     if (UI->getParent() == TargetBB) {
7764       if (InstOrdering[UI] < InstOrdering[InsertPoint])
7765         InsertPoint = UI;
7766       continue;
7767     }
7768     ToReplace.push_back(U);
7769   }
7770 
7771   SetVector<Instruction *> MaybeDead;
7772   DenseMap<Instruction *, Instruction *> NewInstructions;
7773   for (Use *U : ToReplace) {
7774     auto *UI = cast<Instruction>(U->get());
7775     Instruction *NI = UI->clone();
7776 
7777     if (IsHugeFunc) {
7778       // Now we clone an instruction, its operands' defs may sink to this BB
7779       // now. So we put the operands defs' BBs into FreshBBs to do optimization.
7780       for (Value *Op : NI->operands())
7781         if (auto *OpDef = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op))
7782           FreshBBs.insert(OpDef->getParent());
7783     }
7784 
7785     NewInstructions[UI] = NI;
7786     MaybeDead.insert(UI);
7787     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Sinking " << *UI << " to user " << *I << "\n");
7788     NI->insertBefore(InsertPoint->getIterator());
7789     InsertPoint = NI;
7790     InsertedInsts.insert(NI);
7791 
7792     // Update the use for the new instruction, making sure that we update the
7793     // sunk instruction uses, if it is part of a chain that has already been
7794     // sunk.
7795     Instruction *OldI = cast<Instruction>(U->getUser());
7796     if (auto It = NewInstructions.find(OldI); It != NewInstructions.end())
7797       It->second->setOperand(U->getOperandNo(), NI);
7798     else
7799       U->set(NI);
7800     Changed = true;
7801   }
7802 
7803   // Remove instructions that are dead after sinking.
7804   for (auto *I : MaybeDead) {
7805     if (!I->hasNUsesOrMore(1)) {
7806       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Removing dead instruction: " << *I << "\n");
7807       I->eraseFromParent();
7808     }
7809   }
7810 
7811   return Changed;
7812 }
7813 
optimizeSwitchType(SwitchInst * SI)7814 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeSwitchType(SwitchInst *SI) {
7815   Value *Cond = SI->getCondition();
7816   Type *OldType = Cond->getType();
7817   LLVMContext &Context = Cond->getContext();
7818   EVT OldVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, OldType);
7819   MVT RegType = TLI->getPreferredSwitchConditionType(Context, OldVT);
7820   unsigned RegWidth = RegType.getSizeInBits();
7821 
7822   if (RegWidth <= cast<IntegerType>(OldType)->getBitWidth())
7823     return false;
7824 
7825   // If the register width is greater than the type width, expand the condition
7826   // of the switch instruction and each case constant to the width of the
7827   // register. By widening the type of the switch condition, subsequent
7828   // comparisons (for case comparisons) will not need to be extended to the
7829   // preferred register width, so we will potentially eliminate N-1 extends,
7830   // where N is the number of cases in the switch.
7831   auto *NewType = Type::getIntNTy(Context, RegWidth);
7832 
7833   // Extend the switch condition and case constants using the target preferred
7834   // extend unless the switch condition is a function argument with an extend
7835   // attribute. In that case, we can avoid an unnecessary mask/extension by
7836   // matching the argument extension instead.
7837   Instruction::CastOps ExtType = Instruction::ZExt;
7838   // Some targets prefer SExt over ZExt.
7839   if (TLI->isSExtCheaperThanZExt(OldVT, RegType))
7840     ExtType = Instruction::SExt;
7841 
7842   if (auto *Arg = dyn_cast<Argument>(Cond)) {
7843     if (Arg->hasSExtAttr())
7844       ExtType = Instruction::SExt;
7845     if (Arg->hasZExtAttr())
7846       ExtType = Instruction::ZExt;
7847   }
7848 
7849   auto *ExtInst = CastInst::Create(ExtType, Cond, NewType);
7850   ExtInst->insertBefore(SI->getIterator());
7851   ExtInst->setDebugLoc(SI->getDebugLoc());
7852   SI->setCondition(ExtInst);
7853   for (auto Case : SI->cases()) {
7854     const APInt &NarrowConst = Case.getCaseValue()->getValue();
7855     APInt WideConst = (ExtType == Instruction::ZExt)
7856                           ? NarrowConst.zext(RegWidth)
7857                           : NarrowConst.sext(RegWidth);
7858     Case.setValue(ConstantInt::get(Context, WideConst));
7859   }
7860 
7861   return true;
7862 }
7863 
optimizeSwitchPhiConstants(SwitchInst * SI)7864 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeSwitchPhiConstants(SwitchInst *SI) {
7865   // The SCCP optimization tends to produce code like this:
7866   //   switch(x) { case 42: phi(42, ...) }
7867   // Materializing the constant for the phi-argument needs instructions; So we
7868   // change the code to:
7869   //   switch(x) { case 42: phi(x, ...) }
7870 
7871   Value *Condition = SI->getCondition();
7872   // Avoid endless loop in degenerate case.
7873   if (isa<ConstantInt>(*Condition))
7874     return false;
7875 
7876   bool Changed = false;
7877   BasicBlock *SwitchBB = SI->getParent();
7878   Type *ConditionType = Condition->getType();
7879 
7880   for (const SwitchInst::CaseHandle &Case : SI->cases()) {
7881     ConstantInt *CaseValue = Case.getCaseValue();
7882     BasicBlock *CaseBB = Case.getCaseSuccessor();
7883     // Set to true if we previously checked that `CaseBB` is only reached by
7884     // a single case from this switch.
7885     bool CheckedForSinglePred = false;
7886     for (PHINode &PHI : CaseBB->phis()) {
7887       Type *PHIType = PHI.getType();
7888       // If ZExt is free then we can also catch patterns like this:
7889       //   switch((i32)x) { case 42: phi((i64)42, ...); }
7890       // and replace `(i64)42` with `zext i32 %x to i64`.
7891       bool TryZExt =
7892           PHIType->isIntegerTy() &&
7893           PHIType->getIntegerBitWidth() > ConditionType->getIntegerBitWidth() &&
7894           TLI->isZExtFree(ConditionType, PHIType);
7895       if (PHIType == ConditionType || TryZExt) {
7896         // Set to true to skip this case because of multiple preds.
7897         bool SkipCase = false;
7898         Value *Replacement = nullptr;
7899         for (unsigned I = 0, E = PHI.getNumIncomingValues(); I != E; I++) {
7900           Value *PHIValue = PHI.getIncomingValue(I);
7901           if (PHIValue != CaseValue) {
7902             if (!TryZExt)
7903               continue;
7904             ConstantInt *PHIValueInt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(PHIValue);
7905             if (!PHIValueInt ||
7906                 PHIValueInt->getValue() !=
7907                     CaseValue->getValue().zext(PHIType->getIntegerBitWidth()))
7908               continue;
7909           }
7910           if (PHI.getIncomingBlock(I) != SwitchBB)
7911             continue;
7912           // We cannot optimize if there are multiple case labels jumping to
7913           // this block.  This check may get expensive when there are many
7914           // case labels so we test for it last.
7915           if (!CheckedForSinglePred) {
7916             CheckedForSinglePred = true;
7917             if (SI->findCaseDest(CaseBB) == nullptr) {
7918               SkipCase = true;
7919               break;
7920             }
7921           }
7922 
7923           if (Replacement == nullptr) {
7924             if (PHIValue == CaseValue) {
7925               Replacement = Condition;
7926             } else {
7927               IRBuilder<> Builder(SI);
7928               Replacement = Builder.CreateZExt(Condition, PHIType);
7929             }
7930           }
7931           PHI.setIncomingValue(I, Replacement);
7932           Changed = true;
7933         }
7934         if (SkipCase)
7935           break;
7936       }
7937     }
7938   }
7939   return Changed;
7940 }
7941 
optimizeSwitchInst(SwitchInst * SI)7942 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeSwitchInst(SwitchInst *SI) {
7943   bool Changed = optimizeSwitchType(SI);
7944   Changed |= optimizeSwitchPhiConstants(SI);
7945   return Changed;
7946 }
7947 
7948 namespace {
7949 
7950 /// Helper class to promote a scalar operation to a vector one.
7951 /// This class is used to move downward extractelement transition.
7952 /// E.g.,
7953 /// a = vector_op <2 x i32>
7954 /// b = extractelement <2 x i32> a, i32 0
7955 /// c = scalar_op b
7956 /// store c
7957 ///
7958 /// =>
7959 /// a = vector_op <2 x i32>
7960 /// c = vector_op a (equivalent to scalar_op on the related lane)
7961 /// * d = extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 0
7962 /// * store d
7963 /// Assuming both extractelement and store can be combine, we get rid of the
7964 /// transition.
7965 class VectorPromoteHelper {
7966   /// DataLayout associated with the current module.
7967   const DataLayout &DL;
7968 
7969   /// Used to perform some checks on the legality of vector operations.
7970   const TargetLowering &TLI;
7971 
7972   /// Used to estimated the cost of the promoted chain.
7973   const TargetTransformInfo &TTI;
7974 
7975   /// The transition being moved downwards.
7976   Instruction *Transition;
7977 
7978   /// The sequence of instructions to be promoted.
7979   SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> InstsToBePromoted;
7980 
7981   /// Cost of combining a store and an extract.
7982   unsigned StoreExtractCombineCost;
7983 
7984   /// Instruction that will be combined with the transition.
7985   Instruction *CombineInst = nullptr;
7986 
7987   /// The instruction that represents the current end of the transition.
7988   /// Since we are faking the promotion until we reach the end of the chain
7989   /// of computation, we need a way to get the current end of the transition.
getEndOfTransition() const7990   Instruction *getEndOfTransition() const {
7991     if (InstsToBePromoted.empty())
7992       return Transition;
7993     return InstsToBePromoted.back();
7994   }
7995 
7996   /// Return the index of the original value in the transition.
7997   /// E.g., for "extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 1" the original value,
7998   /// c, is at index 0.
getTransitionOriginalValueIdx() const7999   unsigned getTransitionOriginalValueIdx() const {
8000     assert(isa<ExtractElementInst>(Transition) &&
8001            "Other kind of transitions are not supported yet");
8002     return 0;
8003   }
8004 
8005   /// Return the index of the index in the transition.
8006   /// E.g., for "extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 0" the index
8007   /// is at index 1.
getTransitionIdx() const8008   unsigned getTransitionIdx() const {
8009     assert(isa<ExtractElementInst>(Transition) &&
8010            "Other kind of transitions are not supported yet");
8011     return 1;
8012   }
8013 
8014   /// Get the type of the transition.
8015   /// This is the type of the original value.
8016   /// E.g., for "extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 1" the type of the
8017   /// transition is <2 x i32>.
getTransitionType() const8018   Type *getTransitionType() const {
8019     return Transition->getOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx())->getType();
8020   }
8021 
8022   /// Promote \p ToBePromoted by moving \p Def downward through.
8023   /// I.e., we have the following sequence:
8024   /// Def = Transition <ty1> a to <ty2>
8025   /// b = ToBePromoted <ty2> Def, ...
8026   /// =>
8027   /// b = ToBePromoted <ty1> a, ...
8028   /// Def = Transition <ty1> ToBePromoted to <ty2>
8029   void promoteImpl(Instruction *ToBePromoted);
8030 
8031   /// Check whether or not it is profitable to promote all the
8032   /// instructions enqueued to be promoted.
isProfitableToPromote()8033   bool isProfitableToPromote() {
8034     Value *ValIdx = Transition->getOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx());
8035     unsigned Index = isa<ConstantInt>(ValIdx)
8036                          ? cast<ConstantInt>(ValIdx)->getZExtValue()
8037                          : -1;
8038     Type *PromotedType = getTransitionType();
8039 
8040     StoreInst *ST = cast<StoreInst>(CombineInst);
8041     unsigned AS = ST->getPointerAddressSpace();
8042     // Check if this store is supported.
8043     if (!TLI.allowsMisalignedMemoryAccesses(
8044             TLI.getValueType(DL, ST->getValueOperand()->getType()), AS,
8045             ST->getAlign())) {
8046       // If this is not supported, there is no way we can combine
8047       // the extract with the store.
8048       return false;
8049     }
8050 
8051     // The scalar chain of computation has to pay for the transition
8052     // scalar to vector.
8053     // The vector chain has to account for the combining cost.
8054     enum TargetTransformInfo::TargetCostKind CostKind =
8055         TargetTransformInfo::TCK_RecipThroughput;
8056     InstructionCost ScalarCost =
8057         TTI.getVectorInstrCost(*Transition, PromotedType, CostKind, Index);
8058     InstructionCost VectorCost = StoreExtractCombineCost;
8059     for (const auto &Inst : InstsToBePromoted) {
8060       // Compute the cost.
8061       // By construction, all instructions being promoted are arithmetic ones.
8062       // Moreover, one argument is a constant that can be viewed as a splat
8063       // constant.
8064       Value *Arg0 = Inst->getOperand(0);
8065       bool IsArg0Constant = isa<UndefValue>(Arg0) || isa<ConstantInt>(Arg0) ||
8066                             isa<ConstantFP>(Arg0);
8067       TargetTransformInfo::OperandValueInfo Arg0Info, Arg1Info;
8068       if (IsArg0Constant)
8069         Arg0Info.Kind = TargetTransformInfo::OK_UniformConstantValue;
8070       else
8071         Arg1Info.Kind = TargetTransformInfo::OK_UniformConstantValue;
8072 
8073       ScalarCost += TTI.getArithmeticInstrCost(
8074           Inst->getOpcode(), Inst->getType(), CostKind, Arg0Info, Arg1Info);
8075       VectorCost += TTI.getArithmeticInstrCost(Inst->getOpcode(), PromotedType,
8076                                                CostKind, Arg0Info, Arg1Info);
8077     }
8078     LLVM_DEBUG(
8079         dbgs() << "Estimated cost of computation to be promoted:\nScalar: "
8080                << ScalarCost << "\nVector: " << VectorCost << '\n');
8081     return ScalarCost > VectorCost;
8082   }
8083 
8084   /// Generate a constant vector with \p Val with the same
8085   /// number of elements as the transition.
8086   /// \p UseSplat defines whether or not \p Val should be replicated
8087   /// across the whole vector.
8088   /// In other words, if UseSplat == true, we generate <Val, Val, ..., Val>,
8089   /// otherwise we generate a vector with as many poison as possible:
8090   /// <poison, ..., poison, Val, poison, ..., poison> where \p Val is only
8091   /// used at the index of the extract.
getConstantVector(Constant * Val,bool UseSplat) const8092   Value *getConstantVector(Constant *Val, bool UseSplat) const {
8093     unsigned ExtractIdx = std::numeric_limits<unsigned>::max();
8094     if (!UseSplat) {
8095       // If we cannot determine where the constant must be, we have to
8096       // use a splat constant.
8097       Value *ValExtractIdx = Transition->getOperand(getTransitionIdx());
8098       if (ConstantInt *CstVal = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ValExtractIdx))
8099         ExtractIdx = CstVal->getSExtValue();
8100       else
8101         UseSplat = true;
8102     }
8103 
8104     ElementCount EC = cast<VectorType>(getTransitionType())->getElementCount();
8105     if (UseSplat)
8106       return ConstantVector::getSplat(EC, Val);
8107 
8108     if (!EC.isScalable()) {
8109       SmallVector<Constant *, 4> ConstVec;
8110       PoisonValue *PoisonVal = PoisonValue::get(Val->getType());
8111       for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx != EC.getKnownMinValue(); ++Idx) {
8112         if (Idx == ExtractIdx)
8113           ConstVec.push_back(Val);
8114         else
8115           ConstVec.push_back(PoisonVal);
8116       }
8117       return ConstantVector::get(ConstVec);
8118     } else
8119       llvm_unreachable(
8120           "Generate scalable vector for non-splat is unimplemented");
8121   }
8122 
8123   /// Check if promoting to a vector type an operand at \p OperandIdx
8124   /// in \p Use can trigger undefined behavior.
canCauseUndefinedBehavior(const Instruction * Use,unsigned OperandIdx)8125   static bool canCauseUndefinedBehavior(const Instruction *Use,
8126                                         unsigned OperandIdx) {
8127     // This is not safe to introduce undef when the operand is on
8128     // the right hand side of a division-like instruction.
8129     if (OperandIdx != 1)
8130       return false;
8131     switch (Use->getOpcode()) {
8132     default:
8133       return false;
8134     case Instruction::SDiv:
8135     case Instruction::UDiv:
8136     case Instruction::SRem:
8137     case Instruction::URem:
8138       return true;
8139     case Instruction::FDiv:
8140     case Instruction::FRem:
8141       return !Use->hasNoNaNs();
8142     }
8143     llvm_unreachable(nullptr);
8144   }
8145 
8146 public:
VectorPromoteHelper(const DataLayout & DL,const TargetLowering & TLI,const TargetTransformInfo & TTI,Instruction * Transition,unsigned CombineCost)8147   VectorPromoteHelper(const DataLayout &DL, const TargetLowering &TLI,
8148                       const TargetTransformInfo &TTI, Instruction *Transition,
8149                       unsigned CombineCost)
8150       : DL(DL), TLI(TLI), TTI(TTI), Transition(Transition),
8151         StoreExtractCombineCost(CombineCost) {
8152     assert(Transition && "Do not know how to promote null");
8153   }
8154 
8155   /// Check if we can promote \p ToBePromoted to \p Type.
canPromote(const Instruction * ToBePromoted) const8156   bool canPromote(const Instruction *ToBePromoted) const {
8157     // We could support CastInst too.
8158     return isa<BinaryOperator>(ToBePromoted);
8159   }
8160 
8161   /// Check if it is profitable to promote \p ToBePromoted
8162   /// by moving downward the transition through.
shouldPromote(const Instruction * ToBePromoted) const8163   bool shouldPromote(const Instruction *ToBePromoted) const {
8164     // Promote only if all the operands can be statically expanded.
8165     // Indeed, we do not want to introduce any new kind of transitions.
8166     for (const Use &U : ToBePromoted->operands()) {
8167       const Value *Val = U.get();
8168       if (Val == getEndOfTransition()) {
8169         // If the use is a division and the transition is on the rhs,
8170         // we cannot promote the operation, otherwise we may create a
8171         // division by zero.
8172         if (canCauseUndefinedBehavior(ToBePromoted, U.getOperandNo()))
8173           return false;
8174         continue;
8175       }
8176       if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Val) && !isa<UndefValue>(Val) &&
8177           !isa<ConstantFP>(Val))
8178         return false;
8179     }
8180     // Check that the resulting operation is legal.
8181     int ISDOpcode = TLI.InstructionOpcodeToISD(ToBePromoted->getOpcode());
8182     if (!ISDOpcode)
8183       return false;
8184     return StressStoreExtract ||
8185            TLI.isOperationLegalOrCustom(
8186                ISDOpcode, TLI.getValueType(DL, getTransitionType(), true));
8187   }
8188 
8189   /// Check whether or not \p Use can be combined
8190   /// with the transition.
8191   /// I.e., is it possible to do Use(Transition) => AnotherUse?
canCombine(const Instruction * Use)8192   bool canCombine(const Instruction *Use) { return isa<StoreInst>(Use); }
8193 
8194   /// Record \p ToBePromoted as part of the chain to be promoted.
enqueueForPromotion(Instruction * ToBePromoted)8195   void enqueueForPromotion(Instruction *ToBePromoted) {
8196     InstsToBePromoted.push_back(ToBePromoted);
8197   }
8198 
8199   /// Set the instruction that will be combined with the transition.
recordCombineInstruction(Instruction * ToBeCombined)8200   void recordCombineInstruction(Instruction *ToBeCombined) {
8201     assert(canCombine(ToBeCombined) && "Unsupported instruction to combine");
8202     CombineInst = ToBeCombined;
8203   }
8204 
8205   /// Promote all the instructions enqueued for promotion if it is
8206   /// is profitable.
8207   /// \return True if the promotion happened, false otherwise.
promote()8208   bool promote() {
8209     // Check if there is something to promote.
8210     // Right now, if we do not have anything to combine with,
8211     // we assume the promotion is not profitable.
8212     if (InstsToBePromoted.empty() || !CombineInst)
8213       return false;
8214 
8215     // Check cost.
8216     if (!StressStoreExtract && !isProfitableToPromote())
8217       return false;
8218 
8219     // Promote.
8220     for (auto &ToBePromoted : InstsToBePromoted)
8221       promoteImpl(ToBePromoted);
8222     InstsToBePromoted.clear();
8223     return true;
8224   }
8225 };
8226 
8227 } // end anonymous namespace
8228 
promoteImpl(Instruction * ToBePromoted)8229 void VectorPromoteHelper::promoteImpl(Instruction *ToBePromoted) {
8230   // At this point, we know that all the operands of ToBePromoted but Def
8231   // can be statically promoted.
8232   // For Def, we need to use its parameter in ToBePromoted:
8233   // b = ToBePromoted ty1 a
8234   // Def = Transition ty1 b to ty2
8235   // Move the transition down.
8236   // 1. Replace all uses of the promoted operation by the transition.
8237   // = ... b => = ... Def.
8238   assert(ToBePromoted->getType() == Transition->getType() &&
8239          "The type of the result of the transition does not match "
8240          "the final type");
8241   ToBePromoted->replaceAllUsesWith(Transition);
8242   // 2. Update the type of the uses.
8243   // b = ToBePromoted ty2 Def => b = ToBePromoted ty1 Def.
8244   Type *TransitionTy = getTransitionType();
8245   ToBePromoted->mutateType(TransitionTy);
8246   // 3. Update all the operands of the promoted operation with promoted
8247   // operands.
8248   // b = ToBePromoted ty1 Def => b = ToBePromoted ty1 a.
8249   for (Use &U : ToBePromoted->operands()) {
8250     Value *Val = U.get();
8251     Value *NewVal = nullptr;
8252     if (Val == Transition)
8253       NewVal = Transition->getOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx());
8254     else if (isa<UndefValue>(Val) || isa<ConstantInt>(Val) ||
8255              isa<ConstantFP>(Val)) {
8256       // Use a splat constant if it is not safe to use undef.
8257       NewVal = getConstantVector(
8258           cast<Constant>(Val),
8259           isa<UndefValue>(Val) ||
8260               canCauseUndefinedBehavior(ToBePromoted, U.getOperandNo()));
8261     } else
8262       llvm_unreachable("Did you modified shouldPromote and forgot to update "
8263                        "this?");
8264     ToBePromoted->setOperand(U.getOperandNo(), NewVal);
8265   }
8266   Transition->moveAfter(ToBePromoted);
8267   Transition->setOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx(), ToBePromoted);
8268 }
8269 
8270 /// Some targets can do store(extractelement) with one instruction.
8271 /// Try to push the extractelement towards the stores when the target
8272 /// has this feature and this is profitable.
optimizeExtractElementInst(Instruction * Inst)8273 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeExtractElementInst(Instruction *Inst) {
8274   unsigned CombineCost = std::numeric_limits<unsigned>::max();
8275   if (DisableStoreExtract ||
8276       (!StressStoreExtract &&
8277        !TLI->canCombineStoreAndExtract(Inst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
8278                                        Inst->getOperand(1), CombineCost)))
8279     return false;
8280 
8281   // At this point we know that Inst is a vector to scalar transition.
8282   // Try to move it down the def-use chain, until:
8283   // - We can combine the transition with its single use
8284   //   => we got rid of the transition.
8285   // - We escape the current basic block
8286   //   => we would need to check that we are moving it at a cheaper place and
8287   //      we do not do that for now.
8288   BasicBlock *Parent = Inst->getParent();
8289   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Found an interesting transition: " << *Inst << '\n');
8290   VectorPromoteHelper VPH(*DL, *TLI, *TTI, Inst, CombineCost);
8291   // If the transition has more than one use, assume this is not going to be
8292   // beneficial.
8293   while (Inst->hasOneUse()) {
8294     Instruction *ToBePromoted = cast<Instruction>(*Inst->user_begin());
8295     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Use: " << *ToBePromoted << '\n');
8296 
8297     if (ToBePromoted->getParent() != Parent) {
8298       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Instruction to promote is in a different block ("
8299                         << ToBePromoted->getParent()->getName()
8300                         << ") than the transition (" << Parent->getName()
8301                         << ").\n");
8302       return false;
8303     }
8304 
8305     if (VPH.canCombine(ToBePromoted)) {
8306       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Assume " << *Inst << '\n'
8307                         << "will be combined with: " << *ToBePromoted << '\n');
8308       VPH.recordCombineInstruction(ToBePromoted);
8309       bool Changed = VPH.promote();
8310       NumStoreExtractExposed += Changed;
8311       return Changed;
8312     }
8313 
8314     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Try promoting.\n");
8315     if (!VPH.canPromote(ToBePromoted) || !VPH.shouldPromote(ToBePromoted))
8316       return false;
8317 
8318     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Promoting is possible... Enqueue for promotion!\n");
8319 
8320     VPH.enqueueForPromotion(ToBePromoted);
8321     Inst = ToBePromoted;
8322   }
8323   return false;
8324 }
8325 
8326 /// For the instruction sequence of store below, F and I values
8327 /// are bundled together as an i64 value before being stored into memory.
8328 /// Sometimes it is more efficient to generate separate stores for F and I,
8329 /// which can remove the bitwise instructions or sink them to colder places.
8330 ///
8331 ///   (store (or (zext (bitcast F to i32) to i64),
8332 ///              (shl (zext I to i64), 32)), addr)  -->
8333 ///   (store F, addr) and (store I, addr+4)
8334 ///
8335 /// Similarly, splitting for other merged store can also be beneficial, like:
8336 /// For pair of {i32, i32}, i64 store --> two i32 stores.
8337 /// For pair of {i32, i16}, i64 store --> two i32 stores.
8338 /// For pair of {i16, i16}, i32 store --> two i16 stores.
8339 /// For pair of {i16, i8},  i32 store --> two i16 stores.
8340 /// For pair of {i8, i8},   i16 store --> two i8 stores.
8341 ///
8342 /// We allow each target to determine specifically which kind of splitting is
8343 /// supported.
8344 ///
8345 /// The store patterns are commonly seen from the simple code snippet below
8346 /// if only std::make_pair(...) is sroa transformed before inlined into hoo.
8347 ///   void goo(const std::pair<int, float> &);
8348 ///   hoo() {
8349 ///     ...
8350 ///     goo(std::make_pair(tmp, ftmp));
8351 ///     ...
8352 ///   }
8353 ///
8354 /// Although we already have similar splitting in DAG Combine, we duplicate
8355 /// it in CodeGenPrepare to catch the case in which pattern is across
8356 /// multiple BBs. The logic in DAG Combine is kept to catch case generated
8357 /// during code expansion.
splitMergedValStore(StoreInst & SI,const DataLayout & DL,const TargetLowering & TLI)8358 static bool splitMergedValStore(StoreInst &SI, const DataLayout &DL,
8359                                 const TargetLowering &TLI) {
8360   // Handle simple but common cases only.
8361   Type *StoreType = SI.getValueOperand()->getType();
8362 
8363   // The code below assumes shifting a value by <number of bits>,
8364   // whereas scalable vectors would have to be shifted by
8365   // <2log(vscale) + number of bits> in order to store the
8366   // low/high parts. Bailing out for now.
8367   if (StoreType->isScalableTy())
8368     return false;
8369 
8370   if (!DL.typeSizeEqualsStoreSize(StoreType) ||
8371       DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StoreType) == 0)
8372     return false;
8373 
8374   unsigned HalfValBitSize = DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StoreType) / 2;
8375   Type *SplitStoreType = Type::getIntNTy(SI.getContext(), HalfValBitSize);
8376   if (!DL.typeSizeEqualsStoreSize(SplitStoreType))
8377     return false;
8378 
8379   // Don't split the store if it is volatile.
8380   if (SI.isVolatile())
8381     return false;
8382 
8383   // Match the following patterns:
8384   // (store (or (zext LValue to i64),
8385   //            (shl (zext HValue to i64), 32)), HalfValBitSize)
8386   //  or
8387   // (store (or (shl (zext HValue to i64), 32)), HalfValBitSize)
8388   //            (zext LValue to i64),
8389   // Expect both operands of OR and the first operand of SHL have only
8390   // one use.
8391   Value *LValue, *HValue;
8392   if (!match(SI.getValueOperand(),
8393              m_c_Or(m_OneUse(m_ZExt(m_Value(LValue))),
8394                     m_OneUse(m_Shl(m_OneUse(m_ZExt(m_Value(HValue))),
8395                                    m_SpecificInt(HalfValBitSize))))))
8396     return false;
8397 
8398   // Check LValue and HValue are int with size less or equal than 32.
8399   if (!LValue->getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
8400       DL.getTypeSizeInBits(LValue->getType()) > HalfValBitSize ||
8401       !HValue->getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
8402       DL.getTypeSizeInBits(HValue->getType()) > HalfValBitSize)
8403     return false;
8404 
8405   // If LValue/HValue is a bitcast instruction, use the EVT before bitcast
8406   // as the input of target query.
8407   auto *LBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(LValue);
8408   auto *HBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(HValue);
8409   EVT LowTy = LBC ? EVT::getEVT(LBC->getOperand(0)->getType())
8410                   : EVT::getEVT(LValue->getType());
8411   EVT HighTy = HBC ? EVT::getEVT(HBC->getOperand(0)->getType())
8412                    : EVT::getEVT(HValue->getType());
8413   if (!ForceSplitStore && !TLI.isMultiStoresCheaperThanBitsMerge(LowTy, HighTy))
8414     return false;
8415 
8416   // Start to split store.
8417   IRBuilder<> Builder(SI.getContext());
8418   Builder.SetInsertPoint(&SI);
8419 
8420   // If LValue/HValue is a bitcast in another BB, create a new one in current
8421   // BB so it may be merged with the splitted stores by dag combiner.
8422   if (LBC && LBC->getParent() != SI.getParent())
8423     LValue = Builder.CreateBitCast(LBC->getOperand(0), LBC->getType());
8424   if (HBC && HBC->getParent() != SI.getParent())
8425     HValue = Builder.CreateBitCast(HBC->getOperand(0), HBC->getType());
8426 
8427   bool IsLE = SI.getDataLayout().isLittleEndian();
8428   auto CreateSplitStore = [&](Value *V, bool Upper) {
8429     V = Builder.CreateZExtOrBitCast(V, SplitStoreType);
8430     Value *Addr = SI.getPointerOperand();
8431     Align Alignment = SI.getAlign();
8432     const bool IsOffsetStore = (IsLE && Upper) || (!IsLE && !Upper);
8433     if (IsOffsetStore) {
8434       Addr = Builder.CreateGEP(
8435           SplitStoreType, Addr,
8436           ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(SI.getContext()), 1));
8437 
8438       // When splitting the store in half, naturally one half will retain the
8439       // alignment of the original wider store, regardless of whether it was
8440       // over-aligned or not, while the other will require adjustment.
8441       Alignment = commonAlignment(Alignment, HalfValBitSize / 8);
8442     }
8443     Builder.CreateAlignedStore(V, Addr, Alignment);
8444   };
8445 
8446   CreateSplitStore(LValue, false);
8447   CreateSplitStore(HValue, true);
8448 
8449   // Delete the old store.
8450   SI.eraseFromParent();
8451   return true;
8452 }
8453 
8454 // Return true if the GEP has two operands, the first operand is of a sequential
8455 // type, and the second operand is a constant.
GEPSequentialConstIndexed(GetElementPtrInst * GEP)8456 static bool GEPSequentialConstIndexed(GetElementPtrInst *GEP) {
8457   gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*GEP);
8458   return GEP->getNumOperands() == 2 && I.isSequential() &&
8459          isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(1));
8460 }
8461 
8462 // Try unmerging GEPs to reduce liveness interference (register pressure) across
8463 // IndirectBr edges. Since IndirectBr edges tend to touch on many blocks,
8464 // reducing liveness interference across those edges benefits global register
8465 // allocation. Currently handles only certain cases.
8466 //
8467 // For example, unmerge %GEPI and %UGEPI as below.
8468 //
8469 // ---------- BEFORE ----------
8470 // SrcBlock:
8471 //   ...
8472 //   %GEPIOp = ...
8473 //   ...
8474 //   %GEPI = gep %GEPIOp, Idx
8475 //   ...
8476 //   indirectbr ... [ label %DstB0, label %DstB1, ... label %DstBi ... ]
8477 //   (* %GEPI is alive on the indirectbr edges due to other uses ahead)
8478 //   (* %GEPIOp is alive on the indirectbr edges only because of it's used by
8479 //   %UGEPI)
8480 //
8481 // DstB0: ... (there may be a gep similar to %UGEPI to be unmerged)
8482 // DstB1: ... (there may be a gep similar to %UGEPI to be unmerged)
8483 // ...
8484 //
8485 // DstBi:
8486 //   ...
8487 //   %UGEPI = gep %GEPIOp, UIdx
8488 // ...
8489 // ---------------------------
8490 //
8491 // ---------- AFTER ----------
8492 // SrcBlock:
8493 //   ... (same as above)
8494 //    (* %GEPI is still alive on the indirectbr edges)
8495 //    (* %GEPIOp is no longer alive on the indirectbr edges as a result of the
8496 //    unmerging)
8497 // ...
8498 //
8499 // DstBi:
8500 //   ...
8501 //   %UGEPI = gep %GEPI, (UIdx-Idx)
8502 //   ...
8503 // ---------------------------
8504 //
8505 // The register pressure on the IndirectBr edges is reduced because %GEPIOp is
8506 // no longer alive on them.
8507 //
8508 // We try to unmerge GEPs here in CodGenPrepare, as opposed to limiting merging
8509 // of GEPs in the first place in InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst() so as
8510 // not to disable further simplications and optimizations as a result of GEP
8511 // merging.
8512 //
8513 // Note this unmerging may increase the length of the data flow critical path
8514 // (the path from %GEPIOp to %UGEPI would go through %GEPI), which is a tradeoff
8515 // between the register pressure and the length of data-flow critical
8516 // path. Restricting this to the uncommon IndirectBr case would minimize the
8517 // impact of potentially longer critical path, if any, and the impact on compile
8518 // time.
tryUnmergingGEPsAcrossIndirectBr(GetElementPtrInst * GEPI,const TargetTransformInfo * TTI)8519 static bool tryUnmergingGEPsAcrossIndirectBr(GetElementPtrInst *GEPI,
8520                                              const TargetTransformInfo *TTI) {
8521   BasicBlock *SrcBlock = GEPI->getParent();
8522   // Check that SrcBlock ends with an IndirectBr. If not, give up. The common
8523   // (non-IndirectBr) cases exit early here.
8524   if (!isa<IndirectBrInst>(SrcBlock->getTerminator()))
8525     return false;
8526   // Check that GEPI is a simple gep with a single constant index.
8527   if (!GEPSequentialConstIndexed(GEPI))
8528     return false;
8529   ConstantInt *GEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(GEPI->getOperand(1));
8530   // Check that GEPI is a cheap one.
8531   if (TTI->getIntImmCost(GEPIIdx->getValue(), GEPIIdx->getType(),
8532                          TargetTransformInfo::TCK_SizeAndLatency) >
8533       TargetTransformInfo::TCC_Basic)
8534     return false;
8535   Value *GEPIOp = GEPI->getOperand(0);
8536   // Check that GEPIOp is an instruction that's also defined in SrcBlock.
8537   if (!isa<Instruction>(GEPIOp))
8538     return false;
8539   auto *GEPIOpI = cast<Instruction>(GEPIOp);
8540   if (GEPIOpI->getParent() != SrcBlock)
8541     return false;
8542   // Check that GEP is used outside the block, meaning it's alive on the
8543   // IndirectBr edge(s).
8544   if (llvm::none_of(GEPI->users(), [&](User *Usr) {
8545         if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Usr)) {
8546           if (I->getParent() != SrcBlock) {
8547             return true;
8548           }
8549         }
8550         return false;
8551       }))
8552     return false;
8553   // The second elements of the GEP chains to be unmerged.
8554   std::vector<GetElementPtrInst *> UGEPIs;
8555   // Check each user of GEPIOp to check if unmerging would make GEPIOp not alive
8556   // on IndirectBr edges.
8557   for (User *Usr : GEPIOp->users()) {
8558     if (Usr == GEPI)
8559       continue;
8560     // Check if Usr is an Instruction. If not, give up.
8561     if (!isa<Instruction>(Usr))
8562       return false;
8563     auto *UI = cast<Instruction>(Usr);
8564     // Check if Usr in the same block as GEPIOp, which is fine, skip.
8565     if (UI->getParent() == SrcBlock)
8566       continue;
8567     // Check if Usr is a GEP. If not, give up.
8568     if (!isa<GetElementPtrInst>(Usr))
8569       return false;
8570     auto *UGEPI = cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Usr);
8571     // Check if UGEPI is a simple gep with a single constant index and GEPIOp is
8572     // the pointer operand to it. If so, record it in the vector. If not, give
8573     // up.
8574     if (!GEPSequentialConstIndexed(UGEPI))
8575       return false;
8576     if (UGEPI->getOperand(0) != GEPIOp)
8577       return false;
8578     if (UGEPI->getSourceElementType() != GEPI->getSourceElementType())
8579       return false;
8580     if (GEPIIdx->getType() !=
8581         cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1))->getType())
8582       return false;
8583     ConstantInt *UGEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1));
8584     if (TTI->getIntImmCost(UGEPIIdx->getValue(), UGEPIIdx->getType(),
8585                            TargetTransformInfo::TCK_SizeAndLatency) >
8586         TargetTransformInfo::TCC_Basic)
8587       return false;
8588     UGEPIs.push_back(UGEPI);
8589   }
8590   if (UGEPIs.size() == 0)
8591     return false;
8592   // Check the materializing cost of (Uidx-Idx).
8593   for (GetElementPtrInst *UGEPI : UGEPIs) {
8594     ConstantInt *UGEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1));
8595     APInt NewIdx = UGEPIIdx->getValue() - GEPIIdx->getValue();
8596     InstructionCost ImmCost = TTI->getIntImmCost(
8597         NewIdx, GEPIIdx->getType(), TargetTransformInfo::TCK_SizeAndLatency);
8598     if (ImmCost > TargetTransformInfo::TCC_Basic)
8599       return false;
8600   }
8601   // Now unmerge between GEPI and UGEPIs.
8602   for (GetElementPtrInst *UGEPI : UGEPIs) {
8603     UGEPI->setOperand(0, GEPI);
8604     ConstantInt *UGEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1));
8605     Constant *NewUGEPIIdx = ConstantInt::get(
8606         GEPIIdx->getType(), UGEPIIdx->getValue() - GEPIIdx->getValue());
8607     UGEPI->setOperand(1, NewUGEPIIdx);
8608     // If GEPI is not inbounds but UGEPI is inbounds, change UGEPI to not
8609     // inbounds to avoid UB.
8610     if (!GEPI->isInBounds()) {
8611       UGEPI->setIsInBounds(false);
8612     }
8613   }
8614   // After unmerging, verify that GEPIOp is actually only used in SrcBlock (not
8615   // alive on IndirectBr edges).
8616   assert(llvm::none_of(GEPIOp->users(),
8617                        [&](User *Usr) {
8618                          return cast<Instruction>(Usr)->getParent() != SrcBlock;
8619                        }) &&
8620          "GEPIOp is used outside SrcBlock");
8621   return true;
8622 }
8623 
optimizeBranch(BranchInst * Branch,const TargetLowering & TLI,SmallSet<BasicBlock *,32> & FreshBBs,bool IsHugeFunc)8624 static bool optimizeBranch(BranchInst *Branch, const TargetLowering &TLI,
8625                            SmallSet<BasicBlock *, 32> &FreshBBs,
8626                            bool IsHugeFunc) {
8627   // Try and convert
8628   //  %c = icmp ult %x, 8
8629   //  br %c, bla, blb
8630   //  %tc = lshr %x, 3
8631   // to
8632   //  %tc = lshr %x, 3
8633   //  %c = icmp eq %tc, 0
8634   //  br %c, bla, blb
8635   // Creating the cmp to zero can be better for the backend, especially if the
8636   // lshr produces flags that can be used automatically.
8637   if (!TLI.preferZeroCompareBranch() || !Branch->isConditional())
8638     return false;
8639 
8640   ICmpInst *Cmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Branch->getCondition());
8641   if (!Cmp || !isa<ConstantInt>(Cmp->getOperand(1)) || !Cmp->hasOneUse())
8642     return false;
8643 
8644   Value *X = Cmp->getOperand(0);
8645   if (!X->hasUseList())
8646     return false;
8647 
8648   APInt CmpC = cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp->getOperand(1))->getValue();
8649 
8650   for (auto *U : X->users()) {
8651     Instruction *UI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U);
8652     // A quick dominance check
8653     if (!UI ||
8654         (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent() &&
8655          UI->getParent() != Branch->getSuccessor(0) &&
8656          UI->getParent() != Branch->getSuccessor(1)) ||
8657         (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent() &&
8658          !UI->getParent()->getSinglePredecessor()))
8659       continue;
8660 
8661     if (CmpC.isPowerOf2() && Cmp->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
8662         match(UI, m_Shr(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(CmpC.logBase2())))) {
8663       IRBuilder<> Builder(Branch);
8664       if (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent())
8665         UI->moveBefore(Branch->getIterator());
8666       UI->dropPoisonGeneratingFlags();
8667       Value *NewCmp = Builder.CreateCmp(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, UI,
8668                                         ConstantInt::get(UI->getType(), 0));
8669       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Converting " << *Cmp << "\n");
8670       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << " to compare on zero: " << *NewCmp << "\n");
8671       replaceAllUsesWith(Cmp, NewCmp, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8672       return true;
8673     }
8674     if (Cmp->isEquality() &&
8675         (match(UI, m_Add(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(-CmpC))) ||
8676          match(UI, m_Sub(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(CmpC))) ||
8677          match(UI, m_Xor(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(CmpC))))) {
8678       IRBuilder<> Builder(Branch);
8679       if (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent())
8680         UI->moveBefore(Branch->getIterator());
8681       UI->dropPoisonGeneratingFlags();
8682       Value *NewCmp = Builder.CreateCmp(Cmp->getPredicate(), UI,
8683                                         ConstantInt::get(UI->getType(), 0));
8684       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Converting " << *Cmp << "\n");
8685       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << " to compare on zero: " << *NewCmp << "\n");
8686       replaceAllUsesWith(Cmp, NewCmp, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8687       return true;
8688     }
8689   }
8690   return false;
8691 }
8692 
optimizeInst(Instruction * I,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)8693 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeInst(Instruction *I, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
8694   bool AnyChange = false;
8695   AnyChange = fixupDbgVariableRecordsOnInst(*I);
8696 
8697   // Bail out if we inserted the instruction to prevent optimizations from
8698   // stepping on each other's toes.
8699   if (InsertedInsts.count(I))
8700     return AnyChange;
8701 
8702   // TODO: Move into the switch on opcode below here.
8703   if (PHINode *P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) {
8704     // It is possible for very late stage optimizations (such as SimplifyCFG)
8705     // to introduce PHI nodes too late to be cleaned up.  If we detect such a
8706     // trivial PHI, go ahead and zap it here.
8707     if (Value *V = simplifyInstruction(P, {*DL, TLInfo})) {
8708       LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(P);
8709       replaceAllUsesWith(P, V, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8710       P->eraseFromParent();
8711       ++NumPHIsElim;
8712       return true;
8713     }
8714     return AnyChange;
8715   }
8716 
8717   if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
8718     // If the source of the cast is a constant, then this should have
8719     // already been constant folded.  The only reason NOT to constant fold
8720     // it is if something (e.g. LSR) was careful to place the constant
8721     // evaluation in a block other than then one that uses it (e.g. to hoist
8722     // the address of globals out of a loop).  If this is the case, we don't
8723     // want to forward-subst the cast.
8724     if (isa<Constant>(CI->getOperand(0)))
8725       return AnyChange;
8726 
8727     if (OptimizeNoopCopyExpression(CI, *TLI, *DL))
8728       return true;
8729 
8730     if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(I) || isa<SIToFPInst>(I) || isa<FPToUIInst>(I) ||
8731          isa<TruncInst>(I)) &&
8732         TLI->optimizeExtendOrTruncateConversion(
8733             I, LI->getLoopFor(I->getParent()), *TTI))
8734       return true;
8735 
8736     if (isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
8737       /// Sink a zext or sext into its user blocks if the target type doesn't
8738       /// fit in one register
8739       if (TLI->getTypeAction(CI->getContext(),
8740                              TLI->getValueType(*DL, CI->getType())) ==
8741           TargetLowering::TypeExpandInteger) {
8742         return SinkCast(CI);
8743       } else {
8744         if (TLI->optimizeExtendOrTruncateConversion(
8745                 I, LI->getLoopFor(I->getParent()), *TTI))
8746           return true;
8747 
8748         bool MadeChange = optimizeExt(I);
8749         return MadeChange | optimizeExtUses(I);
8750       }
8751     }
8752     return AnyChange;
8753   }
8754 
8755   if (auto *Cmp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
8756     if (optimizeCmp(Cmp, ModifiedDT))
8757       return true;
8758 
8759   if (match(I, m_URem(m_Value(), m_Value())))
8760     if (optimizeURem(I))
8761       return true;
8762 
8763   if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
8764     LI->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_invariant_group, nullptr);
8765     bool Modified = optimizeLoadExt(LI);
8766     unsigned AS = LI->getPointerAddressSpace();
8767     Modified |= optimizeMemoryInst(I, I->getOperand(0), LI->getType(), AS);
8768     return Modified;
8769   }
8770 
8771   if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(I)) {
8772     if (splitMergedValStore(*SI, *DL, *TLI))
8773       return true;
8774     SI->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_invariant_group, nullptr);
8775     unsigned AS = SI->getPointerAddressSpace();
8776     return optimizeMemoryInst(I, SI->getOperand(1),
8777                               SI->getOperand(0)->getType(), AS);
8778   }
8779 
8780   if (AtomicRMWInst *RMW = dyn_cast<AtomicRMWInst>(I)) {
8781     unsigned AS = RMW->getPointerAddressSpace();
8782     return optimizeMemoryInst(I, RMW->getPointerOperand(), RMW->getType(), AS);
8783   }
8784 
8785   if (AtomicCmpXchgInst *CmpX = dyn_cast<AtomicCmpXchgInst>(I)) {
8786     unsigned AS = CmpX->getPointerAddressSpace();
8787     return optimizeMemoryInst(I, CmpX->getPointerOperand(),
8788                               CmpX->getCompareOperand()->getType(), AS);
8789   }
8790 
8791   BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I);
8792 
8793   if (BinOp && BinOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && EnableAndCmpSinking &&
8794       sinkAndCmp0Expression(BinOp, *TLI, InsertedInsts))
8795     return true;
8796 
8797   // TODO: Move this into the switch on opcode - it handles shifts already.
8798   if (BinOp && (BinOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr ||
8799                 BinOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)) {
8800     ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BinOp->getOperand(1));
8801     if (CI && TLI->hasExtractBitsInsn())
8802       if (OptimizeExtractBits(BinOp, CI, *TLI, *DL))
8803         return true;
8804   }
8805 
8806   if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(I)) {
8807     if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8808       /// The GEP operand must be a pointer, so must its result -> BitCast
8809       Instruction *NC = new BitCastInst(GEPI->getOperand(0), GEPI->getType(),
8810                                         GEPI->getName(), GEPI->getIterator());
8811       NC->setDebugLoc(GEPI->getDebugLoc());
8812       replaceAllUsesWith(GEPI, NC, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8813       RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
8814           GEPI, TLInfo, nullptr,
8815           [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
8816       ++NumGEPsElim;
8817       optimizeInst(NC, ModifiedDT);
8818       return true;
8819     }
8820     if (tryUnmergingGEPsAcrossIndirectBr(GEPI, TTI)) {
8821       return true;
8822     }
8823   }
8824 
8825   if (FreezeInst *FI = dyn_cast<FreezeInst>(I)) {
8826     // freeze(icmp a, const)) -> icmp (freeze a), const
8827     // This helps generate efficient conditional jumps.
8828     Instruction *CmpI = nullptr;
8829     if (ICmpInst *II = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(FI->getOperand(0)))
8830       CmpI = II;
8831     else if (FCmpInst *F = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(FI->getOperand(0)))
8832       CmpI = F->getFastMathFlags().none() ? F : nullptr;
8833 
8834     if (CmpI && CmpI->hasOneUse()) {
8835       auto Op0 = CmpI->getOperand(0), Op1 = CmpI->getOperand(1);
8836       bool Const0 = isa<ConstantInt>(Op0) || isa<ConstantFP>(Op0) ||
8837                     isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0);
8838       bool Const1 = isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<ConstantFP>(Op1) ||
8839                     isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1);
8840       if (Const0 || Const1) {
8841         if (!Const0 || !Const1) {
8842           auto *F = new FreezeInst(Const0 ? Op1 : Op0, "", CmpI->getIterator());
8843           F->takeName(FI);
8844           CmpI->setOperand(Const0 ? 1 : 0, F);
8845         }
8846         replaceAllUsesWith(FI, CmpI, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8847         FI->eraseFromParent();
8848         return true;
8849       }
8850     }
8851     return AnyChange;
8852   }
8853 
8854   if (tryToSinkFreeOperands(I))
8855     return true;
8856 
8857   switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8858   case Instruction::Shl:
8859   case Instruction::LShr:
8860   case Instruction::AShr:
8861     return optimizeShiftInst(cast<BinaryOperator>(I));
8862   case Instruction::Call:
8863     return optimizeCallInst(cast<CallInst>(I), ModifiedDT);
8864   case Instruction::Select:
8865     return optimizeSelectInst(cast<SelectInst>(I));
8866   case Instruction::ShuffleVector:
8867     return optimizeShuffleVectorInst(cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I));
8868   case Instruction::Switch:
8869     return optimizeSwitchInst(cast<SwitchInst>(I));
8870   case Instruction::ExtractElement:
8871     return optimizeExtractElementInst(cast<ExtractElementInst>(I));
8872   case Instruction::Br:
8873     return optimizeBranch(cast<BranchInst>(I), *TLI, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8874   }
8875 
8876   return AnyChange;
8877 }
8878 
8879 /// Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bitreverse
8880 /// idiom. If so, insert the new intrinsic and return true.
makeBitReverse(Instruction & I)8881 bool CodeGenPrepare::makeBitReverse(Instruction &I) {
8882   if (!I.getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
8883       !TLI->isOperationLegalOrCustom(ISD::BITREVERSE,
8884                                      TLI->getValueType(*DL, I.getType(), true)))
8885     return false;
8886 
8887   SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> Insts;
8888   if (!recognizeBSwapOrBitReverseIdiom(&I, false, true, Insts))
8889     return false;
8890   Instruction *LastInst = Insts.back();
8891   replaceAllUsesWith(&I, LastInst, FreshBBs, IsHugeFunc);
8892   RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
8893       &I, TLInfo, nullptr,
8894       [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
8895   return true;
8896 }
8897 
8898 // In this pass we look for GEP and cast instructions that are used
8899 // across basic blocks and rewrite them to improve basic-block-at-a-time
8900 // selection.
optimizeBlock(BasicBlock & BB,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)8901 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeBlock(BasicBlock &BB, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
8902   SunkAddrs.clear();
8903   bool MadeChange = false;
8904 
8905   do {
8906     CurInstIterator = BB.begin();
8907     ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::NotModifyDT;
8908     while (CurInstIterator != BB.end()) {
8909       MadeChange |= optimizeInst(&*CurInstIterator++, ModifiedDT);
8910       if (ModifiedDT != ModifyDT::NotModifyDT) {
8911         // For huge function we tend to quickly go though the inner optmization
8912         // opportunities in the BB. So we go back to the BB head to re-optimize
8913         // each instruction instead of go back to the function head.
8914         if (IsHugeFunc) {
8915           DT.reset();
8916           getDT(*BB.getParent());
8917           break;
8918         } else {
8919           return true;
8920         }
8921       }
8922     }
8923   } while (ModifiedDT == ModifyDT::ModifyInstDT);
8924 
8925   bool MadeBitReverse = true;
8926   while (MadeBitReverse) {
8927     MadeBitReverse = false;
8928     for (auto &I : reverse(BB)) {
8929       if (makeBitReverse(I)) {
8930         MadeBitReverse = MadeChange = true;
8931         break;
8932       }
8933     }
8934   }
8935   MadeChange |= dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(&BB, ModifiedDT);
8936 
8937   return MadeChange;
8938 }
8939 
8940 // Some CGP optimizations may move or alter what's computed in a block. Check
8941 // whether a dbg.value intrinsic could be pointed at a more appropriate operand.
fixupDbgValue(Instruction * I)8942 bool CodeGenPrepare::fixupDbgValue(Instruction *I) {
8943   assert(isa<DbgValueInst>(I));
8944   DbgValueInst &DVI = *cast<DbgValueInst>(I);
8945 
8946   // Does this dbg.value refer to a sunk address calculation?
8947   bool AnyChange = false;
8948   SmallDenseSet<Value *> LocationOps(DVI.location_ops().begin(),
8949                                      DVI.location_ops().end());
8950   for (Value *Location : LocationOps) {
8951     WeakTrackingVH SunkAddrVH = SunkAddrs[Location];
8952     Value *SunkAddr = SunkAddrVH.pointsToAliveValue() ? SunkAddrVH : nullptr;
8953     if (SunkAddr) {
8954       // Point dbg.value at locally computed address, which should give the best
8955       // opportunity to be accurately lowered. This update may change the type
8956       // of pointer being referred to; however this makes no difference to
8957       // debugging information, and we can't generate bitcasts that may affect
8958       // codegen.
8959       DVI.replaceVariableLocationOp(Location, SunkAddr);
8960       AnyChange = true;
8961     }
8962   }
8963   return AnyChange;
8964 }
8965 
fixupDbgVariableRecordsOnInst(Instruction & I)8966 bool CodeGenPrepare::fixupDbgVariableRecordsOnInst(Instruction &I) {
8967   bool AnyChange = false;
8968   for (DbgVariableRecord &DVR : filterDbgVars(I.getDbgRecordRange()))
8969     AnyChange |= fixupDbgVariableRecord(DVR);
8970   return AnyChange;
8971 }
8972 
8973 // FIXME: should updating debug-info really cause the "changed" flag to fire,
8974 // which can cause a function to be reprocessed?
fixupDbgVariableRecord(DbgVariableRecord & DVR)8975 bool CodeGenPrepare::fixupDbgVariableRecord(DbgVariableRecord &DVR) {
8976   if (DVR.Type != DbgVariableRecord::LocationType::Value &&
8977       DVR.Type != DbgVariableRecord::LocationType::Assign)
8978     return false;
8979 
8980   // Does this DbgVariableRecord refer to a sunk address calculation?
8981   bool AnyChange = false;
8982   SmallDenseSet<Value *> LocationOps(DVR.location_ops().begin(),
8983                                      DVR.location_ops().end());
8984   for (Value *Location : LocationOps) {
8985     WeakTrackingVH SunkAddrVH = SunkAddrs[Location];
8986     Value *SunkAddr = SunkAddrVH.pointsToAliveValue() ? SunkAddrVH : nullptr;
8987     if (SunkAddr) {
8988       // Point dbg.value at locally computed address, which should give the best
8989       // opportunity to be accurately lowered. This update may change the type
8990       // of pointer being referred to; however this makes no difference to
8991       // debugging information, and we can't generate bitcasts that may affect
8992       // codegen.
8993       DVR.replaceVariableLocationOp(Location, SunkAddr);
8994       AnyChange = true;
8995     }
8996   }
8997   return AnyChange;
8998 }
8999 
DbgInserterHelper(DbgValueInst * DVI,BasicBlock::iterator VI)9000 static void DbgInserterHelper(DbgValueInst *DVI, BasicBlock::iterator VI) {
9001   DVI->removeFromParent();
9002   if (isa<PHINode>(VI))
9003     DVI->insertBefore(VI->getParent()->getFirstInsertionPt());
9004   else
9005     DVI->insertAfter(VI);
9006 }
9007 
DbgInserterHelper(DbgVariableRecord * DVR,BasicBlock::iterator VI)9008 static void DbgInserterHelper(DbgVariableRecord *DVR, BasicBlock::iterator VI) {
9009   DVR->removeFromParent();
9010   BasicBlock *VIBB = VI->getParent();
9011   if (isa<PHINode>(VI))
9012     VIBB->insertDbgRecordBefore(DVR, VIBB->getFirstInsertionPt());
9013   else
9014     VIBB->insertDbgRecordAfter(DVR, &*VI);
9015 }
9016 
9017 // A llvm.dbg.value may be using a value before its definition, due to
9018 // optimizations in this pass and others. Scan for such dbg.values, and rescue
9019 // them by moving the dbg.value to immediately after the value definition.
9020 // FIXME: Ideally this should never be necessary, and this has the potential
9021 // to re-order dbg.value intrinsics.
placeDbgValues(Function & F)9022 bool CodeGenPrepare::placeDbgValues(Function &F) {
9023   bool MadeChange = false;
9024   DominatorTree DT(F);
9025 
9026   auto DbgProcessor = [&](auto *DbgItem, Instruction *Position) {
9027     SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> VIs;
9028     for (Value *V : DbgItem->location_ops())
9029       if (Instruction *VI = dyn_cast_or_null<Instruction>(V))
9030         VIs.push_back(VI);
9031 
9032     // This item may depend on multiple instructions, complicating any
9033     // potential sink. This block takes the defensive approach, opting to
9034     // "undef" the item if it has more than one instruction and any of them do
9035     // not dominate iem.
9036     for (Instruction *VI : VIs) {
9037       if (VI->isTerminator())
9038         continue;
9039 
9040       // If VI is a phi in a block with an EHPad terminator, we can't insert
9041       // after it.
9042       if (isa<PHINode>(VI) && VI->getParent()->getTerminator()->isEHPad())
9043         continue;
9044 
9045       // If the defining instruction dominates the dbg.value, we do not need
9046       // to move the dbg.value.
9047       if (DT.dominates(VI, Position))
9048         continue;
9049 
9050       // If we depend on multiple instructions and any of them doesn't
9051       // dominate this DVI, we probably can't salvage it: moving it to
9052       // after any of the instructions could cause us to lose the others.
9053       if (VIs.size() > 1) {
9054         LLVM_DEBUG(
9055             dbgs()
9056             << "Unable to find valid location for Debug Value, undefing:\n"
9057             << *DbgItem);
9058         DbgItem->setKillLocation();
9059         break;
9060       }
9061 
9062       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Moving Debug Value before :\n"
9063                         << *DbgItem << ' ' << *VI);
9064       DbgInserterHelper(DbgItem, VI->getIterator());
9065       MadeChange = true;
9066       ++NumDbgValueMoved;
9067     }
9068   };
9069 
9070   for (BasicBlock &BB : F) {
9071     for (Instruction &Insn : llvm::make_early_inc_range(BB)) {
9072       // Process dbg.value intrinsics.
9073       DbgValueInst *DVI = dyn_cast<DbgValueInst>(&Insn);
9074       if (DVI) {
9075         DbgProcessor(DVI, DVI);
9076         continue;
9077       }
9078 
9079       // If this isn't a dbg.value, process any attached DbgVariableRecord
9080       // records attached to this instruction.
9081       for (DbgVariableRecord &DVR : llvm::make_early_inc_range(
9082                filterDbgVars(Insn.getDbgRecordRange()))) {
9083         if (DVR.Type != DbgVariableRecord::LocationType::Value)
9084           continue;
9085         DbgProcessor(&DVR, &Insn);
9086       }
9087     }
9088   }
9089 
9090   return MadeChange;
9091 }
9092 
9093 // Group scattered pseudo probes in a block to favor SelectionDAG. Scattered
9094 // probes can be chained dependencies of other regular DAG nodes and block DAG
9095 // combine optimizations.
placePseudoProbes(Function & F)9096 bool CodeGenPrepare::placePseudoProbes(Function &F) {
9097   bool MadeChange = false;
9098   for (auto &Block : F) {
9099     // Move the rest probes to the beginning of the block.
9100     auto FirstInst = Block.getFirstInsertionPt();
9101     while (FirstInst != Block.end() && FirstInst->isDebugOrPseudoInst())
9102       ++FirstInst;
9103     BasicBlock::iterator I(FirstInst);
9104     I++;
9105     while (I != Block.end()) {
9106       if (auto *II = dyn_cast<PseudoProbeInst>(I++)) {
9107         II->moveBefore(FirstInst);
9108         MadeChange = true;
9109       }
9110     }
9111   }
9112   return MadeChange;
9113 }
9114 
9115 /// Scale down both weights to fit into uint32_t.
scaleWeights(uint64_t & NewTrue,uint64_t & NewFalse)9116 static void scaleWeights(uint64_t &NewTrue, uint64_t &NewFalse) {
9117   uint64_t NewMax = (NewTrue > NewFalse) ? NewTrue : NewFalse;
9118   uint32_t Scale = (NewMax / std::numeric_limits<uint32_t>::max()) + 1;
9119   NewTrue = NewTrue / Scale;
9120   NewFalse = NewFalse / Scale;
9121 }
9122 
9123 /// Some targets prefer to split a conditional branch like:
9124 /// \code
9125 ///   %0 = icmp ne i32 %a, 0
9126 ///   %1 = icmp ne i32 %b, 0
9127 ///   %or.cond = or i1 %0, %1
9128 ///   br i1 %or.cond, label %TrueBB, label %FalseBB
9129 /// \endcode
9130 /// into multiple branch instructions like:
9131 /// \code
9132 ///   bb1:
9133 ///     %0 = icmp ne i32 %a, 0
9134 ///     br i1 %0, label %TrueBB, label %bb2
9135 ///   bb2:
9136 ///     %1 = icmp ne i32 %b, 0
9137 ///     br i1 %1, label %TrueBB, label %FalseBB
9138 /// \endcode
9139 /// This usually allows instruction selection to do even further optimizations
9140 /// and combine the compare with the branch instruction. Currently this is
9141 /// applied for targets which have "cheap" jump instructions.
9142 ///
9143 /// FIXME: Remove the (equivalent?) implementation in SelectionDAG.
9144 ///
splitBranchCondition(Function & F,ModifyDT & ModifiedDT)9145 bool CodeGenPrepare::splitBranchCondition(Function &F, ModifyDT &ModifiedDT) {
9146   if (!TM->Options.EnableFastISel || TLI->isJumpExpensive())
9147     return false;
9148 
9149   bool MadeChange = false;
9150   for (auto &BB : F) {
9151     // Does this BB end with the following?
9152     //   %cond1 = icmp|fcmp|binary instruction ...
9153     //   %cond2 = icmp|fcmp|binary instruction ...
9154     //   %cond.or = or|and i1 %cond1, cond2
9155     //   br i1 %cond.or label %dest1, label %dest2"
9156     Instruction *LogicOp;
9157     BasicBlock *TBB, *FBB;
9158     if (!match(BB.getTerminator(),
9159                m_Br(m_OneUse(m_Instruction(LogicOp)), TBB, FBB)))
9160       continue;
9161 
9162     auto *Br1 = cast<BranchInst>(BB.getTerminator());
9163     if (Br1->getMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_unpredictable))
9164       continue;
9165 
9166     // The merging of mostly empty BB can cause a degenerate branch.
9167     if (TBB == FBB)
9168       continue;
9169 
9170     unsigned Opc;
9171     Value *Cond1, *Cond2;
9172     if (match(LogicOp,
9173               m_LogicalAnd(m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond1)), m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond2)))))
9174       Opc = Instruction::And;
9175     else if (match(LogicOp, m_LogicalOr(m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond1)),
9176                                         m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond2)))))
9177       Opc = Instruction::Or;
9178     else
9179       continue;
9180 
9181     auto IsGoodCond = [](Value *Cond) {
9182       return match(
9183           Cond,
9184           m_CombineOr(m_Cmp(), m_CombineOr(m_LogicalAnd(m_Value(), m_Value()),
9185                                            m_LogicalOr(m_Value(), m_Value()))));
9186     };
9187     if (!IsGoodCond(Cond1) || !IsGoodCond(Cond2))
9188       continue;
9189 
9190     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Before branch condition splitting\n"; BB.dump());
9191 
9192     // Create a new BB.
9193     auto *TmpBB =
9194         BasicBlock::Create(BB.getContext(), BB.getName() + ".cond.split",
9195                            BB.getParent(), BB.getNextNode());
9196     if (IsHugeFunc)
9197       FreshBBs.insert(TmpBB);
9198 
9199     // Update original basic block by using the first condition directly by the
9200     // branch instruction and removing the no longer needed and/or instruction.
9201     Br1->setCondition(Cond1);
9202     LogicOp->eraseFromParent();
9203 
9204     // Depending on the condition we have to either replace the true or the
9205     // false successor of the original branch instruction.
9206     if (Opc == Instruction::And)
9207       Br1->setSuccessor(0, TmpBB);
9208     else
9209       Br1->setSuccessor(1, TmpBB);
9210 
9211     // Fill in the new basic block.
9212     auto *Br2 = IRBuilder<>(TmpBB).CreateCondBr(Cond2, TBB, FBB);
9213     if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond2)) {
9214       I->removeFromParent();
9215       I->insertBefore(Br2->getIterator());
9216     }
9217 
9218     // Update PHI nodes in both successors. The original BB needs to be
9219     // replaced in one successor's PHI nodes, because the branch comes now from
9220     // the newly generated BB (NewBB). In the other successor we need to add one
9221     // incoming edge to the PHI nodes, because both branch instructions target
9222     // now the same successor. Depending on the original branch condition
9223     // (and/or) we have to swap the successors (TrueDest, FalseDest), so that
9224     // we perform the correct update for the PHI nodes.
9225     // This doesn't change the successor order of the just created branch
9226     // instruction (or any other instruction).
9227     if (Opc == Instruction::Or)
9228       std::swap(TBB, FBB);
9229 
9230     // Replace the old BB with the new BB.
9231     TBB->replacePhiUsesWith(&BB, TmpBB);
9232 
9233     // Add another incoming edge from the new BB.
9234     for (PHINode &PN : FBB->phis()) {
9235       auto *Val = PN.getIncomingValueForBlock(&BB);
9236       PN.addIncoming(Val, TmpBB);
9237     }
9238 
9239     // Update the branch weights (from SelectionDAGBuilder::
9240     // FindMergedConditions).
9241     if (Opc == Instruction::Or) {
9242       // Codegen X | Y as:
9243       // BB1:
9244       //   jmp_if_X TBB
9245       //   jmp TmpBB
9246       // TmpBB:
9247       //   jmp_if_Y TBB
9248       //   jmp FBB
9249       //
9250 
9251       // We have flexibility in setting Prob for BB1 and Prob for NewBB.
9252       // The requirement is that
9253       //   TrueProb for BB1 + (FalseProb for BB1 * TrueProb for TmpBB)
9254       //     = TrueProb for original BB.
9255       // Assuming the original weights are A and B, one choice is to set BB1's
9256       // weights to A and A+2B, and set TmpBB's weights to A and 2B. This choice
9257       // assumes that
9258       //   TrueProb for BB1 == FalseProb for BB1 * TrueProb for TmpBB.
9259       // Another choice is to assume TrueProb for BB1 equals to TrueProb for
9260       // TmpBB, but the math is more complicated.
9261       uint64_t TrueWeight, FalseWeight;
9262       if (extractBranchWeights(*Br1, TrueWeight, FalseWeight)) {
9263         uint64_t NewTrueWeight = TrueWeight;
9264         uint64_t NewFalseWeight = TrueWeight + 2 * FalseWeight;
9265         scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
9266         Br1->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof,
9267                          MDBuilder(Br1->getContext())
9268                              .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight,
9269                                                   hasBranchWeightOrigin(*Br1)));
9270 
9271         NewTrueWeight = TrueWeight;
9272         NewFalseWeight = 2 * FalseWeight;
9273         scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
9274         Br2->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof,
9275                          MDBuilder(Br2->getContext())
9276                              .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight));
9277       }
9278     } else {
9279       // Codegen X & Y as:
9280       // BB1:
9281       //   jmp_if_X TmpBB
9282       //   jmp FBB
9283       // TmpBB:
9284       //   jmp_if_Y TBB
9285       //   jmp FBB
9286       //
9287       //  This requires creation of TmpBB after CurBB.
9288 
9289       // We have flexibility in setting Prob for BB1 and Prob for TmpBB.
9290       // The requirement is that
9291       //   FalseProb for BB1 + (TrueProb for BB1 * FalseProb for TmpBB)
9292       //     = FalseProb for original BB.
9293       // Assuming the original weights are A and B, one choice is to set BB1's
9294       // weights to 2A+B and B, and set TmpBB's weights to 2A and B. This choice
9295       // assumes that
9296       //   FalseProb for BB1 == TrueProb for BB1 * FalseProb for TmpBB.
9297       uint64_t TrueWeight, FalseWeight;
9298       if (extractBranchWeights(*Br1, TrueWeight, FalseWeight)) {
9299         uint64_t NewTrueWeight = 2 * TrueWeight + FalseWeight;
9300         uint64_t NewFalseWeight = FalseWeight;
9301         scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
9302         Br1->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof,
9303                          MDBuilder(Br1->getContext())
9304                              .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight));
9305 
9306         NewTrueWeight = 2 * TrueWeight;
9307         NewFalseWeight = FalseWeight;
9308         scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
9309         Br2->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof,
9310                          MDBuilder(Br2->getContext())
9311                              .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight));
9312       }
9313     }
9314 
9315     ModifiedDT = ModifyDT::ModifyBBDT;
9316     MadeChange = true;
9317 
9318     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "After branch condition splitting\n"; BB.dump();
9319                TmpBB->dump());
9320   }
9321   return MadeChange;
9322 }
9323